blob: 375eedafaa87d09ce095f3bd5165e400dc50d072 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau1db55792020-11-05 17:20:35 +01005 version 2.4
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreaubfd19d62021-04-23 19:11:10 +02007 2021/04/23
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100442.4. Conditional blocks
452.5. Time format
462.6. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020047
483. Global parameters
493.1. Process management and security
503.2. Performance tuning
513.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100523.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200533.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200543.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200553.7. Programs
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +0100563.8. HTTP-errors
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +0200573.9. Rings
William Lallemand0217b7b2020-11-18 10:41:24 +0100583.10. Log forwarding
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020059
604. Proxies
614.1. Proxy keywords matrix
624.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
63
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100645. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200655.1. Bind options
665.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200675.3. Server DNS resolution
685.3.1. Global overview
695.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020070
Julien Pivotto6ccee412019-11-27 15:49:54 +0100716. Cache
726.1. Limitation
736.2. Setup
746.2.1. Cache section
756.2.2. Proxy section
76
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200777. Using ACLs and fetching samples
787.1. ACL basics
797.1.1. Matching booleans
807.1.2. Matching integers
817.1.3. Matching strings
827.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
837.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
847.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
857.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
867.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200877.3.1. Converters
887.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
897.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
907.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
917.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
927.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200937.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200947.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020095
968. Logging
978.1. Log levels
988.2. Log formats
998.2.1. Default log format
1008.2.2. TCP log format
1018.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01001028.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +01001038.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001048.3. Advanced logging options
1058.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
1068.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
1078.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
1088.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1098.4. Timing events
1108.5. Session state at disconnection
1118.6. Non-printable characters
1128.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1138.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1148.9. Examples of logs
115
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001169. Supported filters
1179.1. Trace
1189.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001199.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001209.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02001219.5. fcgi-app
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +01001229.6. OpenTracing
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200123
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012410. FastCGI applications
12510.1. Setup
12610.1.1. Fcgi-app section
12710.1.2. Proxy section
12810.1.3. Example
12910.2. Default parameters
13010.3. Limitations
131
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020013211. Address formats
13311.1. Address family prefixes
13411.2. Socket type prefixes
13511.3. Protocol prefixes
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200136
1371. Quick reminder about HTTP
138----------------------------
139
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100140When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200141fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
142on almost anything found in the contents.
143
144However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
145formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
146correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
147
148
1491.1. The HTTP transaction model
150-------------------------------
151
152The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100153to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100154from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
155connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200156will involve a new connection :
157
158 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
159
160In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
161establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
162by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
163length.
164
165Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
166to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
167however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
168response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
169header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
170
171 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
172
173Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
174power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
175but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200176a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100178Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200179keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
180second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
181page :
182
183 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
184
185This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
186latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
187correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
188the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100189server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200190
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100191The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
192time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
193are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
194parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
195carry the stream identifier.
196
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100197By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
198connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
199leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100200start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
201processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
202waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200203
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200204HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100205 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
206 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100207 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100208 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200209 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100210
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100211
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200212
2131.2. HTTP request
214-----------------
215
216First, let's consider this HTTP request :
217
218 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100219 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200220 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
221 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
222 3 User-agent: my small browser
223 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
224 5 Accept: image/png
225
226
2271.2.1. The Request line
228-----------------------
229
230Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
231
232 - a METHOD : GET
233 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
234 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
235
236All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
237which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
238followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
239is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
240desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
241the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
242
243The URI itself can have several forms :
244
245 - A "relative URI" :
246
247 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
248
249 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
250 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
251
252 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
253
254 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
255
256 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
257 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
258 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
259 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
260 must accept this form too.
261
262 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
263 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
264 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100265
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200266 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
267 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
268 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
269 other protocols too.
270
271In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
272mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
273on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
274It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
275specific to the language, framework or application in use.
276
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100277HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100278assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100279
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200280
2811.2.2. The request headers
282--------------------------
283
284The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
285beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
286an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
287Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
288values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
289encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
290the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
291define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
292
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100293Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200294their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100295"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
Willy Tarreau253c2512020-07-07 15:55:23 +0200296as can be seen when running in debug mode. Internally, all header names are
297normalized to lower case so that HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 use the exact same
298representation, and they are sent as-is on the other side. This explains why an
299HTTP/1.x request typed with camel case is delivered in lower case.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200300
301The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
302that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
303is one valid form of empty line.
304
305Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
306headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
307about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
308application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
309
310Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000311 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200312 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
313 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
314 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
315
316
3171.3. HTTP response
318------------------
319
320An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
321messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
322
323 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100324 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200325 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
326 2 Content-length: 350
327 3 Content-Type: text/html
328
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200329As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
330codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
331response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100332continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
333the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
334following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
335sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
336(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
337correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
338such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
339state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
340over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
341if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
342information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200343
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200344
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003451.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200346------------------------
347
348Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
349
350 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
351 - a status code : 200
352 - a reason : OK
353
354The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100355 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
356 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
357 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
358 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
359 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200360
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000361Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100362"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200363found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
364messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
365or "Authentication Required".
366
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100367HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200368
369 Code When / reason
370 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
371 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
372 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
373 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100374 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
375 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200376 400 for an invalid or too large request
377 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
378 accessing the stats page)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200379 403 when a request is forbidden by a "http-request deny" rule
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +0100380 404 when the requested resource could not be found
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
Florian Tham272e29b2020-01-08 10:19:05 +0100382 410 when the requested resource is no longer available and will not
383 be available again
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200384 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
385 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +0100386 501 when haproxy is unable to satisfy a client request because of an
387 unsupported feature
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200388 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200389 when an "http-response deny" rule blocks the response.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200390 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
391 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
392 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
393
394The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3954.2).
396
397
3981.3.2. The response headers
399---------------------------
400
401Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
402the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
403details.
404
405
4062. Configuring HAProxy
407----------------------
408
4092.1. Configuration file format
410------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200411
412HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
413
414 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100415 - the configuration file(s), whose format is described here
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -0700416 - the running process's environment, in case some environment variables are
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100417 explicitly referenced
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200418
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100419The configuration file follows a fairly simple hierarchical format which obey
420a few basic rules:
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100421
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100422 1. a configuration file is an ordered sequence of statements
423
424 2. a statement is a single non-empty line before any unprotected "#" (hash)
425
426 3. a line is a series of tokens or "words" delimited by unprotected spaces or
427 tab characters
428
429 4. the first word or sequence of words of a line is one of the keywords or
430 keyword sequences listed in this document
431
432 5. all other words are all arguments of the first one, some being well-known
433 keywords listed in this document, others being values, references to other
434 parts of the configuration, or expressions
435
436 6. certain keywords delimit a section inside which only a subset of keywords
437 are supported
438
439 7. a section ends at the end of a file or on a special keyword starting a new
440 section
441
442This is all that is needed to know to write a simple but reliable configuration
443generator, but this is not enough to reliably parse any configuration nor to
444figure how to deal with certain corner cases.
445
446First, there are a few consequences of the rules above. Rule 6 and 7 imply that
447the keywords used to define a new section are valid everywhere and cannot have
448a different meaning in a specific section. These keywords are always a single
449word (as opposed to a sequence of words), and traditionally the section that
450follows them is designated using the same name. For example when speaking about
451the "global section", it designates the section of configuration that follows
452the "global" keyword. This usage is used a lot in error messages to help locate
453the parts that need to be addressed.
454
455A number of sections create an internal object or configuration space, which
456requires to be distinguished from other ones. In this case they will take an
457extra word which will set the name of this particular section. For some of them
458the section name is mandatory. For example "frontend foo" will create a new
459section of type "frontend" named "foo". Usually a name is specific to its
460section and two sections of different types may use the same name, but this is
461not recommended as it tends to complexify configuration management.
462
463A direct consequence of rule 7 is that when multiple files are read at once,
464each of them must start with a new section, and the end of each file will end
465a section. A file cannot contain sub-sections nor end an existing section and
466start a new one.
467
468Rule 1 mentioned that ordering matters. Indeed, some keywords create directives
469that can be repeated multiple times to create ordered sequences of rules to be
470applied in a certain order. For example "tcp-request" can be used to alternate
471"accept" and "reject" rules on varying criteria. As such, a configuration file
472processor must always preserve a section's ordering when editing a file. The
473ordering of sections usually does not matter except for the global section
474which must be placed before other sections, but it may be repeated if needed.
475In addition, some automatic identifiers may automatically be assigned to some
476of the created objects (e.g. proxies), and by reordering sections, their
477identifiers will change. These ones appear in the statistics for example. As
478such, the configuration below will assign "foo" ID number 1 and "bar" ID number
4792, which will be swapped if the two sections are reversed:
480
481 listen foo
482 bind :80
483
484 listen bar
485 bind :81
486
487Another important point is that according to rules 2 and 3 above, empty lines,
488spaces, tabs, and comments following and unprotected "#" character are not part
489of the configuration as they are just used as delimiters. This implies that the
490following configurations are strictly equivalent:
491
492 global#this is the global section
493 daemon#daemonize
494 frontend foo
495 mode http # or tcp
496
497and:
498
499 global
500 daemon
501
502 # this is the public web frontend
503 frontend foo
504 mode http
505
506The common practice is to align to the left only the keyword that initiates a
507new section, and indent (i.e. prepend a tab character or a few spaces) all
508other keywords so that it's instantly visible that they belong to the same
509section (as done in the second example above). Placing comments before a new
510section helps the reader decide if it's the desired one. Leaving a blank line
511at the end of a section also visually helps spotting the end when editing it.
512
513Tabs are very convenient for indent but they do not copy-paste well. If spaces
514are used instead, it is recommended to avoid placing too many (2 to 4) so that
515editing in field doesn't become a burden with limited editors that do not
516support automatic indent.
517
518In the early days it used to be common to see arguments split at fixed tab
519positions because most keywords would not take more than two arguments. With
520modern versions featuring complex expressions this practice does not stand
521anymore, and is not recommended.
522
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200523
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02005242.2. Quoting and escaping
525-------------------------
526
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100527In modern configurations, some arguments require the use of some characters
528that were previously considered as pure delimiters. In order to make this
529possible, HAProxy supports character escaping by prepending a backslash ('\')
530in front of the character to be escaped, weak quoting within double quotes
531('"') and strong quoting within single quotes ("'").
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200532
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100533This is pretty similar to what is done in a number of programming languages and
534very close to what is commonly encountered in Bourne shell. The principle is
535the following: while the configuration parser cuts the lines into words, it
536also takes care of quotes and backslashes to decide whether a character is a
537delimiter or is the raw representation of this character within the current
538word. The escape character is then removed, the quotes are removed, and the
539remaining word is used as-is as a keyword or argument for example.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200540
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100541If a backslash is needed in a word, it must either be escaped using itself
542(i.e. double backslash) or be strongly quoted.
543
544Escaping outside quotes is achieved by preceding a special character by a
545backslash ('\'):
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200546
547 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
548 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
549 \\ to use a backslash
550 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
551 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
552
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100553In addition, a few non-printable characters may be emitted using their usual
554C-language representation:
555
556 \n to insert a line feed (LF, character \x0a or ASCII 10 decimal)
557 \r to insert a carriage return (CR, character \x0d or ASCII 13 decimal)
558 \t to insert a tab (character \x09 or ASCII 9 decimal)
559 \xNN to insert character having ASCII code hex NN (e.g \x0a for LF).
560
561Weak quoting is achieved by surrounding double quotes ("") around the character
562or sequence of characters to protect. Weak quoting prevents the interpretation
563of:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200564
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100565 space or tab as a word separator
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200566 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
567 # hash as a comment start
568
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100569Weak quoting permits the interpretation of environment variables (which are not
570evaluated outside of quotes) by preceding them with a dollar sign ('$'). If a
571dollar character is needed inside double quotes, it must be escaped using a
572backslash.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200573
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100574Strong quoting is achieved by surrounding single quotes ('') around the
575character or sequence of characters to protect. Inside single quotes, nothing
576is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regular expressions.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200577
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100578As a result, here is the matrix indicating how special characters can be
579entered in different contexts (unprintable characters are replaced with their
580name within angle brackets). Note that some characters that may only be
581represented escaped have no possible representation inside single quotes,
582hence the '-' there:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200583
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100584 Character | Unquoted | Weakly quoted | Strongly quoted
585 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
586 <TAB> | \<TAB>, \x09 | "<TAB>", "\<TAB>", "\x09" | '<TAB>'
587 <LF> | \n, \x0a | "\n", "\x0a" | -
588 <CR> | \r, \x0d | "\r", "\x0d" | -
589 <SPC> | \<SPC>, \x20 | "<SPC>", "\<SPC>", "\x20" | '<SPC>'
590 " | \", \x22 | "\"", "\x22" | '"'
591 # | \#, \x23 | "#", "\#", "\x23" | '#'
592 $ | $, \$, \x24 | "\$", "\x24" | '$'
593 ' | \', \x27 | "'", "\'", "\x27" | -
594 \ | \\, \x5c | "\\", "\x5c" | '\'
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200595
596 Example:
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100597 # those are all strictly equivalent:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200598 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
599 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
600 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
601 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
602 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
603
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100604There is one particular case where a second level of quoting or escaping may be
605necessary. Some keywords take arguments within parenthesis, sometimes delimited
606by commas. These arguments are commonly integers or predefined words, but when
607they are arbitrary strings, it may be required to perform a separate level of
608escaping to disambiguate the characters that belong to the argument from the
609characters that are used to delimit the arguments themselves. A pretty common
610case is the "regsub" converter. It takes a regular expression in argument, and
611if a closing parenthesis is needed inside, this one will require to have its
612own quotes.
613
614The keyword argument parser is exactly the same as the top-level one regarding
615quotes, except that is will not make special cases of backslashes. But what is
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500616not always obvious is that the delimiters used inside must first be escaped or
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100617quoted so that they are not resolved at the top level.
618
619Let's take this example making use of the "regsub" converter which takes 3
620arguments, one regular expression, one replacement string and one set of flags:
621
622 # replace all occurrences of "foo" with "blah" in the path:
623 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(foo,blah,g)]
624
625Here no special quoting was necessary. But if now we want to replace either
626"foo" or "bar" with "blah", we'll need the regular expression "(foo|bar)". We
627cannot write:
628
629 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
630
631because we would like the string to cut like this:
632
633 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
634 |---------|----|-|
635 arg1 _/ / /
636 arg2 __________/ /
637 arg3 ______________/
638
639but actually what is passed is a string between the opening and closing
640parenthesis then garbage:
641
642 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
643 |--------|--------|
644 arg1=(foo|bar _/ /
645 trailing garbage _________/
646
647The obvious solution here seems to be that the closing parenthesis needs to be
648quoted, but alone this will not work, because as mentioned above, quotes are
649processed by the top-level parser which will resolve them before processing
650this word:
651
652 http-request set-path %[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
653 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
654 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
655
656So we didn't change anything for the argument parser at the second level which
657still sees a truncated regular expression as the only argument, and garbage at
658the end of the string. By escaping the quotes they will be passed unmodified to
659the second level:
660
661 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(\"(foo|bar)\",blah,g)]
662 ------------ -------- ------------------------------------
663 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
664 |---------||----|-|
665 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
666 arg2=blah ___________/ /
667 arg3=g _______________/
668
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500669Another approach consists in using single quotes outside the whole string and
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100670double quotes inside (so that the double quotes are not stripped again):
671
672 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]'
673 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
674 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
675 |---------||----|-|
676 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
677 arg2 ___________/ /
678 arg3 _______________/
679
680When using regular expressions, it can happen that the dollar ('$') character
681appears in the expression or that a backslash ('\') is used in the replacement
682string. In this case these ones will also be processed inside the double quotes
683thus single quotes are preferred (or double escaping). Example:
684
685 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]'
686 ------------ -------- -----------------------------------------
687 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]
688 |-------------| |-----||-|
689 arg1=(here)(/|$) _/ / /
690 arg2=my/\1 ________________/ /
691 arg3 ______________________/
692
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500693Remember that backslahes are not escape characters within single quotes and
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100694that the whole word3 above is already protected against them using the single
695quotes. Conversely, if double quotes had been used around the whole expression,
696single the dollar character and the backslashes would have been resolved at top
697level, breaking the argument contents at the second level.
698
699When in doubt, simply do not use quotes anywhere, and start to place single or
700double quotes around arguments that require a comma or a closing parenthesis,
701and think about escaping these quotes using a backslash of the string contains
702a dollar or a backslash. Again, this is pretty similar to what is used under
703a Bourne shell when double-escaping a command passed to "eval". For API writers
704the best is probably to place escaped quotes around each and every argument,
705regardless of their contents. Users will probably find that using single quotes
706around the whole expression and double quotes around each argument provides
707more readable configurations.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200708
709
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007102.3. Environment variables
711--------------------------
712
713HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
714interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
715configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
716optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
717shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
Amaury Denoyellefa41cb62020-10-01 14:32:35 +0200718underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit. If the variable contains a
719list of several values separated by spaces, it can be expanded as individual
720arguments by enclosing the variable with braces and appending the suffix '[*]'
721before the closing brace.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200722
723 Example:
724
725 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
726
727 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
728
729 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
730
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200731Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
732file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200733
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200734* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
735 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
736
737* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
738 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
739 directory.
740
741* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
742
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500743* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200744 processes, separated by semicolons.
745
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500746* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200747 CLI, separated by semicolons.
748
749See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200750
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100751
7522.4. Conditional blocks
753-----------------------
754
755It may sometimes be convenient to be able to conditionally enable or disable
756some arbitrary parts of the configuration, for example to enable/disable SSL or
757ciphers, enable or disable some pre-production listeners without modifying the
758configuration, or adjust the configuration's syntax to support two distinct
759versions of HAProxy during a migration.. HAProxy brings a set of nestable
760preprocessor-like directives which allow to integrate or ignore some blocks of
761text. These directives must be placed on their own line and they act on the
762lines that follow them. Two of them support an expression, the other ones only
763switch to an alternate block or end a current level. The 4 following directives
764are defined to form conditional blocks:
765
766 - .if <condition>
767 - .elif <condition>
768 - .else
769 - .endif
770
771The ".if" directive nests a new level, ".elif" stays at the same level, ".else"
772as well, and ".endif" closes a level. Each ".if" must be terminated by a
773matching ".endif". The ".elif" may only be placed after ".if" or ".elif", and
774there is no limit to the number of ".elif" that may be chained. There may be
775only one ".else" per ".if" and it must always be after the ".if" or the last
776".elif" of a block.
777
778Comments may be placed on the same line if needed after a '#', they will be
779ignored. The directives are tokenized like other configuration directives, and
780as such it is possible to use environment variables in conditions.
781
782The conditions are currently limited to:
783
784 - an empty string, always returns "false"
785 - the integer zero ('0'), always returns "false"
786 - a non-nul integer (e.g. '1'), always returns "true".
787
788Other patterns are not supported yet but the purpose is to bring a few
789functions to test for certain build options and supported features.
790
791Three other directives are provided to report some status:
792
793 - .notice "message" : emit this message at level NOTICE
794 - .warning "message" : emit this message at level WARNING
795 - .alert "message" : emit this message at level ALERT
796
797Messages emitted at level WARNING may cause the process to fail to start if the
798"strict-mode" is enabled. Messages emitted at level ALERT will always cause a
799fatal error. These can be used to detect some inappropriate conditions and
800provide advice to the user.
801
802Example:
803
804 .if "${A}"
805 .if "${B}"
806 .notice "A=1, B=1"
807 .elif "${C}"
808 .notice "A=1, B=0, C=1"
809 .elif "${D}"
810 .warning "A=1, B=0, C=0, D=1"
811 .else
812 .alert "A=1, B=0, C=0, D=0"
813 .endif
814 .else
815 .notice "A=0"
816 .endif
817
818
8192.5. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200820----------------
821
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100822Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100823values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
824otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
825numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
826for every keyword. Supported units are :
827
828 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
829 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
830 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
831 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
832 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
833 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
834
835
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +01008362.6. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200837-------------
838
839 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
840 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
841 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
842 global
843 daemon
844 maxconn 256
845
846 defaults
847 mode http
848 timeout connect 5000ms
849 timeout client 50000ms
850 timeout server 50000ms
851
852 frontend http-in
853 bind *:80
854 default_backend servers
855
856 backend servers
857 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
858
859
860 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
861 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
862 global
863 daemon
864 maxconn 256
865
866 defaults
867 mode http
868 timeout connect 5000ms
869 timeout client 50000ms
870 timeout server 50000ms
871
872 listen http-in
873 bind *:80
874 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
875
876
877Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
878
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100879 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200880
881
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008823. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200883--------------------
884
885Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
886are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
887of them have command-line equivalents.
888
889The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
890
891 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200892 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200893 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200894 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200895 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200896 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200897 - description
898 - deviceatlas-json-file
899 - deviceatlas-log-level
900 - deviceatlas-separator
901 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900902 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200903 - gid
904 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100905 - hard-stop-after
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200906 - h1-case-adjust
907 - h1-case-adjust-file
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100908 - insecure-fork-wanted
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100909 - insecure-setuid-wanted
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +0100910 - issuers-chain-path
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +0200911 - localpeer
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200912 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200913 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100914 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200915 - lua-load
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +0100916 - lua-load-per-thread
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +0100917 - lua-prepend-path
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +0200918 - mworker-max-reloads
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200919 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200920 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200921 - node
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +0100922 - numa-cpu-mapping
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200923 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +0200924 - pp2-never-send-local
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100925 - presetenv
926 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200927 - uid
928 - ulimit-n
929 - user
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +0200930 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +0100931 - set-var
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100932 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200933 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200934 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200935 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +0200936 - ssl-default-bind-curves
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200937 - ssl-default-bind-options
938 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200939 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200940 - ssl-default-server-options
941 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100942 - ssl-server-verify
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +0200943 - ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100944 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100945 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100946 - 51degrees-data-file
947 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200948 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200949 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200950 - wurfl-data-file
951 - wurfl-information-list
952 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200953 - wurfl-cache-size
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +0100954 - strict-limits
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100955
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200956 * Performance tuning
William Dauchy0a8824f2019-10-27 20:08:09 +0100957 - busy-polling
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200958 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200959 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200960 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100961 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100962 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100963 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200964 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200965 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200966 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200967 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200968 - noepoll
969 - nokqueue
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +0000970 - noevports
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200971 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100972 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300973 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000974 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +0100975 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200976 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200977 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200978 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +0000979 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +0000980 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200981 - tune.buffers.limit
982 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200983 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200984 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100985 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +0200986 - tune.fd.edge-triggered
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +0200987 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +0200988 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +0200989 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100990 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200991 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200992 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +0200993 - tune.idle-pool.shared
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100994 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100995 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100996 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100997 - tune.lua.session-timeout
998 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200999 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001000 - tune.maxaccept
1001 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001002 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001003 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001004 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaua8e2d972020-07-01 18:27:16 +02001005 - tune.pool-high-fd-ratio
1006 - tune.pool-low-fd-ratio
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001007 - tune.rcvbuf.client
1008 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001009 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001010 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02001011 - tune.sched.low-latency
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001012 - tune.sndbuf.client
1013 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001014 - tune.ssl.cachesize
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02001015 - tune.ssl.keylog
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001016 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001017 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001018 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001019 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001020 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01001021 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001022 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001023 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001024 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
1025 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
1026 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001027 - tune.zlib.memlevel
1028 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001029
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001030 * Debugging
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001031 - quiet
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02001032 - zero-warning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001033
1034
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010353.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001036------------------------------------
1037
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001038ca-base <dir>
1039 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +01001040 relative path is used with "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" or "crl-file"
1041 directives. Absolute locations specified in "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" and
1042 "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001043
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001044chroot <jail dir>
1045 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
1046 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
1047 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
1048 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
1049 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001050 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001051
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001052cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
1053 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
1054 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
1055 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
1056 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
1057 set. These sets have the format
1058
1059 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
1060
1061 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001062 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001063 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
1064 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +01001065 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
1066 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Amaury Denoyelle982fb532021-04-21 18:39:58 +02001067 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number starting at 0 for the first
1068 CPU or a range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Outside of
1069 Linux and BSDs, there may be a limitation on the maximum CPU index to either
1070 31 or 63. Multiple CPU numbers or ranges may be specified, and the processes
1071 or threads will be allowed to bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple
1072 "cpu-map" directives may be specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace
1073 the previous ones when they overlap. A thread will be bound on the
1074 intersection of its mapping and the one of the process on which it is
1075 attached. If the intersection is null, no specific binding will be set for
1076 the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +01001077
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001078 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
1079 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
1080 on the machine's word size.
1081
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001082 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001083 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
1084 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
1085 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
1086 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
1087 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
1088 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001089
1090 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001091 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
1092
1093 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
1094 # first 4 CPUs
1095
1096 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
1097 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
1098 # word size.
1099
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001100 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001101 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001102 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
1103 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
1104 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
1105
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001106 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
1107 # and so on.
1108 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
1109 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
1110 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
1111
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001112 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001113 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
1114 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
1115 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
1116
1117 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
1118 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
1119 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
1120
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001121 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
1122 # and a thread range.
1123 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
1124 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
1125 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
1126
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001127crt-base <dir>
1128 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
William Dauchy238ea3b2020-01-11 13:09:12 +01001129 path is used with "crtfile" or "crt" directives. Absolute locations specified
1130 prevail and ignore "crt-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001131
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001132daemon
1133 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
1134 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +01001135 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
1136 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001137
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001138deviceatlas-json-file <path>
1139 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001140 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001141
1142deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001143 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001144 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
1145
1146deviceatlas-separator <char>
1147 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
1148 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
1149
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +01001150deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001151 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
1152 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
1153 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +01001154
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001155external-check
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001156 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks. This is
1157 disabled by default as a security precaution, and even when enabled, checks
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001158 may still fail unless "insecure-fork-wanted" is enabled as well. If the
1159 program launched makes use of a setuid executable (it should really not),
1160 you may also need to set "insecure-setuid-wanted" in the global section.
1161 See "option external-check", and "insecure-fork-wanted", and
1162 "insecure-setuid-wanted".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001163
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001164gid <number>
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07001165 Changes the process's group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001166 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1167 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +01001168 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
1169 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001170 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001171
Willy Tarreau11770ce2019-12-03 08:29:22 +01001172group <group name>
1173 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
1174 See also "gid" and "user".
1175
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +01001176hard-stop-after <time>
1177 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
1178
1179 Arguments :
1180 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
1181 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
1182 SIGUSR1 signal.
1183
1184 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
1185 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
1186 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
1187
1188 Example:
1189 global
1190 hard-stop-after 30s
1191
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001192h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
1193 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
1194 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
1195 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
1196 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05001197 adjusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001198 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
1199 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
1200 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
1201 specified in a proxy.
1202
1203 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
1204 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
1205 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
1206 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
1207 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
1208 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
1209 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
1210
1211 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
1212 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
1213 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
1214 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
1215 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
1216
1217 Example:
1218 global
1219 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
1220
1221 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1222 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1223
1224h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
1225 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
1226 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
1227 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
1228 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
1229 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
1230 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
1231 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
1232 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
1233
1234 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
1235 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
1236 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
1237
1238 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1239 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1240
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001241insecure-fork-wanted
1242 By default haproxy tries hard to prevent any thread and process creation
1243 after it starts. Doing so is particularly important when using Lua files of
1244 uncertain origin, and when experimenting with development versions which may
1245 still contain bugs whose exploitability is uncertain. And generally speaking
1246 it's good hygiene to make sure that no unexpected background activity can be
1247 triggered by traffic. But this prevents external checks from working, and may
1248 break some very specific Lua scripts which actively rely on the ability to
1249 fork. This option is there to disable this protection. Note that it is a bad
1250 idea to disable it, as a vulnerability in a library or within haproxy itself
1251 will be easier to exploit once disabled. In addition, forking from Lua or
1252 anywhere else is not reliable as the forked process may randomly embed a lock
1253 set by another thread and never manage to finish an operation. As such it is
1254 highly recommended that this option is never used and that any workload
1255 requiring such a fork be reconsidered and moved to a safer solution (such as
1256 agents instead of external checks). This option supports the "no" prefix to
1257 disable it.
1258
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001259insecure-setuid-wanted
1260 HAProxy doesn't need to call executables at run time (except when using
1261 external checks which are strongly recommended against), and is even expected
1262 to isolate itself into an empty chroot. As such, there basically is no valid
1263 reason to allow a setuid executable to be called without the user being fully
1264 aware of the risks. In a situation where haproxy would need to call external
1265 checks and/or disable chroot, exploiting a vulnerability in a library or in
1266 haproxy itself could lead to the execution of an external program. On Linux
1267 it is possible to lock the process so that any setuid bit present on such an
1268 executable is ignored. This significantly reduces the risk of privilege
1269 escalation in such a situation. This is what haproxy does by default. In case
1270 this causes a problem to an external check (for example one which would need
1271 the "ping" command), then it is possible to disable this protection by
1272 explicitly adding this directive in the global section. If enabled, it is
1273 possible to turn it back off by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
1274
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001275issuers-chain-path <dir>
1276 Assigns a directory to load certificate chain for issuer completion. All
1277 files must be in PEM format. For certificates loaded with "crt" or "crt-list",
1278 if certificate chain is not included in PEM (also commonly known as
1279 intermediate certificate), haproxy will complete chain if the issuer of the
1280 certificate corresponds to the first certificate of the chain loaded with
1281 "issuers-chain-path".
1282 A "crt" file with PrivateKey+Certificate+IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1
1283 could be replaced with PrivateKey+Certificate. HAProxy will complete the
1284 chain if a file with IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1 is present in
1285 "issuers-chain-path" directory. All other certificates with the same issuer
1286 will share the chain in memory.
1287
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02001288localpeer <name>
1289 Sets the local instance's peer name. It will be ignored if the "-L"
1290 command line argument is specified or if used after "peers" section
1291 definitions. In such cases, a warning message will be emitted during
1292 the configuration parsing.
1293
1294 This option will also set the HAPROXY_LOCALPEER environment variable.
1295 See also "-L" in the management guide and "peers" section below.
1296
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01001297log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001298 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +01001299 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001300 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001301 configured with "log global".
1302
1303 <address> can be one of:
1304
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01001305 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001306 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1307 port).
1308
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01001309 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
1310 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1311 port).
1312
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001313 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001314 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
1315 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001316 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001317
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001318 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
1319 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
1320 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
1321 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
1322 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
1323 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
1324 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
1325 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
1326 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
1327 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
1328 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow haproxy down
1329 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
1330 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
1331 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001332 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
1333 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001334
1335 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
1336 "fd@2", see above.
1337
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02001338 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond to an
1339 in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the "show events"
1340 command, which will also list existing rings and their sizes. Such
1341 buffers are lost on reload or restart but when used as a complement
1342 this can help troubleshooting by having the logs instantly available.
1343
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001344 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1345 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001346
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001347 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
1348 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
1349 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
1350 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
1351 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
1352 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
1353 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
1354 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
1355 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
1356 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001357 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
1358 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001359
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001360 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
1361 one of the following :
1362
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01001363 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
1364 field is stripped. This is the default.
1365 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
1366 rfc3164.
1367
1368 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001369 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
1370
1371 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
1372 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
1373
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001374 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
1375 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
1376 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1377 designed to be used with a local log server.
1378
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001379 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1380 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
1381 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
1382 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
1383 logger consumes.
1384
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001385 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1386 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
1387 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1388 used with a local log server.
1389
1390 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
1391 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1392 designed to be used with a local log server.
1393
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001394 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
1395 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1396 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
1397 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
1398
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001399 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
1400 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
1401 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
1402 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
1403 set with <sample_size> parameter.
1404
1405 <sample_size>
1406 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
1407 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
1408 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
1409 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
1410 (see also <ranges> parameter).
1411
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001412 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001413
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001414 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
1415 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
1416 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
1417
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001418 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
1419 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
1420 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
1421 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001422
1423 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02001424 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
1425 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1426 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1427 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1428 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1429 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001430
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001431 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001432
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001433log-send-hostname [<string>]
1434 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1435 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1436 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1437 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1438 the logs.
1439
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001440log-tag <string>
1441 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1442 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1443 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001444 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001445
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001446lua-load <file>
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001447 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file in the shared context
1448 that is visible to all threads. Any variable set in such a context is visible
1449 from any thread. This is the easiest and recommended way to load Lua programs
1450 but it will not scale well if a lot of Lua calls are performed, as only one
1451 thread may be running on the global state at a time. A program loaded this
1452 way will always see 0 in the "core.thread" variable. This directive can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001453 used multiple times.
1454
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001455lua-load-per-thread <file>
1456 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file into each started thread.
1457 Any global variable has a thread-local visibility so that each thread could
1458 see a different value. As such it is strongly recommended not to use global
1459 variables in programs loaded this way. An independent copy is loaded and
1460 initialized for each thread, everything is done sequentially and in the
1461 thread's numeric order from 1 to nbthread. If some operations need to be
1462 performed only once, the program should check the "core.thread" variable to
1463 figure what thread is being initialized. Programs loaded this way will run
1464 concurrently on all threads and will be highly scalable. This is the
1465 recommended way to load simple functions that register sample-fetches,
1466 converters, actions or services once it is certain the program doesn't depend
1467 on global variables. For the sake of simplicity, the directive is available
1468 even if only one thread is used and even if threads are disabled (in which
1469 case it will be equivalent to lua-load). This directive can be used multiple
1470 times.
1471
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001472lua-prepend-path <string> [<type>]
1473 Prepends the given string followed by a semicolon to Lua's package.<type>
1474 variable.
1475 <type> must either be "path" or "cpath". If <type> is not given it defaults
1476 to "path".
1477
1478 Lua's paths are semicolon delimited lists of patterns that specify how the
1479 `require` function attempts to find the source file of a library. Question
1480 marks (?) within a pattern will be replaced by module name. The path is
1481 evaluated left to right. This implies that paths that are prepended later
1482 will be checked earlier.
1483
1484 As an example by specifying the following path:
1485
1486 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?/init.lua
1487 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?.lua
1488
1489 When `require "example"` is being called Lua will first attempt to load the
1490 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example.lua script, if that does not exist the
1491 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example/init.lua will be attempted and the default
1492 paths if that does not exist either.
1493
1494 See https://www.lua.org/pil/8.1.html for the details within the Lua
1495 documentation.
1496
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001497master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001498 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1499 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1500 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001501 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001502 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
1503 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001504 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
1505 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
1506 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
1507 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
1508 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001509
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001510 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001511
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001512mworker-max-reloads <number>
1513 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001514 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001515 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
1516 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
1517 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
1518
Willy Tarreauf42d7942020-10-20 11:54:49 +02001519nbproc <number> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001520 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
1521 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
1522 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001523 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. When set to a value
1524 larger than 1, threads are automatically disabled. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
Willy Tarreauf42d7942020-10-20 11:54:49 +02001525 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. This directive is deprecated
1526 and scheduled for removal in 2.5. Please use "nbthread" instead. See also
1527 "daemon" and "nbthread".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001528
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001529nbthread <number>
1530 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreau26f6ae12019-02-02 12:56:15 +01001531 makes haproxy run on <number> threads. This is exclusive with "nbproc". While
1532 "nbproc" historically used to be the only way to use multiple processors, it
1533 also involved a number of shortcomings related to the lack of synchronization
1534 between processes (health-checks, peers, stick-tables, stats, ...) which do
1535 not affect threads. As such, any modern configuration is strongly encouraged
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001536 to migrate away from "nbproc" to "nbthread". "nbthread" also works when
1537 HAProxy is started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity,
1538 when nbproc is not used, the default "nbthread" value is automatically set to
1539 the number of CPUs the process is bound to upon startup. This means that the
1540 thread count can easily be adjusted from the calling process using commands
1541 like "taskset" or "cpuset". Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default
1542 value is reported in the output of "haproxy -vv". See also "nbproc".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001543
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01001544numa-cpu-mapping
1545 By default, if running on Linux, haproxy inspects on startup the CPU topology
1546 of the machine. If a multi-socket machine is detected, the affinity is
1547 automatically calculated to run on the CPUs of a single node. This is done in
1548 order to not suffer from the performance penalties caused by the inter-socket
1549 bus latency. However, if the applied binding is non optimal on a particular
1550 architecture, it can be disabled with the statement 'no numa-cpu-mapping'.
1551 This automatic binding is also not applied if a nbthread statement is present
1552 in the configuration, or the affinity of the process is already specified,
1553 for example via the 'cpu-map' directive or the taskset utility.
1554
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001555pidfile <pidfile>
MIZUTA Takeshic32f3942020-08-26 13:46:19 +09001556 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile> when daemon mode or writes PID
1557 of master process into file <pidfile> when master-worker mode. This option is
1558 equivalent to the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to
1559 the user starting the process. See also "daemon" and "master-worker".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001560
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02001561pp2-never-send-local
1562 A bug in the PROXY protocol v2 implementation was present in HAProxy up to
1563 version 2.1, causing it to emit a PROXY command instead of a LOCAL command
1564 for health checks. This is particularly minor but confuses some servers'
1565 logs. Sadly, the bug was discovered very late and revealed that some servers
1566 which possibly only tested their PROXY protocol implementation against
1567 HAProxy fail to properly handle the LOCAL command, and permanently remain in
1568 the "down" state when HAProxy checks them. When this happens, it is possible
1569 to enable this global option to revert to the older (bogus) behavior for the
1570 time it takes to contact the affected components' vendors and get them fixed.
1571 This option is disabled by default and acts on all servers having the
1572 "send-proxy-v2" statement.
1573
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001574presetenv <name> <value>
1575 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1576 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1577 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1578 and "unsetenv".
1579
1580resetenv [<name> ...]
1581 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1582 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1583 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1584 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1585 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1586 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1587 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1588 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1589
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001590stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001591 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
1592 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
1593 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
1594 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
1595 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
1596 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001597 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001598 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1599 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1600 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1601 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001602
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001603server-state-base <directory>
1604 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001605 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1606 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001607
1608server-state-file <file>
1609 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1610 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1611 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1612 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1613 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1614 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1615 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1616 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001617 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1618 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001619
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01001620set-var <var-name> <expr>
1621 Sets the process-wide variable '<var-name>' to the result of the evaluation
1622 of the sample expression <expr>. The variable '<var-name>' may only be a
1623 process-wide variable (using the 'proc.' prefix). It works exactly like the
1624 'set-var' action in TCP or HTTP rules except that the expression is evaluated
1625 at configuration parsing time and that the variable is instantly set. The
1626 sample fetch functions and converters permitted in the expression are only
1627 those using internal data, typically 'int(value)' or 'str(value)'. It's is
1628 possible to reference previously allocated variables as well. These variables
1629 will then be readable (and modifiable) from the regular rule sets.
1630
1631 Example:
1632 global
1633 set-var proc.current_state str(primary)
1634 set-var proc.prio int(100)
1635 set-var proc.threshold int(200),sub(proc.prio)
1636
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001637setenv <name> <value>
1638 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1639 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1640 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1641 and "unsetenv".
1642
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001643set-dumpable
1644 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
William Dauchyec730982019-10-27 20:08:10 +01001645 developer's request. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly
1646 disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It has no impact on
1647 performance nor stability but will try hard to re-enable core dumps that were
1648 possibly disabled by file size limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations
1649 (ulimit -c), or "dumpability" of a process after changing its UID/GID (such
1650 as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by
1651 the current directory's permissions (check what directory the file is started
1652 from), the chroot directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily
1653 disable the chroot directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location),
1654 or any other system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are
1655 notorious for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable
1656 not even installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often,
1657 simply writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the
1658 issue. When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to
1659 re-appear, it's often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by
1660 issuing, for example, "kill -11" to the haproxy process and verify that it
1661 leaves a core where expected when dying.
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001662
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001663ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1664 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1665 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001666 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001667 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001668 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1669 information and recommendations see e.g.
1670 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1671 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1672 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1673 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001674
1675ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1676 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1677 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1678 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1679 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1680 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001681 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1682 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1683 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001684 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001685
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001686ssl-default-bind-curves <curves>
1687 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1688 the default string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve
1689 suite") that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format
1690 of the string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
1691 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
1692
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001693ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1694 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1695 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1696 keyword to see available options.
1697
1698 Example:
1699 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001700 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001701
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001702ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1703 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1704 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001705 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001706 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001707 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1708 information and recommendations see e.g.
1709 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1710 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1711 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1712 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1713 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001714
1715ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1716 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1717 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1718 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1719 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1720 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001721 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1722 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1723 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1724 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001725
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001726ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1727 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1728 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1729 keyword to see available options.
1730
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001731ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1732 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1733 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1734 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001735 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001736 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001737 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1738 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1739 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1740 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001741 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1742 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1743 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1744
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001745ssl-load-extra-del-ext
1746 This setting allows to configure the way HAProxy does the lookup for the
1747 extra SSL files. By default HAProxy adds a new extension to the filename.
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02001748 (ex: with "foobar.crt" load "foobar.crt.key"). With this option enabled,
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001749 HAProxy removes the extension before adding the new one (ex: with
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02001750 "foobar.crt" load "foobar.key").
1751
1752 Your crt file must have a ".crt" extension for this option to work.
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001753
1754 This option is not compatible with bundle extensions (.ecdsa, .rsa. .dsa)
1755 and won't try to remove them.
1756
1757 This option is disabled by default. See also "ssl-load-extra-files".
1758
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001759ssl-load-extra-files <none|all|bundle|sctl|ocsp|issuer|key>*
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001760 This setting alters the way HAProxy will look for unspecified files during
Jerome Magnin587be9c2020-09-07 11:55:57 +02001761 the loading of the SSL certificates associated to "bind" lines. It does not
1762 apply to certificates used for client authentication on "server" lines.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001763
1764 By default, HAProxy discovers automatically a lot of files not specified in
1765 the configuration, and you may want to disable this behavior if you want to
1766 optimize the startup time.
1767
1768 "none": Only load the files specified in the configuration. Don't try to load
1769 a certificate bundle if the file does not exist. In the case of a directory,
1770 it won't try to bundle the certificates if they have the same basename.
1771
1772 "all": This is the default behavior, it will try to load everything,
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001773 bundles, sctl, ocsp, issuer, key.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001774
1775 "bundle": When a file specified in the configuration does not exist, HAProxy
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001776 will try to load a "cert bundle".
1777
1778 Starting from HAProxy 2.3, the bundles are not loaded in the same OpenSSL
1779 certificate store, instead it will loads each certificate in a separate
1780 store which is equivalent to declaring multiple "crt". OpenSSL 1.1.1 is
1781 required to achieve this. Which means that bundles are now used only for
1782 backward compatibility and are not mandatory anymore to do an hybrid RSA/ECC
1783 bind configuration..
1784
1785 To associate these PEM files into a "cert bundle" that is recognized by
1786 haproxy, they must be named in the following way: All PEM files that are to
1787 be bundled must have the same base name, with a suffix indicating the key
1788 type. Currently, three suffixes are supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For
1789 example, if www.example.com has two PEM files, an RSA file and an ECDSA
1790 file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa" and "example.pem.ecdsa". The
1791 first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the suffix matters. To load
1792 this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
1793
1794 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
1795
1796 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
1797 a cert bundle.
1798
1799 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle as if they were configured
1800 separately in several "crt".
1801
1802 The bundle loading does not have an impact anymore on the directory loading
1803 since files are loading separately.
1804
1805 On the CLI, bundles are seen as separate files, and the bundle extension is
1806 required to commit them.
1807
William Dauchy57dd6f12020-10-06 15:22:37 +02001808 OCSP files (.ocsp), issuer files (.issuer), Certificate Transparency (.sctl)
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001809 as well as private keys (.key) are supported with multi-cert bundling.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001810
1811 "sctl": Try to load "<basename>.sctl" for each crt keyword.
1812
1813 "ocsp": Try to load "<basename>.ocsp" for each crt keyword.
1814
1815 "issuer": Try to load "<basename>.issuer" if the issuer of the OCSP file is
1816 not provided in the PEM file.
1817
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001818 "key": If the private key was not provided by the PEM file, try to load a
1819 file "<basename>.key" containing a private key.
1820
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001821 The default behavior is "all".
1822
1823 Example:
1824 ssl-load-extra-files bundle sctl
1825 ssl-load-extra-files sctl ocsp issuer
1826 ssl-load-extra-files none
1827
1828 See also: "crt", section 5.1 about bind options.
1829
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001830ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1831 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1832 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1833 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1834
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001835ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04001836 Self issued CA, aka x509 root CA, is the anchor for chain validation: as a
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001837 server is useless to send it, client must have it. Standard configuration
1838 need to not include such CA in PEM file. This option allows you to keep such
1839 CA in PEM file without sending it to the client. Use case is to provide
1840 issuer for ocsp without the need for '.issuer' file and be able to share it
1841 with 'issuers-chain-path'. This concerns all certificates without intermediate
1842 certificates. It's useless for BoringSSL, .issuer is ignored because ocsp
William Lallemand9a1d8392020-08-10 17:28:23 +02001843 bits does not need it. Requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.2.
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001844
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001845stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1846 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1847 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1848 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001849 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001850 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001851
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001852 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1853 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1854 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001855
1856stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1857 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1858 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001859 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001860
1861stats maxconn <connections>
1862 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1863 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1864
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001865uid <number>
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07001866 Changes the process's user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001867 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1868 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
1869 one. See also "gid" and "user".
1870
1871ulimit-n <number>
1872 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
1873 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
1874 option.
1875
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001876unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
1877 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
1878
1879 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
1880 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
1881 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
1882 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
1883 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
1884 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
1885 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
1886 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
1887 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
1888 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
1889
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001890unsetenv [<name> ...]
1891 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
1892 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
1893 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
1894 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
1895 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
1896 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
1897 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
1898
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001899user <user name>
1900 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
1901 See also "uid" and "group".
1902
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02001903node <name>
1904 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
1905
1906 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
1907 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
1908 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
1909 traffic.
1910
1911description <text>
1912 Add a text that describes the instance.
1913
1914 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1915 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1916 "<" and ">" characters.
1917
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100191851degrees-data-file <file path>
1919 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001920 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001921
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001922 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001923 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1924
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000192551degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001926 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1927 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1928 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1929
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001930 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001931 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1932
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200193351degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001934 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1935 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1936
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001937 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1938 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1939
194051degrees-cache-size <number>
1941 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1942 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1943 By default, this cache is disabled.
1944
1945 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001946 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1947
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001948wurfl-data-file <file path>
1949 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1950 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1951
1952 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1953 with USE_WURFL=1.
1954
1955wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1956 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1957 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1958 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1959
1960 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1961
1962 Valid WURFL properties are:
1963 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1964
1965 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1966 device.
1967
1968 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1969 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1970
1971 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1972 particular web request.
1973
1974 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1975 used Libwurfl API version.
1976
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001977 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1978 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1979
1980 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1981 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1982
1983 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1984
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001985 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1986 with USE_WURFL=1.
1987
1988wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1989 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1990 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1991
1992 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1993 with USE_WURFL=1.
1994
1995wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1996 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1997 thus before the chroot.
1998
1999 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
2000 with USE_WURFL=1.
2001
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02002002wurfl-cache-size <size>
2003 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
2004 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002005 - "0" : no cache is used.
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02002006 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002007
2008 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
2009 with USE_WURFL=1.
2010
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01002011strict-limits
William Dauchya5194602020-03-28 19:29:58 +01002012 Makes process fail at startup when a setrlimit fails. Haproxy tries to set the
2013 best setrlimit according to what has been calculated. If it fails, it will
2014 emit a warning. This option is here to guarantee an explicit failure of
2015 haproxy when those limits fail. It is enabled by default. It may still be
2016 forcibly disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01002017
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020183.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002019-----------------------
2020
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01002021busy-polling
2022 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
2023 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
2024 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
2025 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
2026 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
2027 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
2028 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
2029 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
2030 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
2031 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
2032 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
2033 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
2034 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
2035 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
2036 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
2037 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
2038 "poll" pollers.
2039
William Dauchy3894d972019-12-28 15:36:02 +01002040 This option is automatically disabled on old processes in the context of
2041 seamless reload; it avoids too much cpu conflicts when multiple processes
2042 stay around for some time waiting for the end of their current connections.
2043
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02002044max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
2045 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
2046 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
2047 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
2048 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
2049 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
2050 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
2051 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
2052 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
2053
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002054maxconn <number>
2055 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
2056 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
2057 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02002058 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
2059 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
2060 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
2061 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01002062 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
2063 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
2064 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
2065 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
2066 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
2067 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002068
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02002069maxconnrate <number>
2070 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
2071 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
2072 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
2073 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
2074 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
2075 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
2076 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
2077 fairness.
2078
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01002079maxcomprate <number>
2080 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002081 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01002082 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
2083 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
2084 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002085 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01002086 default value.
2087
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01002088maxcompcpuusage <number>
2089 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
2090 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
2091 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
2092 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
2093 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
2094 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
2095 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
2096 process down and from introducing high latencies.
2097
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002098maxpipes <number>
2099 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
2100 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
2101 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
2102 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
2103 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
2104 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
2105
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02002106maxsessrate <number>
2107 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
2108 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
2109 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
2110 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
2111 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
2112 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
2113 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
2114 fairness.
2115
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002116maxsslconn <number>
2117 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
2118 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
2119 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
2120 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
2121 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
2122 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
2123 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01002124 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
2125 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
2126 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
2127 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
2128 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
2129 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
2130 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002131
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02002132maxsslrate <number>
2133 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
2134 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
2135 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
2136 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
2137 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
2138 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
2139 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
2140 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
2141 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
2142 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
2143
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01002144maxzlibmem <number>
2145 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
2146 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
2147 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01002148 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
2149 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
2150 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
2151
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002152noepoll
2153 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
2154 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01002155 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002156
2157nokqueue
2158 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
2159 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
2160 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
2161
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002162noevports
2163 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
2164 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
2165 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
2166 also "nopoll".
2167
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002168nopoll
2169 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
2170 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002171 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002172 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
2173 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002174
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002175nosplice
2176 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002177 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002178 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002179 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002180 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
2181 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
2182 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
2183 "option splice-response".
2184
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002185nogetaddrinfo
2186 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
2187 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
2188
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00002189noreuseport
2190 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
2191 command line argument "-dR".
2192
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002193profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
2194 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
2195 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
2196 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
2197 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002198 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002199 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
2200 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
2201 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
2202 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
2203
2204 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
2205 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
2206 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
2207 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
2208 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01002209 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
2210 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
2211 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
2212 CLI.
2213
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002214spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09002215 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
2216 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
2217 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
2218 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
2219 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
2220 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002221
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002222ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002223 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002224 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002225 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
2226 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
2227 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
2228 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
2229 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002230 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
2231 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002232 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
2233 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
2234 openssl configuration file uses:
2235 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
2236
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002237ssl-mode-async
2238 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02002239 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002240 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
2241 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
2242 haproxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002243 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002244 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002245
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002246tune.buffers.limit <number>
2247 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
2248 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
2249 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
2250 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
2251 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002252 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002253 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
2254 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
2255 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
2256 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
2257 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
2258 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
2259 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
2260 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
2261 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
2262
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01002263tune.buffers.reserve <number>
2264 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
2265 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
2266 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
2267 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
2268
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002269tune.bufsize <number>
2270 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
2271 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
2272 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
2273 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
2274 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
2275 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
2276 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01002277 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
2278 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
2279 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04002280 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01002281 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
2282 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
2283 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002284
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +01002285tune.chksize <number> (deprecated)
2286 This option is deprecated and ignored.
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02002287
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01002288tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
2289 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
2290 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
2291 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
2292 this value. The default value is 1.
2293
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01002294tune.fail-alloc
2295 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
2296 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
2297 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
2298 gracefully.
2299
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02002300tune.fd.edge-triggered { on | off } [ EXPERIMENTAL ]
2301 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the edge-triggered polling mode for FDs
2302 that support it. This is currently only support with epoll. It may noticeably
2303 reduce the number of epoll_ctl() calls and slightly improve performance in
2304 certain scenarios. This is still experimental, it may result in frozen
2305 connections if bugs are still present, and is disabled by default.
2306
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02002307tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
2308 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
2309 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
2310 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
2311 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
2312 change it.
2313
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002314tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
2315 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002316 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from haproxy. This setting
2317 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002318 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
2319 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
2320 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
2321 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
2322 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
2323
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02002324tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
2325 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
2326 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
2327 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
2328 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
2329 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
2330 client may create as many streams as allocatable by haproxy. It is highly
2331 recommended not to change this value.
2332
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002333tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
2334 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that haproxy announces it is willing to
2335 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
2336 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, haproxy will not announce support
2337 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
2338 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
2339 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
2340 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
2341
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002342tune.http.cookielen <number>
2343 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
2344 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
2345 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
2346 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
2347 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
2348 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
2349 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
2350 to change this value.
2351
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002352tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002353 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
2354 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002355 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002356 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002357 configuration directives too.
2358 The default value is 1024.
2359
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002360tune.http.maxhdr <number>
2361 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
2362 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
2363 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
2364 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
2365 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
2366 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02002367 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
2368 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
2369 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002370
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02002371tune.idle-pool.shared { on | off }
2372 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') sharing of idle connection pools between
2373 threads for a same server. The default is to share them between threads in
2374 order to minimize the number of persistent connections to a server, and to
2375 optimize the connection reuse rate. But to help with debugging or when
2376 suspecting a bug in HAProxy around connection reuse, it can be convenient to
2377 forcefully disable this idle pool sharing between multiple threads, and force
Willy Tarreau0784db82021-02-19 11:45:22 +01002378 this option to "off". The default is on. It is strongly recommended against
2379 disabling this option without setting a conservative value on "pool-low-conn"
2380 for all servers relying on connection reuse to achieve a high performance
2381 level, otherwise connections might be closed very often as the thread count
2382 increases.
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02002383
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002384tune.idletimer <timeout>
2385 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
2386 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
2387 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
2388 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
2389 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
2390 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002391 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002392 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002393 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
2394
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01002395tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
2396 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
2397 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
2398 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
2399 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
2400 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
2401 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
2402 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
2403 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
2404 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
2405
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002406tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
2407 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01002408 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002409 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
2410 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002411 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002412 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
2413 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
2414
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01002415tune.lua.maxmem
2416 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
2417 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
2418 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
2419 memory.
2420
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002421tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
2422 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002423 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2424 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002425 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002426
2427tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
2428 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
2429 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
2430 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
2431 check servers.
2432
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002433tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
2434 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
2435 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2436 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002437 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002438
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002439tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01002440 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
2441 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
Willy Tarreau66161322021-02-19 15:50:27 +01002442 used to give better performance at high connection rates, though this is not
2443 the case anymore with the multi-queue. This value applies individually to
2444 each listener, so that the number of processes a listener is bound to is
2445 taken into account. This value defaults to 4 which showed best results. If a
2446 significantly higher value was inherited from an ancient config, it might be
2447 worth removing it as it will both increase performance and lower response
2448 time. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice the number of processes
2449 the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1 completely disables the
2450 limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002451
2452tune.maxpollevents <number>
2453 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
2454 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
2455 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
2456 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
2457 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
2458
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002459tune.maxrewrite <number>
2460 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
2461 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
2462 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
2463 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
2464 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
2465 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
2466 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
2467 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
2468 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
2469 bufsize.
2470
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002471tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
2472 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
2473 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
2474 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
2475 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
2476 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
2477 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
2478 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
2479 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
2480 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau403bfbb2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02002481 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
2482 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002483 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
2484 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
2485 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
2486 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
2487 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
2488 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
2489 setting this parameter to 0.
2490
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02002491tune.pipesize <number>
2492 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
2493 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
2494 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
2495 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
2496 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
2497 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
2498
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002499tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
2500 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
2501 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
2502 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
2503 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
2504 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
2505 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002506 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002507
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02002508tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
2509 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
2510 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
2511 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
2512 default is 20.
2513
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002514tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
2515tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
2516 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
2517 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2518 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002519 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002520 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002521 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2522 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2523
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002524tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002525 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002526 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
2527 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
2528 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
2529 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
2530
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002531tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002532 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Willy Tarreau060a7612021-03-10 11:06:26 +01002533 tasks. The default value depends on the number of threads but sits between 35
2534 and 280, which tend to show the highest request rates and lowest latencies.
2535 Increasing it may incur latency when dealing with I/Os, making it too small
2536 can incur extra overhead. Higher thread counts benefit from lower values.
2537 When experimenting with much larger values, it may be useful to also enable
2538 tune.sched.low-latency and possibly tune.fd.edge-triggered to limit the
2539 maximum latency to the lowest possible.
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02002540
2541tune.sched.low-latency { on | off }
2542 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the low-latency task scheduler. By default
2543 haproxy processes tasks from several classes one class at a time as this is
2544 the most efficient. But when running with large values of tune.runqueue-depth
2545 this can have a measurable effect on request or connection latency. When this
2546 low-latency setting is enabled, tasks of lower priority classes will always
2547 be executed before other ones if they exist. This will permit to lower the
2548 maximum latency experienced by new requests or connections in the middle of
2549 massive traffic, at the expense of a higher impact on this large traffic.
2550 For regular usage it is better to leave this off. The default value is off.
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002551
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002552tune.sndbuf.client <number>
2553tune.sndbuf.server <number>
2554 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
2555 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2556 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002557 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002558 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002559 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2560 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2561 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
2562 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
2563 notifying haproxy again.
2564
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002565tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002566 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
William Dauchy9a4bbfe2021-02-12 15:58:46 +01002567 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate. An
2568 encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks depending
2569 on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately 200 bytes of
2570 memory (based on `sizeof(struct sh_ssl_sess_hdr) + SHSESS_BLOCK_MIN_SIZE`
2571 calculation used for `shctx_init` function). The default value may be forced
2572 at build time, otherwise defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most
2573 idle entries are purged and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence
2574 of such a purge, hence the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring
2575 that all users keep their session as long as possible. All entries are
2576 pre-allocated upon startup and are shared between all processes if "nbproc"
2577 is greater than 1. Setting this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002578
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002579tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02002580 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002581 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
2582 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
2583 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
2584 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
2585 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
2586
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002587tune.ssl.keylog { on | off }
2588 This option activates the logging of the TLS keys. It should be used with
2589 care as it will consume more memory per SSL session and could decrease
2590 performances. This is disabled by default.
2591
2592 These sample fetches should be used to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE that is
2593 required to decipher traffic with wireshark.
2594
2595 https://developer.mozilla.org/en-US/docs/Mozilla/Projects/NSS/Key_Log_Format
2596
2597 The SSLKEYLOG is a series of lines which are formatted this way:
2598
2599 <Label> <space> <ClientRandom> <space> <Secret>
2600
2601 The ClientRandom is provided by the %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] sample
2602 fetch, the secret and the Label could be find in the array below. You need
2603 to generate a SSLKEYLOGFILE with all the labels in this array.
2604
2605 The following sample fetches are hexadecimal strings and does not need to be
2606 converted.
2607
2608 SSLKEYLOGFILE Label | Sample fetches for the Secrets
2609 --------------------------------|-----------------------------------------
2610 CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret]
2611 CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret]
2612 SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret]
2613 CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0]
2614 SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0]
William Lallemandd742b6c2020-07-07 10:14:56 +02002615 EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_exporter_secret]
2616 EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret]
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002617
2618 This is only available with OpenSSL 1.1.1, and useful with TLS1.3 session.
2619
2620 If you want to generate the content of a SSLKEYLOGFILE with TLS < 1.3, you
2621 only need this line:
2622
2623 "CLIENT_RANDOM %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] %[ssl_fc_session_key,hex]"
2624
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002625tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
2626 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002627 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002628 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
2629 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
2630 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
2631 being used for too long.
2632
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002633tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
2634 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
2635 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
2636 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
2637 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
2638 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
2639 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
2640 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
2641 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
2642 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
2643 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002644 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002645 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002646
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002647tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
2648 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
2649 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
2650 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
2651 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
Willy Tarreau3ba77d22020-05-08 09:31:18 +02002652 this maximum value. Default value if 2048. Only 1024 or higher values are
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002653 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
2654 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002655 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
2656 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002657
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02002658tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
2659 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
2660 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
2661 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
2662 1000 entries.
2663
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01002664tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
2665 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
2666 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
2667 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
2668
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002669tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002670tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002671tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
2672tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
2673tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002674 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
2675 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
2676 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
2677 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
2678 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
2679 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
2680 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
2681 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002682
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01002683 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
2684 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
2685 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
2686 all available space is consumed.
2687 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
2688 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
2689 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002690
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002691tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
2692 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002693 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002694 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002695 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002696 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
2697
2698tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
2699 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
2700 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002701 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
2702 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002703
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020027043.3. Debugging
2705--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002706
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002707quiet
2708 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
2709 line argument "-q".
2710
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02002711zero-warning
2712 When this option is set, haproxy will refuse to start if any warning was
2713 emitted while processing the configuration. It is highly recommended to set
2714 this option on configurations that are not changed often, as it helps detect
2715 subtle mistakes and keep the configuration clean and forward-compatible. Note
2716 that "haproxy -c" will also report errors in such a case. This option is
2717 equivalent to command line argument "-dW".
2718
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002719
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010027203.4. Userlists
2721--------------
2722It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
2723http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
2724it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
2725
2726userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002727 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002728 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
2729
2730group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002731 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002732 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
2733 proceeded by "users" keyword.
2734
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002735user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
2736 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002737 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
2738 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002739 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
2740 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
2741 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
2742 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002743
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002744 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
2745 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
2746 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
2747 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
2748 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
2749 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
2750 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
2751 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in haproxy's
2752 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002753
2754 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002755 userlist L1
2756 group G1 users tiger,scott
2757 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002758
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002759 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
2760 user scott insecure-password elgato
2761 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002762
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002763 userlist L2
2764 group G1
2765 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002766
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002767 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
2768 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
2769 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002770
2771 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002772
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002773
27743.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002775----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002776It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
2777several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
2778instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
2779values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
2780automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
2781In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
2782using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
2783tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
2784reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
2785Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
2786that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
2787each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002788
2789peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002790 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002791 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
2792
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002793bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2794 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
2795 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
2796
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002797disabled
2798 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
2799 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
2800 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
2801
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002802default-bind [param*]
2803 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
2804
2805default-server [param*]
2806 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
2807
2808 Arguments:
2809 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2810 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2811 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2812 details.
2813
2814
2815 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
2816
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002817enable
2818 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
2819
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01002820log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailleb6f759b2019-11-05 09:57:45 +01002821 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
2822 "peers" sections support the same "log" keyword as for the proxies to
2823 log information about the "peers" listener. See "log" option for proxies for
2824 more details.
2825
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002826peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002827 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
2828 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02002829 using "-L" command line option or "localpeer" global configuration setting),
2830 haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer connection on <ip>:<port>.
2831 Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to in order to join the
2832 remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to identify and
2833 validate the remote peer on the server side.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002834
2835 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
2836 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
2837
2838 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02002839 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument or the "localpeer"
2840 global configuration setting to change the local peer name. This makes it
2841 easier to maintain coherent configuration files across all peers.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002842
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002843 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
2844 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002845
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002846 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
2847 "server" keyword explanation below).
2848
2849server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02002850 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002851 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
2852 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
2853 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
2854 of this "peers" section).
2855 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
2856
2857
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002858 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002859 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002860 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002861 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
2862 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
2863 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002864
2865 backend mybackend
2866 mode tcp
2867 balance roundrobin
2868 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
2869 stick on src
2870
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002871 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2872 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002873
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002874 Example:
2875 peers mypeers
2876 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
2877 default-server ssl verify none
2878 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
2879 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002880
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002881
2882table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
2883 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
2884
2885 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
2886 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002887 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002888 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
2889 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
2890 "stick-table" keyword).
2891
2892 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
2893 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
2894 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
2895 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
2896 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
2897 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
2898 of the stick-table name as follows:
2899
2900 peers mypeers
2901 peer A ...
2902 peer B ...
2903 table t1 ...
2904
2905 frontend fe1
2906 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
2907
2908 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
2909 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
2910
2911 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
2912 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
2913 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
2914 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
2915 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
2916 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
2917 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
2918
2919 peers mypeers
2920 peer A ...
2921 peer B ...
2922 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
2923
2924 backend t1
2925 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
2926
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04002927 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002928 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
2929 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
2930
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090029313.6. Mailers
2932------------
2933It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
2934If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
2935in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
2936
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02002937mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002938 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
2939 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
2940
2941mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
2942 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
2943
2944 Example:
2945 mailers mymailers
2946 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
2947 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
2948
2949 backend mybackend
2950 mode tcp
2951 balance roundrobin
2952
2953 email-alert mailers mymailers
2954 email-alert from test1@horms.org
2955 email-alert to test2@horms.org
2956
2957 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2958 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
2959
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01002960timeout mail <time>
2961 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
2962 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
2963 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
2964 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
2965
2966 Example:
2967 mailers mymailers
2968 timeout mail 20s
2969 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002970
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020029713.7. Programs
2972-------------
2973In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
2974master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
2975managed the same way as the workers.
2976
2977During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
2978sequence as a worker:
2979
2980 - the master is re-executed
2981 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
2982 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
2983 instance of the program
2984
2985During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
2986
2987program <name>
2988 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
2989 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
2990 the management guide).
2991
2992command <command> [arguments*]
2993 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
2994 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
2995 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
2996 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
2997
Andrew Heberle97236962019-07-12 11:50:26 +08002998user <user name>
2999 Changes the executed command user ID to the <user name> from /etc/passwd.
3000 See also "group".
3001
3002group <group name>
3003 Changes the executed command group ID to the <group name> from /etc/group.
3004 See also "user".
3005
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +02003006option start-on-reload
3007no option start-on-reload
3008 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
3009 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
3010 program section.
3011
3012
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +010030133.8. HTTP-errors
3014----------------
3015
3016It is possible to globally declare several groups of HTTP errors, to be
3017imported afterwards in any proxy section. Same group may be referenced at
3018several places and can be fully or partially imported.
3019
3020http-errors <name>
3021 Create a new http-errors group with the name <name>. It is an independent
3022 section that may be referenced by one or more proxies using its name.
3023
3024errorfile <code> <file>
3025 Associate a file contents to an HTTP error code
3026
3027 Arguments :
3028 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02003029 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01003030 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003031
3032 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
3033 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
3034 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
3035 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3036 before any chroot is performed.
3037
3038 Please referrers to "errorfile" keyword in section 4 for details.
3039
3040 Example:
3041 http-errors website-1
3042 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/400.http
3043 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/404.http
3044 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
3045
3046 http-errors website-2
3047 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/400.http
3048 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/404.http
3049 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
3050
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +020030513.9. Rings
3052----------
3053
3054It is possible to globally declare ring-buffers, to be used as target for log
3055servers or traces.
3056
3057ring <ringname>
3058 Creates a new ring-buffer with name <ringname>.
3059
3060description <text>
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04003061 The description is an optional description string of the ring. It will
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003062 appear on CLI. By default, <name> is reused to fill this field.
3063
3064format <format>
3065 Format used to store events into the ring buffer.
3066
3067 Arguments:
3068 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
3069 one of the following :
3070
3071 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
3072 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
3073 designed to be used with a local log server.
3074
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01003075 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
3076 field is stripped. This is the default.
3077 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
3078 rfc3164.
3079
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003080 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
3081 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
3082 used in containers or during development, where the severity
3083 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr). This
3084 is the default.
3085
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01003086 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003087 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
3088
3089 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
3090 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
3091
3092 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
3093 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
3094 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
3095 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
3096 logger consumes.
3097
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02003098 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between angle
3099 brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time,
3100 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used
3101 with a local log server.
3102
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003103 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
3104 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
3105 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
3106 used with a local log server.
3107
3108maxlen <length>
3109 The maximum length of an event message stored into the ring,
3110 including formatted header. If an event message is longer than
3111 <length>, it will be truncated to this length.
3112
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003113server <name> <address> [param*]
3114 Used to configure a syslog tcp server to forward messages from ring buffer.
3115 This supports for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph. Some of
3116 these parameters are irrelevant for "ring" sections. Important point: there
3117 is little reason to add more than one server to a ring, because all servers
3118 will receive the exact same copy of the ring contents, and as such the ring
3119 will progress at the speed of the slowest server. If one server does not
3120 respond, it will prevent old messages from being purged and may block new
3121 messages from being inserted into the ring. The proper way to send messages
3122 to multiple servers is to use one distinct ring per log server, not to
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02003123 attach multiple servers to the same ring. Note that specific server directive
3124 "log-proto" is used to set the protocol used to send messages.
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003125
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003126size <size>
3127 This is the optional size in bytes for the ring-buffer. Default value is
3128 set to BUFSIZE.
3129
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003130timeout connect <timeout>
3131 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
3132
3133 Arguments :
3134 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
3135 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3136 as explained at the top of this document.
3137
3138timeout server <timeout>
3139 Set the maximum time for pending data staying into output buffer.
3140
3141 Arguments :
3142 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
3143 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3144 as explained at the top of this document.
3145
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003146 Example:
3147 global
3148 log ring@myring local7
3149
3150 ring myring
3151 description "My local buffer"
3152 format rfc3164
3153 maxlen 1200
3154 size 32764
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003155 timeout connect 5s
3156 timeout server 10s
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02003157 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:6514 log-proto octet-count
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003158
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +020031593.10. Log forwarding
3160-------------------
3161
3162It is possible to declare one or multiple log forwarding section,
3163haproxy will forward all received log messages to a log servers list.
3164
3165log-forward <name>
3166 Creates a new log forwarder proxy identified as <name>.
3167
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003168backlog <conns>
3169 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3170 on connections accept.
3171
3172bind <addr> [param*]
3173 Used to configure a stream log listener to receive messages to forward.
Emeric Brunda46c1c2020-10-08 08:39:02 +02003174 This supports the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph including
3175 those about ssl but some statements such as "alpn" may be irrelevant for
3176 syslog protocol over TCP.
3177 Those listeners support both "Octet Counting" and "Non-Transparent-Framing"
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003178 modes as defined in rfc-6587.
3179
Willy Tarreau76aaa7f2020-09-16 15:07:22 +02003180dgram-bind <addr> [param*]
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003181 Used to configure a datagram log listener to receive messages to forward.
3182 Addresses must be in IPv4 or IPv6 form,followed by a port. This supports
3183 for some of the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph among which
3184 "interface", "namespace" or "transparent", the other ones being
Willy Tarreau26ff5da2020-09-16 15:22:19 +02003185 silently ignored as irrelevant for UDP/syslog case.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003186
3187log global
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01003188log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003189 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
3190 Used to configure target log servers. See more details on proxies
3191 documentation.
3192 If no format specified, haproxy tries to keep the incoming log format.
3193 Configured facility is ignored, except if incoming message does not
3194 present a facility but one is mandatory on the outgoing format.
3195 If there is no timestamp available in the input format, but the field
3196 exists in output format, haproxy will use the local date.
3197
3198 Example:
3199 global
3200 log stderr format iso local7
3201
3202 ring myring
3203 description "My local buffer"
3204 format rfc5424
3205 maxlen 1200
3206 size 32764
3207 timeout connect 5s
3208 timeout server 10s
3209 # syslog tcp server
3210 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:514 log-proto octet-count
3211
3212 log-forward sylog-loadb
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003213 dgram-bind 127.0.0.1:1514
3214 bind 127.0.0.1:1514
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003215 # all messages on stderr
3216 log global
3217 # all messages on local tcp syslog server
3218 log ring@myring local0
3219 # load balance messages on 4 udp syslog servers
3220 log 127.0.0.1:10001 sample 1:4 local0
3221 log 127.0.0.1:10002 sample 2:4 local0
3222 log 127.0.0.1:10003 sample 3:4 local0
3223 log 127.0.0.1:10004 sample 4:4 local0
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003224
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003225maxconn <conns>
3226 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a log forwarder.
3227 10 is the default.
3228
3229timeout client <timeout>
3230 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
3231
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020032324. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003233----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003234
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003235Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01003236 - defaults [<name>] [ from <defaults_name> ]
3237 - frontend <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
3238 - backend <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
3239 - listen <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003240
3241A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
3242connections.
3243
3244A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
3245to forward incoming connections.
3246
3247A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
3248parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
3249
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01003250A "defaults" section resets all settings to the documented ones and presets new
3251ones for use by subsequent sections. All of "frontend", "backend" and "listen"
3252sections always take their initial settings from a defaults section, by default
3253the latest one that appears before the newly created section. It is possible to
3254explicitly designate a specific "defaults" section to load the initial settings
3255from by indicating its name on the section line after the optional keyword
3256"from". While "defaults" section do not impose a name, this use is encouraged
3257for better readability. It is also the only way to designate a specific section
3258to use instead of the default previous one. Since "defaults" section names are
3259optional, by default a very permissive check is applied on their name and these
3260are even permitted to overlap. However if a "defaults" section is referenced by
3261any other section, its name must comply with the syntax imposed on all proxy
3262names, and this name must be unique among the defaults sections. Please note
3263that regardless of what is currently permitted, it is recommended to avoid
3264duplicate section names in general and to respect the same syntax as for proxy
3265names. This rule might be enforced in a future version.
3266
3267Note that it is even possible for a defaults section to take its initial
3268settings from another one, and as such, inherit settings across multiple levels
3269of defaults sections. This can be convenient to establish certain configuration
3270profiles to carry groups of default settings (e.g. TCP vs HTTP or short vs long
3271timeouts) but can quickly become confusing to follow.
3272
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003273All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
3274'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
3275case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
3276
3277Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
3278logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
3279proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
3280However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
3281name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
3282
3283Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
3284and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003285bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003286protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
3287modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
3288arbitrary criteria.
3289
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003290In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
3291a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Julien Pivotto21ad3152019-12-10 13:11:17 +01003292the backend's. HAProxy supports 3 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003293
3294 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
3295 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
3296 between responses and new requests.
3297
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003298 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
3299 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
3300 client-facing connection remains open.
3301
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003302 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
3303 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003304
3305The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
3306frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
3307following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003308weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003309
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003310 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003311
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003312 | KAL | SCL | CLO
3313 ----+-----+-----+----
3314 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
3315 ----+-----+-----+----
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003316 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
3317 ----+-----+-----+----
3318 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003319
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003320It is possible to chain a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. It is pointless if
3321only HTTP traffic is handled. But It may be used to handle several protocols
3322into the same frontend. It this case, the client's connection is first handled
3323as a raw tcp connection before being upgraded to HTTP. Before the upgrade, the
3324content processings are performend on raw data. Once upgraded, data are parsed
3325and stored using an internal representation called HTX and it is no longer
3326possible to rely on raw representation. There is no way to go back.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003327
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003328There are two kind of upgrades, in-place upgrades and destructive upgrades. The
3329first ones concern the TCP to HTTP/1 upgrades. In HTTP/1, the request
3330processings are serialized, thus the applicative stream can be preserved. The
3331second ones concern the TCP to HTTP/2 upgrades. Because it is a multiplexed
3332protocol, the applicative stream cannot be associated to any HTTP/2 stream and
3333is destroyed. New applicative streams are then created when HAProxy receives
3334new HTTP/2 streams at the lower level, in the H2 multiplexer. It is important
3335to understand this difference because that drastically change the way to
3336process data. When an HTTP/1 upgrade is performed, the content processings
3337already performed on raw data are neither lost nor reexecuted while for an
3338HTTP/2 upgrade, applicative streams are distinct and all frontend rules are
3339evaluated systematically on each one. And as said, the first stream, the TCP
3340one, is destroyed, but only after the frontend rules were evaluated.
3341
3342There is another importnat point to understand when HTTP processings are
3343performed from a TCP proxy. While HAProxy is able to parse HTTP/1 in-fly from
3344tcp-request content rules, it is not possible for HTTP/2. Only the HTTP/2
3345preface can be parsed. This is a huge limitation regarding the HTTP content
3346analysis in TCP. Concretely it is only possible to know if received data are
3347HTTP. For instance, it is not possible to choose a backend based on the Host
3348header value while it is trivial in HTTP/1. Hopefully, there is a solution to
3349mitigate this drawback.
3350
3351It exists two way to perform HTTP upgrades. The first one, the historical
3352method, is to select an HTTP backend. The upgrade happens when the backend is
3353set. Thus, for in-place upgrades, only the backend configuration is considered
3354in the HTTP data processing. For destructive upgrades, the applicative stream
3355is destroyed, thus its processing is stopped. With this method, possibilities
3356to choose a backend with an HTTP/2 connection are really limited, as mentioned
3357above, and a bit useless because the stream is destroyed. The second method is
3358to upgrade during the tcp-request content rules evaluation, thanks to the
3359"switch-mode http" action. In this case, the upgrade is performed in the
3360frontend context and it is possible to define HTTP directives in this
3361frontend. For in-place upgrades, it offers all the power of the HTTP analysis
3362as soon as possible. It is not that far from an HTTP frontend. For destructive
3363upgrades, it does not change anything except it is useless to choose a backend
3364on limited information. It is of course the recommended method. Thus, testing
3365the request protocol from the tcp-request content rules to perform an HTTP
3366upgrade is enough. All the remaining HTTP manipulation may be moved to the
3367frontend http-request ruleset. But keep in mind that tcp-request content rules
3368remains evaluated on each streams, that can't be changed.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003369
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020033704.1. Proxy keywords matrix
3371--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003372
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003373The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
3374limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
3375they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
3376limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003377marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003378option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02003379and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
3380with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
3381specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003382
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003383
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003384 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
3385------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
3386acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003387backlog X X X -
3388balance X - X X
3389bind - X X -
3390bind-process X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003391capture cookie - X X -
3392capture request header - X X -
3393capture response header - X X -
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003394clitcpka-cnt X X X -
3395clitcpka-idle X X X -
3396clitcpka-intvl X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003397compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003398cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003399declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003400default-server X - X X
3401default_backend X X X -
3402description - X X X
3403disabled X X X X
3404dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003405email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003406email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003407email-alert mailers X X X X
3408email-alert myhostname X X X X
3409email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003410enabled X X X X
3411errorfile X X X X
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003412errorfiles X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003413errorloc X X X X
3414errorloc302 X X X X
3415-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3416errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003417force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003418filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003419fullconn X - X X
3420grace X X X X
3421hash-type X - X X
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01003422http-after-response - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02003423http-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003424http-check connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003425http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003426http-check expect X - X X
Peter Gervai8912ae62020-06-11 18:26:36 +02003427http-check send X - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02003428http-check send-state X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003429http-check set-var X - X X
3430http-check unset-var X - X X
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02003431http-error X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003432http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003433http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02003434http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02003435http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003436id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003437ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02003438load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003439log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01003440log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02003441log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01003442log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02003443max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003444maxconn X X X -
3445mode X X X X
3446monitor fail - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003447monitor-uri X X X -
3448option abortonclose (*) X - X X
3449option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
3450option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
3451option allbackups (*) X - X X
3452option checkcache (*) X - X X
3453option clitcpka (*) X X X -
3454option contstats (*) X X X -
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02003455option disable-h2-upgrade (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003456option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
3457option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003458-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3459option forwardfor X X X X
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02003460option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
3461option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02003462option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02003463option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003464option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02003465option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02003466option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003467option http-server-close (*) X X X X
3468option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
3469option httpchk X - X X
3470option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01003471option httplog X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003472option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003473option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02003474option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003475option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003476option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
3477option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
3478option logasap (*) X X X -
3479option mysql-check X - X X
3480option nolinger (*) X X X X
3481option originalto X X X X
3482option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02003483option pgsql-check X - X X
3484option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003485option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02003486option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003487option smtpchk X - X X
3488option socket-stats (*) X X X -
3489option splice-auto (*) X X X X
3490option splice-request (*) X X X X
3491option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01003492option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003493option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
3494option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
3495-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01003496option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003497option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
3498option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
3499option tcpka X X X X
3500option tcplog X X X X
3501option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003502external-check command X - X X
3503external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003504persist rdp-cookie X - X X
3505rate-limit sessions X X X -
3506redirect - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003507-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003508retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02003509retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003510server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02003511server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02003512server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003513source X - X X
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003514srvtcpka-cnt X - X X
3515srvtcpka-idle X - X X
3516srvtcpka-intvl X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02003517stats admin - X X X
3518stats auth X X X X
3519stats enable X X X X
3520stats hide-version X X X X
3521stats http-request - X X X
3522stats realm X X X X
3523stats refresh X X X X
3524stats scope X X X X
3525stats show-desc X X X X
3526stats show-legends X X X X
3527stats show-node X X X X
3528stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003529-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3530stick match - - X X
3531stick on - - X X
3532stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02003533stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01003534stick-table - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02003535tcp-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003536tcp-check connect X - X X
3537tcp-check expect X - X X
3538tcp-check send X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003539tcp-check send-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003540tcp-check send-binary X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003541tcp-check send-binary-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003542tcp-check set-var X - X X
3543tcp-check unset-var X - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02003544tcp-request connection - X X -
3545tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02003546tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02003547tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02003548tcp-response content - - X X
3549tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003550timeout check X - X X
3551timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003552timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003553timeout connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003554timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
3555timeout http-request X X X X
3556timeout queue X - X X
3557timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003558timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003559timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02003560timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003561transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01003562unique-id-format X X X -
3563unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003564use_backend - X X -
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02003565use-fcgi-app - - X X
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02003566use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003567------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
3568 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003569
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003570
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020035714.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
3572---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003573
3574This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
3575
3576
3577acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
3578 Declare or complete an access list.
3579 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3580 no | yes | yes | yes
3581 Example:
3582 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
3583 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
3584 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
3585
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003586 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003587
3588
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003589backlog <conns>
3590 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3591 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3592 yes | yes | yes | no
3593 Arguments :
3594 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
3595 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003596 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003597
3598 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
3599 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
3600 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
3601 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
3602 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
3603 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
3604 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
3605 backlog parameter.
3606
3607 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
3608 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
3609 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
3610
3611 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
3612
3613
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003614balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003615balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003616 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
3617 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3618 yes | no | yes | yes
3619 Arguments :
3620 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
3621 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
3622 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
3623 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
3624
3625 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3626 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
3627 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
3628 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003629 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08003630 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003631 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
3632 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
3633 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
3634 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
3635 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
3636 it, so that you don't worry.
3637
3638 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3639 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
3640 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
3641 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
3642 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
3643 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
3644 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
3645 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003646
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003647 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
3648 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
3649 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
3650 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
3651 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
3652 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
3653 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
Willy Tarreau8c855f62020-10-22 17:41:45 +02003654 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance. It will
3655 also consider the number of queued connections in addition to
3656 the established ones in order to minimize queuing.
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003657
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003658 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003659 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003660 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
3661 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003662 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003663 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
3664 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
3665 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
3666 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
3667 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003668 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
3669 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
3670 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
3671 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
3672 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
3673 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003674
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003675 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
3676 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
3677 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
3678 address will always reach the same server as long as no
3679 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
3680 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
3681 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
3682 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003683 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003684 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003685 static by default, which means that changing a server's
3686 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
3687 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003688
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003689 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
3690 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
3691 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
3692 the running servers. The result designates which server will
3693 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
3694 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
3695 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
3696 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
3697 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
3698 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3699 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3700 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003701
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003702 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003703 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
3704 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
3705 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
3706 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
3707 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
3708 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
3709 URIs start with a leading "/".
3710
3711 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
3712 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
3713 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
3714 evaluation stops when either is reached.
3715
Willy Tarreau57a37412020-09-23 08:56:29 +02003716 A "path-only" parameter indicates that the hashing key starts
3717 at the first '/' of the path. This can be used to ignore the
3718 authority part of absolute URIs, and to make sure that HTTP/1
3719 and HTTP/2 URIs will provide the same hash.
3720
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003721 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003722 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
3723
3724 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003725 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
3726 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003727 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
3728 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
3729 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
3730 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003731 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003732 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
3733 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003734
3735 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
3736 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
3737 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
3738 server will receive the request.
3739
3740 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
3741 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
3742 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
3743 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
3744 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003745 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
3746 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
3747 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003748
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003749 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
3750 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
3751 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
3752 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
3753 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003754
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003755 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003756 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
3757 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
3758 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
3759
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003760 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3761 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3762 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3763
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003764 random
3765 random(<draws>)
3766 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003767 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
3768 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
3769 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
3770 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003771 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
3772 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
3773 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
3774 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
3775 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
3776 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
3777 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
3778 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
3779 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
3780 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
3781 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
3782 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
3783 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
3784 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
3785 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
3786 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
3787 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
3788 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
3789 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
3790 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003791
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003792 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02003793 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003794 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
3795 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
3796 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
3797 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
3798 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
3799 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003800 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003801 used instead.
3802
3803 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
3804 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
3805 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
3806 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
3807
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003808 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3809 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3810 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3811
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003812 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09003813
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003814 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003815 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
3816 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003817
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01003818 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
3819 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
3820 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003821
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003822 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003823 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003824 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
3825 NTLM relies on.
3826
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003827 Examples :
3828 balance roundrobin
3829 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003830 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003831 balance hdr(User-Agent)
3832 balance hdr(host)
3833 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003834
3835 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
3836 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
3837
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003838 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003839 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
3840 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
3841 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02003842 the body. (see acl http_end)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003843
3844 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
3845 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
3846 defaults to 16 kB.
3847
3848 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
3849 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
3850
3851 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
3852 Round Robin.
3853
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00003854 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003855 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
3856 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
3857 actually appeared in the first chunk).
3858
3859 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
3860
3861 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003862 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003863 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
3864 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
3865 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003866
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003867 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003868
3869
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003870bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
3871bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003872 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
3873 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3874 no | yes | yes | no
3875 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01003876 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
3877 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
3878 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
3879 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01003880 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003881 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
3882 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
3883 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
3884 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
3885 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
3886 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02003887 - 'udp@' -> address is resolved as IPv4 or IPv6 and
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003888 protocol UDP is used. Currently those listeners are
3889 supported only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02003890 - 'udp4@' -> address is always IPv4 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003891 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
3892 only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02003893 - 'udp6@' -> address is always IPv6 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003894 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
3895 only in log-forward sections.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003896 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02003897 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
3898 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
3899 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
3900 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
3901 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
3902 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
3903 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01003904 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
3905 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
3906 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02003907 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
3908 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
3909 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
3910 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003911 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
3912 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
3913 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01003914
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003915 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
3916 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003917 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
3918 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
3919 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003920 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
3921 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
3922 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
3923 the range.
3924
3925 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
3926 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
3927 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
3928 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
3929 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
3930 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
3931 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003932 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003933 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003934
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003935 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003936 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003937 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
3938 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
3939 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
3940 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
3941 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
3942 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
3943
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003944 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
3945 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
3946 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
3947 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003948
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003949 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
3950 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
3951 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
3952 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
3953 in a frontend.
3954
3955 Example :
3956 listen http_proxy
3957 bind :80,:443
3958 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003959 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003960
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003961 listen http_https_proxy
3962 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02003963 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003964
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003965 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
3966 bind ipv6@:80
3967 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
3968 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
3969
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003970 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003971 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003972
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02003973 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
3974 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
3975 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
3976 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
3977 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
3978
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003979 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003980 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003981
3982
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003983bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003984 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
3985 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3986 yes | yes | yes | yes
3987 Arguments :
3988 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
3989 may be used to override a default value.
3990
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003991 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003992 option may be combined with other numbers.
3993
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003994 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003995 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
3996 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
3997 missing from all processes.
3998
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003999 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01004000 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01004001 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
4002 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
4003 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
4004 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
4005 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02004006 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004007
4008 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
4009 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
4010 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
4011 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
4012 and 'even' instances.
4013
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01004014 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
4015 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
4016 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
4017 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004018
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02004019 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
4020 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
4021
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02004022 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
4023 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
4024 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
4025
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004026 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
4027 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
4028
4029 Example :
4030 listen app_ip1
4031 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02004032 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004033
4034 listen app_ip2
4035 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02004036 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004037
4038 listen management
4039 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02004040 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004041
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01004042 listen management
4043 bind 10.0.0.4:80
4044 bind-process 1-4
4045
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02004046 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004047
4048
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004049capture cookie <name> len <length>
4050 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
4051 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4052 no | yes | yes | no
4053 Arguments :
4054 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
4055 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
4056 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
4057 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004058 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004059
4060 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
4061 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
4062 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
4063 right if it exceeds <length>.
4064
4065 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
4066 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
4067 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
4068 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
4069
4070 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
4071 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
4072 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
4073
4074 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
4075 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
4076 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01004077 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
4078 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
4079 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004080
4081 Example:
4082 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
4083
4084 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004085 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004086
4087
4088capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004089 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004090 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4091 no | yes | yes | no
4092 Arguments :
4093 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004094 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004095 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
4096 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
4097 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
4098
4099 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
4100 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
4101 it exceeds <length>.
4102
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004103 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004104 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
4105 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004106 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
4107 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
4108 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
4109 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004110 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004111 environments to find where the request came from.
4112
4113 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
4114 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
4115 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
4116 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004117
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01004118 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
4119 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
4120 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
4121 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
4122 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004123
4124 Example:
4125 capture request header Host len 15
4126 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01004127 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004128
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004129 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004130 about logging.
4131
4132
4133capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004134 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004135 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4136 no | yes | yes | no
4137 Arguments :
4138 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004139 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004140 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
4141 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
4142 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
4143
4144 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
4145 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
4146 it exceeds <length>.
4147
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004148 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004149 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
4150 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
4151 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004152 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
4153 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
4154 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
4155 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004156
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01004157 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
4158 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
4159 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
4160 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
4161 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004162
4163 Example:
4164 capture response header Content-length len 9
4165 capture response header Location len 15
4166
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004167 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004168 about logging.
4169
4170
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004171clitcpka-cnt <count>
4172 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
4173 the connection on the client side.
4174 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4175 yes | yes | yes | no
4176 Arguments :
4177 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
4178
4179 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
4180 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004181 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4182 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004183
4184 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-idle", "clitcpka-intvl".
4185
4186
4187clitcpka-idle <timeout>
4188 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
4189 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
4190 client side.
4191 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4192 yes | yes | yes | no
4193 Arguments :
4194 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
4195 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
4196 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
4197 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
4198
4199 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
4200 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004201 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4202 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004203
4204 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-intvl".
4205
4206
4207clitcpka-intvl <timeout>
4208 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the client side.
4209 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4210 yes | yes | yes | no
4211 Arguments :
4212 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
4213 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
4214 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
4215 document.
4216
4217 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
4218 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004219 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4220 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004221
4222 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-idle".
4223
4224
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004225compression algo <algorithm> ...
4226compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004227compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004228 Enable HTTP compression.
4229 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4230 yes | yes | yes | yes
4231 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004232 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
4233 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
4234 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
4235
4236 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004237 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
4238 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
4239 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004240
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004241 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004242 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004243
4244 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
4245 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
4246 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
4247 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
4248 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004249 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004250
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004251 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
4252 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
4253 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
4254 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
4255 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
4256 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
4257 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004258 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004259
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04004260 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004261 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004262 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
4263 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
4264 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
4265 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
4266 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004267
4268 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
4269 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
4270 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
4271 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
4272 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004273 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
4274 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
4275 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
4276 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
4277 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02004278 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
4279 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004280
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004281 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01004282 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
4283 "Accept-Encoding" header
Julien Pivottoff80c822021-03-29 12:41:40 +02004284 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1 or above
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01004285 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01004286 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
4287 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
4288 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
4289 "multipart"
4290 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
4291 header
4292 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
4293 and later
4294 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
4295 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01004296 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004297
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01004298 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004299
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004300 Examples :
4301 compression algo gzip
4302 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004303
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004304
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004305cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004306 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
4307 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01004308 [ dynamic ] [ attr <value> ]*
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004309 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
4310 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4311 yes | no | yes | yes
4312 Arguments :
4313 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
4314 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
4315 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
4316 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
4317 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
4318 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004319 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004320 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
4321 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
4322
4323 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
4324 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
4325 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
4326 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
4327 headers is left to the application. The application can then
4328 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004329 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
4330 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004331 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004332 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
4333 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004334
4335 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004336 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004337
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004338 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004339 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02004340 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004341 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004342 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
4343 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
4344 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
4345 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
4346 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
4347 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
4348 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004349
4350 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
4351 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
4352 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
4353 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
4354 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
4355 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
4356 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
4357 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
4358 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004359 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02004360 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
4361 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
4362 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004363
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004364 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
4365 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
4366 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004367 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
4368 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
4369 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
4370 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02004371 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
4372 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
4373 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004374
4375 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
4376 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
4377 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
4378 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
4379 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
4380 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
4381 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
4382 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
4383 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
4384
4385 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
4386 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
4387 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
4388 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
4389 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
4390 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
4391 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
4392 persistence cookie in the cache.
4393 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
4394
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004395 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
4396 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
4397 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
4398 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
4399 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004400 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004401 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
4402 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
4403 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
4404 they logout.
4405
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004406 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
4407 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
4408 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
4409 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
4410
4411 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
4412 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
4413 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
4414 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
4415 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
4416 this attribute.
4417
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02004418 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004419 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01004420 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
4421 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
4422 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
4423 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
4424 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
4425 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02004426
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004427 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
4428 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
4429 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
4430 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
4431 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
4432 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
4433 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
4434 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004435 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004436 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
4437 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
4438 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
4439 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
4440 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
4441 the site.
4442
4443 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
4444 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
4445 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
4446 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
4447 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
4448 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
4449 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
4450 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
4451 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
4452 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
4453 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
4454 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
4455 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004456 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004457 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
4458 redispatch after some absolute delay.
4459
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004460 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
4461 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
4462 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
4463 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
4464 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
4465 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
4466
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01004467 attr This option tells haproxy to add an extra attribute when a
4468 cookie is inserted. The attribute value can contain any
4469 characters except control ones or ";". This option may be
4470 repeated.
4471
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004472 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
4473 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
4474 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
4475 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02004476
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004477 Examples :
4478 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
4479 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
4480 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004481 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004482
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02004483 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004484
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004485
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004486declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
4487 Declares a capture slot.
4488 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4489 no | yes | yes | no
4490 Arguments:
4491 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
4492
4493 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
4494 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
4495 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
4496 for use in the response.
4497
4498 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02004499 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004500 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
4501
4502
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004503default-server [param*]
4504 Change default options for a server in a backend
4505 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4506 yes | no | yes | yes
4507 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004508 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
4509 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
4510 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
4511 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004512
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004513 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004514 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
4515
4516 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004517
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004518
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004519default_backend <backend>
4520 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
4521 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4522 yes | yes | yes | no
4523 Arguments :
4524 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
4525
4526 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
4527 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
4528 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
4529 will catch all undetermined requests.
4530
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004531 Example :
4532
4533 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
4534 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
4535 default_backend dynamic
4536
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02004537 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004538
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004539
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02004540description <string>
4541 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
4542 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4543 no | yes | yes | yes
4544 Arguments : string
4545
4546 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
4547 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
4548 it describes.
4549 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
4550
4551
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004552disabled
4553 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4554 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4555 yes | yes | yes | yes
4556 Arguments : none
4557
4558 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
4559 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
4560 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
4561 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
4562 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
4563 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
4564 keyword in a "defaults" section.
4565
4566 See also : "enabled"
4567
4568
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004569dispatch <address>:<port>
4570 Set a default server address
4571 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4572 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004573 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004574
4575 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
4576 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
4577 during start-up.
4578
4579 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
4580 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
4581 possible with normal servers.
4582
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02004583 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004584 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
4585 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
4586 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
4587 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
4588
4589 See also : "server"
4590
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004591
4592dynamic-cookie-key <string>
4593 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
4594 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4595 yes | no | yes | yes
4596 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
4597
4598 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004599 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004600 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
4601 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004602 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004603 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004604
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004605enabled
4606 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4607 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4608 yes | yes | yes | yes
4609 Arguments : none
4610
4611 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
4612 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
4613
4614 See also : "disabled"
4615
4616
4617errorfile <code> <file>
4618 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4619 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4620 yes | yes | yes | yes
4621 Arguments :
4622 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004623 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004624 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004625
4626 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004627 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004628 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004629 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
4630 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004631
4632 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4633 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4634 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4635
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004636 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4637
Christopher Faulet70170672020-05-18 17:42:48 +02004638 The files are parsed when HAProxy starts and must be valid according to the
4639 HTTP specification. They should not exceed the configured buffer size
4640 (BUFSIZE), which generally is 16 kB, otherwise an internal error will be
4641 returned. It is also wise not to put any reference to local contents
4642 (e.g. images) in order to avoid loops between the client and HAProxy when all
4643 servers are down, causing an error to be returned instead of an
4644 image. Finally, The response cannot exceed (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite)
4645 so that "http-after-response" rules still have room to operate (see
4646 "tune.maxrewrite").
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004647
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004648 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
4649 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
4650 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004651 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004652 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
4653
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004654 See also : "http-error", "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004655
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004656 Example :
4657 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004658 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004659 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
4660 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
4661
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004662
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004663errorfiles <name> [<code> ...]
4664 Import, fully or partially, the error files defined in the <name> http-errors
4665 section.
4666 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4667 yes | yes | yes | yes
4668 Arguments :
4669 <name> is the name of an existing http-errors section.
4670
4671 <code> is a HTTP status code. Several status code may be listed.
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004672 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes 200, 400, 401,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004673 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503,
4674 and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004675
4676 Errors defined in the http-errors section with the name <name> are imported
4677 in the current proxy. If no status code is specified, all error files of the
4678 http-errors section are imported. Otherwise, only error files associated to
4679 the listed status code are imported. Those error files override the already
4680 defined custom errors for the proxy. And they may be overridden by following
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04004681 ones. Functionally, it is exactly the same as declaring all error files by
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004682 hand using "errorfile" directives.
4683
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004684 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302" ,
4685 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004686
4687 Example :
4688 errorfiles generic
4689 errorfiles site-1 403 404
4690
4691
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004692errorloc <code> <url>
4693errorloc302 <code> <url>
4694 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4695 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4696 yes | yes | yes | yes
4697 Arguments :
4698 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004699 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004700 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004701
4702 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4703 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4704 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4705 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004706 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004707
4708 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4709 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4710 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4711
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004712 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4713
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004714 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
4715 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
4716 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
4717 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004718 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004719 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
4720 request.
4721
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004722 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004723
4724
4725errorloc303 <code> <url>
4726 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4727 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4728 yes | yes | yes | yes
4729 Arguments :
4730 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004731 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004732 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004733
4734 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4735 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4736 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4737 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004738 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004739
4740 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4741 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4742 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4743
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004744 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4745
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004746 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
4747 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
4748 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
4749 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004750 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004751
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004752 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004753
4754
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004755email-alert from <emailaddr>
4756 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004757 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004758 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4759 yes | yes | yes | yes
4760
4761 Arguments :
4762
4763 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
4764
4765 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4766 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4767
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004768 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02004769 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
4770 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004771
4772
4773email-alert level <level>
4774 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
4775 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
4776 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4777 yes | yes | yes | yes
4778
4779 Arguments :
4780
4781 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
4782 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
4783 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
4784
4785 By default level is alert
4786
4787 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
4788 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
4789 for the proxy.
4790
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09004791 Alerts are sent when :
4792
4793 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
4794 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
4795 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
4796 is notice or lower
4797 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
4798 and a health check status update occurs
4799
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004800 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
4801 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004802 section 3.6 about mailers.
4803
4804
4805email-alert mailers <mailersect>
4806 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
4807 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4808 yes | yes | yes | yes
4809
4810 Arguments :
4811
4812 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
4813
4814 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
4815 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4816
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004817 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
4818 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004819
4820
4821email-alert myhostname <hostname>
4822 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
4823 mailers.
4824 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4825 yes | yes | yes | yes
4826
4827 Arguments :
4828
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01004829 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004830
4831 By default the systems hostname is used.
4832
4833 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
4834 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
4835 for the proxy.
4836
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004837 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
4838 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004839
4840
4841email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004842 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004843 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
4844 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4845 yes | yes | yes | yes
4846
4847 Arguments :
4848
4849 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
4850
4851 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4852 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4853
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004854 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004855 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
4856
4857
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004858force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
4859 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
4860 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01004861 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004862
4863 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
4864 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
4865 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
4866 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
4867 marked down for maintenance operations.
4868
4869 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
4870 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
4871 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
4872 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
4873 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
4874 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
4875 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
4876 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
4877 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
4878
4879 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
4880 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
4881 is used.
4882
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004883 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02004884 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004885
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004886
4887filter <name> [param*]
4888 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
4889 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4890 no | yes | yes | yes
4891 Arguments :
4892 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
4893 referenced in section 9.
4894
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01004895 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004896 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01004897 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
4898 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004899
4900 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
4901 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
4902
4903 Example:
4904 listen
4905 bind *:80
4906
4907 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
4908 filter compression
4909 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
4910
4911 compression algo gzip
4912 compression offload
4913
4914 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
4915
4916 See also : section 9.
4917
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004918
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004919fullconn <conns>
4920 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
4921 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4922 yes | no | yes | yes
4923 Arguments :
4924 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
4925 servers use the maximal number of connections.
4926
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004927 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004928 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004929 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004930 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
4931 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
4932 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
4933 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
4934 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004935 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004936
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02004937 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
4938 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01004939 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
4940 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
4941 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02004942
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004943 Example :
4944 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
4945 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
4946 # connections.
4947 backend dynamic
4948 fullconn 10000
4949 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
4950 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
4951
4952 See also : "maxconn", "server"
4953
4954
Willy Tarreauab0a5192020-10-09 19:07:01 +02004955grace <time> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004956 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
4957 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01004958 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004959 Arguments :
4960 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
4961 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
4962 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
4963
4964 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
4965 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004966 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004967 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
4968
4969 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
4970 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
4971 simplify it.
4972
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004973
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004974hash-balance-factor <factor>
4975 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
4976 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4977 yes | no | no | yes
4978 Arguments :
4979 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
4980 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01004981 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004982
4983 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
4984 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
4985 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
4986 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
4987 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
4988 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
4989 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
4990
4991 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
4992 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
4993 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
4994 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
4995 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
4996
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02004997 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
4998 consistent hashing mechanism.
4999
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005000 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
5001
5002
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005003hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005004 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
5005 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5006 yes | no | yes | yes
5007 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005008 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
5009 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005010
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005011 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
5012 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
5013 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
5014 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
5015 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
5016 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
5017 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
5018 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
5019 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
5020 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01005021
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005022 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
5023 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
5024 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
5025 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
5026 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
5027 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
5028 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
5029 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
5030 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
5031 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
5032 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
5033 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
5034 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005035 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
5036 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005037
5038 <function> is the hash function to be used :
5039
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005040 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005041 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
5042 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
5043 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005044 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
5045 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
5046 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005047
5048 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
5049 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005050 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
5051 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
5052 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
5053 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
5054
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01005055 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
5056 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
5057 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
5058 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
5059 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
5060 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
5061 parameter.
5062
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01005063 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
5064 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
5065 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
5066 used on strings.
5067
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005068 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
5069
5070 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
5071 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
5072 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
5073 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
5074 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
5075 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
5076 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
5077 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
5078 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
5079 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
5080 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
5081 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005082
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005083 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
5084 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
5085 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005086
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005087 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005088
5089
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005090http-after-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5091 Access control for all Layer 7 responses (server, applet/service and internal
5092 ones).
5093
5094 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5095 no | yes | yes | yes
5096
5097 The http-after-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer
5098 7 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they
5099 are met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5100 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5101 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
5102 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
5103
5104 Unlike http-response rules, these ones are applied on all responses, the
5105 server ones but also to all responses generated by HAProxy. These rules are
5106 evaluated at the end of the responses analysis, before the data forwarding.
5107
5108 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5109 below.
5110
5111 There is no limit to the number of http-after-response statements per
5112 instance.
5113
Christopher Fauletd5ac6de2020-12-02 08:40:14 +01005114 Note: Errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are handled by the
5115 multiplexer at a lower level, before any http analysis. Thus no
5116 http-after-response ruleset is evaluated on these errors.
5117
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005118 Example:
5119 http-after-response set-header Strict-Transport-Security "max-age=31536000"
5120 http-after-response set-header Cache-Control "no-store,no-cache,private"
5121 http-after-response set-header Pragma "no-cache"
5122
5123http-after-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5124
5125 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
5126 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
5127 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
5128 example, or to pass some internal information.
5129 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
5130 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
5131 the resulting header from a previous rule.
5132
5133http-after-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5134
5135 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
5136 No further "http-after-response" rules are evaluated.
5137
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005138http-after-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005139
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005140 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
5141 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
5142 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
5143 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
5144 method is used.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005145
5146http-after-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5147 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5148
5149 This works like "http-response replace-header".
5150
5151 Example:
5152 http-after-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
5153
5154 # applied to:
5155 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
5156
5157 # outputs:
5158 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
5159
5160 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
5161
5162http-after-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5163 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5164
5165 This works like "http-response replace-value".
5166
5167 Example:
5168 http-after-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
5169
5170 # applied to:
5171 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
5172
5173 # outputs:
5174 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
5175
5176http-after-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5177
5178 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
5179 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
5180 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
5181
5182http-after-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
5183 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5184
5185 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
5186 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
5187 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
5188 fallback.
5189
5190 Example:
5191 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
5192 http-response set-status 431
5193 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
5194 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down"
5195
5196http-after-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5197
5198 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5199 inline.
5200
5201 Arguments:
5202 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5203 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5204 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5205 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5206 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5207 (request and response)
5208 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5209 processing
5210 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5211 processing
5212 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5213 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
5214 and '_'.
5215
5216 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5217 followed by some converters.
5218
5219 Example:
5220 http-after-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
5221
5222http-after-response strict-mode { on | off }
5223
5224 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
5225 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
5226 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
5227 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
5228 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005229 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005230 processing.
5231
5232 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
5233 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005234 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005235 rules evaluation.
5236
5237http-after-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5238
5239 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-after-response set-var" for
5240 details about <var-name>.
5241
5242 Example:
5243 http-after-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
5244
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005245
5246http-check comment <string>
5247 Defines a comment for the following the http-check rule, reported in logs if
5248 it fails.
5249 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5250 yes | no | yes | yes
5251
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005252 Arguments :
5253 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following http-check
5254 rule fails.
5255
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005256 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
5257 user-friendly error reporting.
5258
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005259 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check send" and
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005260 "http-check expect".
5261
5262
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005263http-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy]
5264 [via-socks4] [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02005265 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005266 Opens a new connection to perform an HTTP health check
5267 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5268 yes | no | yes | yes
5269
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005270 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005271 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5272
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005273 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005274 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005275
5276 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
5277 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
5278 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
5279 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
5280
5281 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
5282
5283 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
5284
5285 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
5286
5287 ssl opens a ciphered connection
5288
5289 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
5290
5291 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
5292 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
5293 for instance: "h2,http/1.1". If it is not set, the server ALPN
5294 is used.
5295
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02005296 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
5297 It must be an HTTP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
5298 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
5299 haproxy -vv.
5300
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005301 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
5302
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005303 Just like tcp-check health checks, it is possible to configure the connection
5304 to use to perform HTTP health check. This directive should also be used to
5305 describe a scenario involving several request/response exchanges, possibly on
5306 different ports or with different servers.
5307
5308 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
5309 directive, then the first step of the http-check sequence must be to specify
5310 the port with a "http-check connect".
5311
5312 In an http-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
5313 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
5314 do.
5315
5316 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
5317 unset-var or comment rules.
5318
5319 Examples :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005320 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
5321 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
5322 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
5323 option httpchk
5324
5325 http-check connect
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02005326 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005327 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005328 http-check connect port 443 ssl sni haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02005329 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005330 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005331
5332 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
5333
5334 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send", "http-check expect"
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005335
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005336
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005337http-check disable-on-404
5338 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
5339 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005340 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005341 Arguments : none
5342
5343 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
5344 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
5345 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
5346 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
5347 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
5348 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
5349 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
5350 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005351 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
5352 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
Christopher Fauletfa8b89a2020-11-20 18:54:13 +01005353 responses will still be considered as soft-stop. Note also that a stopped
5354 server will stay stopped even if it replies 404s. This option is only
5355 evaluated for running servers.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005356
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005357 See also : "option httpchk" and "http-check expect".
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005358
5359
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005360http-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005361 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
5362 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
5363 [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005364 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005365 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02005366 yes | no | yes | yes
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005367
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005368 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005369 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5370
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005371 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
5372 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
5373 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
5374 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
5375 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
5376 incomplete. If an exact string is used, the minimum between the
5377 string length and this parameter is used. This parameter is
5378 ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule does not match,
5379 the check will wait for more data. If set to 0, the evaluation
5380 result is always conclusive.
5381
5382 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5383 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
5384 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005385 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
5386 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01005387 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
5388 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005389 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
5390 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
5391 By default "L7OK" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005392
5393 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5394 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01005395 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
5396 supported :
5397 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
5398 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005399 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
5400 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
5401 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
5402 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
5403 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005404
5405 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5406 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005407 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
5408 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
5409 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
5410 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005411 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
5412
5413 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
5414 informational message reported in logs if the expect
5415 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
5416 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
5417
5418 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
5419 informational message reported in logs if an error
5420 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
5421 log-format string.
5422
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005423 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005424 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus", "hdr",
5425 "fhdr", "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005426 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
5427 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
5428 details on the supported keywords.
5429
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005430 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string, a regular
5431 expression or a more complex pattern with several arguments. If
5432 the string pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped with the
5433 usual backslash ('\').
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005434
5435 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
5436 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
5437 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
5438 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
5439 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
5440
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005441 status <codes> : test the status codes found parsing <codes> string. it
5442 must be a comma-separated list of status codes or range
5443 codes. A health check response will be considered as
5444 valid if the response's status code matches any status
5445 code or is inside any range of the list. If the "status"
5446 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5447 considered invalid if the status code matches.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005448
5449 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005450 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005451 response's status code matches the expression. If the
5452 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
5453 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
5454 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
5455
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005456 hdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
5457 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005458 test the specified header pattern on the HTTP response
5459 headers. The name pattern is mandatory but the value
5460 pattern is optional. If not specified, only the header
5461 presence is verified. <meth> is the matching method,
5462 applied on the header name or the header value. Supported
5463 matching methods are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix
5464 match), "end" (suffix match), "sub" (substring match) or
5465 "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005466 method is used. If the "name-lf" parameter is used,
5467 <name> is evaluated as a log-format string. If "value-lf"
5468 parameter is used, <value> is evaluated as a log-format
5469 string. These parameters cannot be used with the regex
5470 matching method. Finally, the header value is considered
5471 as comma-separated list. Note that matchings are case
5472 insensitive on the header names.
5473
5474 fhdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
5475 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
5476 test the specified full header pattern on the HTTP
5477 response headers. It does exactly the same than "hdr"
5478 keyword, except the full header value is tested, commas
5479 are not considered as delimiters.
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005480
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005481 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005482 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005483 response's body contains this exact string. If the
5484 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
5485 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
5486 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
5487 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005488 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005489 trace).
5490
5491 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005492 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005493 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
5494 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5495 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
5496 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
5497 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005498 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005499
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +02005500 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the HTTP response body.
5501 A health check response will be considered valid if the
5502 response's body contains the string resulting of the
5503 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
5504 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5505 considered invalid if the body contains the string.
5506
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005507 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +01005508 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005509 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
5510 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
5511 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
5512 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
5513 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
5514 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
5515
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005516 In an http-check ruleset, the last expect rule may be implicit. If no expect
5517 rule is specified after the last "http-check send", an implicit expect rule
5518 is defined to match on 2xx or 3xx status codes. It means this rule is also
5519 defined if there is no "http-check" rule at all, when only "option httpchk"
5520 is set.
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01005521
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005522 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
5523 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
5524
5525 Examples :
5526 # only accept status 200 as valid
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005527 http-check expect status 200,201,300-310
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005528
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005529 # be sure a sessid coookie is set
5530 http-check expect header name "set-cookie" value -m beg "sessid="
5531
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005532 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005533 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005534
5535 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005536 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005537
5538 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005539 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005540
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005541 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check disable-on-404"
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005542 and "http-check send".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005543
5544
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005545http-check send [meth <method>] [{ uri <uri> | uri-lf <fmt> }>] [ver <version>]
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005546 [hdr <name> <fmt>]* [{ body <string> | body-lf <fmt> }]
5547 [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005548 Add a possible list of headers and/or a body to the request sent during HTTP
5549 health checks.
5550 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5551 yes | no | yes | yes
5552 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005553 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5554
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005555 meth <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not
5556 set, the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires
5557 low server processing and is easy to filter out from the
5558 logs. Any method may be used, though it is not recommended
5559 to invent non-standard ones.
5560
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005561 uri <uri> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5562 to the string <uri>. It defaults to "/" which is accessible
5563 by default on almost any server, but may be changed to any
5564 other URI. Query strings are permitted.
5565
5566 uri-lf <fmt> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5567 using the log-format string <fmt>. It defaults to "/" which
5568 is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
5569 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005570
Christopher Faulet907701b2020-04-28 09:37:00 +02005571 ver <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005572 "HTTP/1.0" but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005573 1.0, so turning it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005574 the Host field is mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "hdr" argument
5575 to add it.
5576
5577 hdr <name> <fmt> adds the HTTP header field whose name is specified in
5578 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt>, which follows
5579 to the log-format rules.
5580
5581 body <string> add the body defined by <string> to the request sent during
5582 HTTP health checks. If defined, the "Content-Length" header
5583 is thus automatically added to the request.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005584
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005585 body-lf <fmt> add the body defined by the log-format string <fmt> to the
5586 request sent during HTTP health checks. If defined, the
5587 "Content-Length" header is thus automatically added to the
5588 request.
5589
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005590 In addition to the request line defined by the "option httpchk" directive,
5591 this one is the valid way to add some headers and optionally a body to the
5592 request sent during HTTP health checks. If a body is defined, the associate
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005593 "Content-Length" header is automatically added. Thus, this header or
5594 "Transfer-encoding" header should not be present in the request provided by
5595 "http-check send". If so, it will be ignored. The old trick consisting to add
5596 headers after the version string on the "option httpchk" line is now
Amaury Denoyelle6d975f02020-12-22 14:08:52 +01005597 deprecated.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005598
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005599 Also "http-check send" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
Amaury Denoyelle6d975f02020-12-22 14:08:52 +01005600 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, unless a Connection
5601 header has already already been configured via a hdr entry.
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005602
5603 Note that the Host header and the request authority, when both defined, are
5604 automatically synchronized. It means when the HTTP request is sent, when a
5605 Host is inserted in the request, the request authority is accordingly
5606 updated. Thus, don't be surprised if the Host header value overwrites the
5607 configured request authority.
5608
5609 Note also for now, no Host header is automatically added in HTTP/1.1 or above
5610 requests. You should add it explicitly.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005611
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005612 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send-state" and "http-check expect".
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005613
5614
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005615http-check send-state
5616 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
5617 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5618 yes | no | yes | yes
5619 Arguments : none
5620
5621 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
5622 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
5623 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
5624 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
5625 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
5626
5627 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
5628 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
5629 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
5630 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
5631 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08005632 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
5633 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
5634 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5635
5636 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
5637 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
5638 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5639
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005640 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
5641 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
5642 checked in multiple backends.
5643
5644 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
5645 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
5646
5647 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
5648 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
5649 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
5650 one fails.
5651
5652 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
5653 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
5654 connections on all servers of the same backend.
5655
5656 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
5657 server's queue.
5658
5659 Example of a header received by the application server :
5660 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
5661 scur=13/22; qcur=0
5662
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005663 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404" and
5664 "http-check send".
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005665
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005666
5667http-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005668 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005669 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5670 yes | no | yes | yes
5671
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005672 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005673 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5674 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5675 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5676 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5677 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5678 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5679 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5680 and '-'.
5681
5682 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
5683
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005684 Examples :
5685 http-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005686
5687
5688http-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005689 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005690 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5691 yes | no | yes | yes
5692
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005693 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005694 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5695 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5696 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5697 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5698 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5699 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5700 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5701 and '-'.
5702
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005703 Examples :
5704 http-check unset-var(check.port)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005705
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005706
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005707http-error status <code> [content-type <type>]
5708 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5709 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
5710 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
5711 Defines a custom error message to use instead of errors generated by HAProxy.
5712 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5713 yes | yes | yes | yes
5714 Arguments :
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05005715 status <code> is the HTTP status code. It must be specified.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005716 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005717 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01005718 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005719
5720 content-type <type> is the response content type, for instance
5721 "text/plain". This parameter is ignored and should be
5722 omitted when an errorfile is configured or when the
5723 payload is empty. Otherwise, it must be defined.
5724
5725 default-errorfiles Reset the previously defined error message for current
5726 proxy for the status <code>. If used on a backend, the
5727 frontend error message is used, if defined. If used on
5728 a frontend, the default error message is used.
5729
5730 errorfile <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response.
5731 It is recommended to follow the common practice of
5732 appending ".http" to the filename so that people do
5733 not confuse the response with HTML error pages, and to
5734 use absolute paths, since files are read before any
5735 chroot is performed.
5736
5737 errorfiles <name> designates the http-errors section to use to import
5738 the error message with the status code <code>. If no
5739 such message is found, the proxy's error messages are
5740 considered.
5741
5742 file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5743 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5744 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5745 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5746 considered as a raw string.
5747
5748 string <str> specifies the raw string to use as response payload.
5749 The content-type must always be set as argument to
5750 "content-type".
5751
5752 lf-file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5753 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5754 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5755 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5756 evaluated as a log-format string.
5757
5758 lf-string <str> specifies the log-format string to use as response
5759 payload. The content-type must always be set as
5760 argument to "content-type".
5761
5762 hdr <name> <fmt> adds to the response the HTTP header field whose name
5763 is specified in <name> and whose value is defined by
5764 <fmt>, which follows to the log-format rules.
5765 This parameter is ignored if an errorfile is used.
5766
5767 This directive may be used instead of "errorfile", to define a custom error
5768 message. As "errorfile" directive, it is used for errors detected and
5769 returned by HAProxy. If an errorfile is defined, it is parsed when HAProxy
5770 starts and must be valid according to the HTTP standards. The generated
5771 response must not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFFSIZE), otherwise an
5772 internal error will be returned. Finally, if you consider to use some
5773 http-after-response rules to rewrite these errors, the reserved buffer space
5774 should be available (see "tune.maxrewrite").
5775
5776 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
5777 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
5778 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running.
5779
Christopher Fauletd5ac6de2020-12-02 08:40:14 +01005780 Note: 400/408/500 errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are
5781 handled by the multiplexer at a lower level. No custom formatting is
5782 supported at this level. Thus only static error messages, defined with
5783 "errorfile" directive, are supported. However, this limitation only
5784 exists during the request headers parsing or between two transactions.
5785
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005786 See also : "errorfile", "errorfiles", "errorloc", "errorloc302",
5787 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
5788
5789
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005790http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005791 Access control for Layer 7 requests
5792
5793 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5794 no | yes | yes | yes
5795
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005796 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
5797 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
5798 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5799 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5800 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005801
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005802 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5803 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005804
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005805 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005806
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005807 Example:
5808 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
5809 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
5810 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005811
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005812 http-request allow if nagios
5813 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
5814 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
5815 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01005816
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005817 Example:
5818 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
5819 acl add path /addacl
5820 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005821
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005822 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005823
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005824 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
5825 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02005826
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005827 Example:
5828 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
5829 acl setmap path /setmap
5830 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005831
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005832 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005833
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005834 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
5835 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005836
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005837 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
5838 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005839
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005840http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005841
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005842 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5843 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5844 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5845 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
5846 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
5847 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5848 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5849 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005850
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005851http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005852
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005853 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
5854 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
5855 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
5856 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
5857 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
5858 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
5859 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
5860 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005861
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005862http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005863
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005864 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
5865 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005866
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005867
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005868http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005869
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005870 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
5871 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
5872 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
5873 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
5874 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005875
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02005876 The corresponding proxy's error message is used. It may be customized using
5877 an "errorfile" or an "http-error" directive. For 401 responses, all
5878 occurrences of the WWW-Authenticate header are removed and replaced by a new
5879 one with a basic authentication challenge for realm "<realm>". For 407
5880 responses, the same is done on the Proxy-Authenticate header. If the error
5881 message must not be altered, consider to use "http-request return" rule
5882 instead.
5883
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005884 Example:
5885 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
5886 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005887
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02005888http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005889
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02005890 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005891
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005892http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
5893 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005894
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005895 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
5896 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
5897 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
5898 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
5899 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
5900 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
5901 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
5902 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
5903 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005904
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005905 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
5906 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
5907 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01005908 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
5909
5910 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
5911 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
5912 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
5913 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005914
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005915http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005916
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005917 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5918 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5919 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5920 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5921 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5922 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005923
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005924http-request del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02005925
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005926 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
5927 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
5928 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
5929 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
5930 method is used.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02005931
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005932http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02005933
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005934 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5935 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5936 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5937 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5938 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
5939 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02005940
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005941http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5942http-request deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
5943 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5944 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
5945 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
5946 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04005947
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005948 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request.
5949 By default an HTTP 403 error is returned. But the response may be customized
5950 using same syntax than "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05005951 return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined,
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005952 or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
5953 "http-request deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
5954 "http-request deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005955 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005956 See also "http-request return".
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04005957
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02005958http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5959 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
5960 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
5961 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
5962
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01005963http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr> :
5964
5965 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
5966 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
5967 pointed by <resolvers>.
5968 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
5969 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
5970 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
5971 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
5972 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
5973 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
5974 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
5975 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
5976 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
5977 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
5978 to 0.0.0.0.
5979
5980 Example:
5981 resolvers mydns
5982 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
5983 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
5984 timeout retry 1s
5985 hold valid 10s
5986 hold nx 3s
5987 hold other 3s
5988 hold obsolete 0s
5989 accepted_payload_size 8192
5990
5991 frontend fe
5992 bind 10.42.0.1:80
5993 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower
5994 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
5995
5996 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
5997 # which mean DNS resolution error
5998 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
5999
6000 default_backend be
6001
6002 backend b_503
6003 # dummy backend used to return 503.
6004 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
6005 # 503 error page to end users
6006
6007 backend be
6008 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
6009 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
6010 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
6011 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
6012 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
6013
6014 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
6015 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
6016
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01006017http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6018
6019 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
6020 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
6021 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
6022 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01006023 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
6024 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01006025
6026 See RFC 8297 for more information.
6027
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006028http-request normalize-uri <normalizer> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006029http-request normalize-uri path-merge-slashes [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006030http-request normalize-uri path-strip-dot [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006031http-request normalize-uri path-strip-dotdot [ full ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006032http-request normalize-uri percent-decode-unreserved [ strict ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006033http-request normalize-uri percent-to-uppercase [ strict ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6034http-request normalize-uri query-sort-by-name [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006035
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006036 Performs normalization of the request's URI.
6037
Tim Duesterhus2963fd32021-04-17 00:24:56 +02006038 URI normalization in HAProxy 2.4 is currently available as an experimental
6039 technical preview. You should be prepared that the behavior of normalizers
6040 might change to fix possible issues, possibly breaking proper request
6041 processing in your infrastructure.
6042
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006043 Each normalizer handles a single type of normalization to allow for a
6044 fine-grained selection of the level of normalization that is appropriate for
6045 the supported backend.
6046
6047 As an example the "path-strip-dotdot" normalizer might be useful for a static
6048 fileserver that directly maps the requested URI to the path within the local
6049 filesystem. However it might break routing of an API that expects a specific
6050 number of segments in the path.
6051
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006052 It is important to note that some normalizers might result in unsafe
6053 transformations for broken URIs. It might also be possible that a combination
6054 of normalizers that are safe by themselves results in unsafe transformations
6055 when improperly combined.
6056
6057 As an example the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer might result in
6058 unexpected results when a broken URI includes bare percent characters. One
6059 such a broken URI is "/%%36%36" which would be decoded to "/%66" which in
6060 turn is equivalent to "/f". By specifying the "strict" option requests to
6061 such a broken URI would safely be rejected.
6062
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006063 The following normalizers are available:
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006064
Tim Duesterhusd6d33de2021-04-21 21:20:35 +02006065 - path-strip-dot: Removes "/./" segments within the "path" component
6066 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.3).
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006067
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006068 Segments including percent encoded dots ("%2E") will not be detected. Use
6069 the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer first if this is undesired.
6070
Tim Duesterhus7a95f412021-04-21 21:20:33 +02006071 Example:
6072 - /. -> /
6073 - /./bar/ -> /bar/
6074 - /a/./a -> /a/a
6075 - /.well-known/ -> /.well-known/ (no change)
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006076
Tim Duesterhusd6d33de2021-04-21 21:20:35 +02006077 - path-strip-dotdot: Normalizes "/../" segments within the "path" component
6078 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.3).
6079
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006080 This merges segments that attempt to access the parent directory with
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006081 their preceding segment.
6082
6083 Empty segments do not receive special treatment. Use the "merge-slashes"
6084 normalizer first if this is undesired.
6085
6086 Segments including percent encoded dots ("%2E") will not be detected. Use
6087 the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer first if this is undesired.
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006088
6089 Example:
6090 - /foo/../ -> /
6091 - /foo/../bar/ -> /bar/
6092 - /foo/bar/../ -> /foo/
6093 - /../bar/ -> /../bar/
Tim Duesterhus560e1a62021-04-15 21:46:00 +02006094 - /bar/../../ -> /../
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006095 - /foo//../ -> /foo/
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006096 - /foo/%2E%2E/ -> /foo/%2E%2E/
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006097
Tim Duesterhus560e1a62021-04-15 21:46:00 +02006098 If the "full" option is specified then "../" at the beginning will be
6099 removed as well:
6100
6101 Example:
6102 - /../bar/ -> /bar/
6103 - /bar/../../ -> /
6104
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006105 - path-merge-slashes: Merges adjacent slashes within the "path" component
6106 into a single slash.
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006107
6108 Example:
6109 - // -> /
6110 - /foo//bar -> /foo/bar
6111
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006112 - percent-decode-unreserved: Decodes unreserved percent encoded characters to
6113 their representation as a regular character (RFC 3986#6.2.2.2).
6114
6115 The set of unreserved characters includes all letters, all digits, "-",
6116 ".", "_", and "~".
6117
6118 Example:
6119 - /%61dmin -> /admin
6120 - /foo%3Fbar=baz -> /foo%3Fbar=baz (no change)
6121 - /%%36%36 -> /%66 (unsafe)
6122 - /%ZZ -> /%ZZ
6123
6124 If the "strict" option is specified then invalid sequences will result
6125 in a HTTP 400 Bad Request being returned.
6126
6127 Example:
6128 - /%%36%36 -> HTTP 400
6129 - /%ZZ -> HTTP 400
6130
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006131 - percent-to-uppercase: Uppercases letters within percent-encoded sequences
Tim Duesterhusc315efd2021-04-21 21:20:34 +02006132 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.1).
Tim Duesterhusa4071932021-04-15 21:46:02 +02006133
6134 Example:
6135 - /%6f -> /%6F
6136 - /%zz -> /%zz
6137
6138 If the "strict" option is specified then invalid sequences will result
6139 in a HTTP 400 Bad Request being returned.
6140
6141 Example:
6142 - /%zz -> HTTP 400
6143
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006144 - query-sort-by-name: Sorts the query string parameters by parameter name.
Tim Duesterhusd7b89be2021-04-15 21:46:01 +02006145 Parameters are assumed to be delimited by '&'. Shorter names sort before
6146 longer names and identical parameter names maintain their relative order.
6147
6148 Example:
6149 - /?c=3&a=1&b=2 -> /?a=1&b=2&c=3
6150 - /?aaa=3&a=1&aa=2 -> /?a=1&aa=2&aaa=3
6151 - /?a=3&b=4&a=1&b=5&a=2 -> /?a=3&a=1&a=2&b=4&b=5
6152
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006153http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006154
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006155 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
6156 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
6157 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
6158 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
6159 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006160
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006161http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006162
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006163 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
6164 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
6165 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
6166 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006167
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006168http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6169 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02006170
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006171 This matches the value of all occurrences of header field <name> against
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006172 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
6173 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
6174 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
6175 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
6176 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02006177
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006178 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
6179 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
6180 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
6181 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
6182 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01006183
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006184 Example:
6185 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
6186
6187 # applied to:
6188 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
6189
6190 # outputs:
6191 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
6192
6193 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006194
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006195 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
6196
6197 # applied to:
6198 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006199
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006200 # outputs:
6201 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006202
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006203http-request replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6204 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6205
6206 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's path
6207 component instead of a header. The path component starts at the first '/'
Christopher Faulet82c83322020-09-02 14:16:59 +02006208 after an optional scheme+authority and ends before the question mark. Thus,
6209 the replacement does not modify the scheme, the authority and the
6210 query-string.
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006211
6212 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
6213 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
6214 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
6215
6216 Example:
6217 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
6218 http-request replace-path (.*) /foo\1
6219
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006220 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
6221 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1
6222 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
6223 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
6224
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02006225http-request replace-pathq <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6226 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6227
6228 This does the same as "http-request replace-path" except that the path
6229 contains the query-string if any is present. Thus, the path and the
6230 query-string are replaced.
6231
6232 Example:
6233 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
6234 http-request replace-pathq ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
6235
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006236http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6237 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6238
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006239 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
6240 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
6241 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
6242 against.
6243
6244 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
6245 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
6246 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006247
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006248 IMPORTANT NOTE: historically in HTTP/1.x, the vast majority of requests sent
6249 by browsers use the "origin form", which differs from the "absolute form" in
6250 that they do not contain a scheme nor authority in the URI portion. Mostly
6251 only requests sent to proxies, those forged by hand and some emitted by
6252 certain applications use the absolute form. As such, "replace-uri" usually
6253 works fine most of the time in HTTP/1.x with rules starting with a "/". But
6254 with HTTP/2, clients are encouraged to send absolute URIs only, which look
6255 like the ones HTTP/1 clients use to talk to proxies. Such partial replace-uri
6256 rules may then fail in HTTP/2 when they work in HTTP/1. Either the rules need
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006257 to be adapted to optionally match a scheme and authority, or replace-path
6258 should be used.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006259
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006260 Example:
6261 # rewrite all "http" absolute requests to "https":
6262 http-request replace-uri ^http://(.*) https://\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006263
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006264 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
6265 http-request replace-uri ([^/:]*://[^/]*)?(.*) \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006266
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006267http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6268 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006269
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006270 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
6271 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
6272 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
6273 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006274
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006275 Example:
6276 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02006277
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006278 # applied to:
6279 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02006280
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006281 # outputs:
6282 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01006283
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006284http-request return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
6285 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6286 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006287 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006288 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6289
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006290 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006291 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
6292 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006293 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006294 be defined. It can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006295 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006296 are followed to create the response :
6297
6298 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
6299 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
6300 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
6301 ignored.
6302
6303 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
6304 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006305 status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006306 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if
6307 any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006308
6309 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
6310 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
6311 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006312 by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501,
6313 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006314
6315 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
6316 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
6317 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006318 must be one of the status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006319 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006320 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006321
6322 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
6323 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
6324 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
6325 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
6326 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
6327 as a raw content.
6328
6329 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
6330 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
6331 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
6332 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
6333 considered as a raw string.
6334
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006335 When the response is not based on an errorfile, it is possible to append HTTP
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006336 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
6337 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
6338 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
6339
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006340 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
6341 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006342 reserved for the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006343
6344 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6345
6346 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006347 http-request return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006348 if { path /ping }
6349
6350 http-request return content-type image/x-icon file /var/www/favicon.ico \
6351 if { path /favicon.ico }
6352
6353 http-request return status 403 content-type text/plain \
6354 lf-string "Access denied. IP %[src] is blacklisted." \
6355 if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
6356
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006357http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6358http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006359
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006360 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
6361 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
6362 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006363
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006364http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6365 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006366
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006367 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
6368 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
6369 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
6370 evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006371
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006372http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006373
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006374 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
6375 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
6376 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
6377 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
6378 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006379
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006380 Arguments:
6381 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6382 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006383
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006384 Example:
6385 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
6386 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006387
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006388 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
6389 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006390
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006391http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006392
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006393 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
6394 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
6395 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006396
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006397 Arguments:
6398 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6399 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006400
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006401 Example:
6402 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
6403 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006404
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006405 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
6406 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
6407 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006408
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006409http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006410
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006411 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
6412 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
6413 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
6414 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
6415 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006416
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006417 Example:
6418 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
6419 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
6420 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
6421 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
6422 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
6423 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
6424 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
6425 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
6426 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006427
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006428http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006429
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006430 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
6431 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
6432 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
6433 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
6434 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006435
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006436http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
6437 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006438
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006439 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6440 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6441 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
6442 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
6443 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
6444 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
6445 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
6446 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
6447 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006448
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006449http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006450
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006451 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
6452 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
6453 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
6454 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
6455 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
6456 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
6457 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02006458
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006459http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006460
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006461 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
6462 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
6463 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006464
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006465http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006466
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006467 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
6468 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
6469 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
6470 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
6471 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
6472 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
6473 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
6474 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006475
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006476http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02006477
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006478 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
6479 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
6480 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
6481 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
6482 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
6483 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02006484
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006485 Example :
6486 # prepend the host name before the path
6487 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006488
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02006489http-request set-pathq <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6490
6491 This does the same as "http-request set-path" except that the query-string is
6492 also rewritten. It may be used to remove the query-string, including the
6493 question mark (it is not possible using "http-request set-query").
6494
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006495http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02006496
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006497 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
6498 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
6499 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
6500 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
6501 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006502
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006503http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006504
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006505 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
6506 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
6507 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
6508 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
6509 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
6510 values have higher priority.
6511 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
6512 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
6513 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
6514 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
6515 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006516
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006517http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006518
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006519 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
6520 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
6521 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
6522 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
6523 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
6524 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
6525 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006526
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006527 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006528
6529 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006530 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
6531 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006532
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006533http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6534 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
6535 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
6536 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006537 privacy. All subsequent calls to "src" fetch will return this value
6538 (see example).
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006539
6540 Arguments :
6541 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6542 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006543
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006544 See also "option forwardfor".
6545
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006546 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006547 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
6548 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
6549
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006550 # After the masking this will track connections
6551 # based on the IP address with the last byte zeroed out.
6552 http-request track-sc0 src
6553
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006554 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
6555 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
6556
6557http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6558
6559 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
6560 expression.
6561
6562 Arguments:
6563 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6564 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006565
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006566 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006567 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
6568 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
6569
6570 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
6571 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
6572 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
6573
Amaury Denoyelle8d228232020-12-10 13:43:54 +01006574http-request set-timeout server|tunnel { <timeout> | <expr> }
6575 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6576
6577 This action overrides the specified "server" or "tunnel" timeout for the
6578 current stream only. The timeout can be specified in millisecond or with any
6579 other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit as explained at the top of
6580 this document. It is also possible to write an expression which must returns
6581 a number interpreted as a timeout in millisecond.
6582
6583 Note that the server/tunnel timeouts are only relevant on the backend side
6584 and thus this rule is only available for the proxies with backend
6585 capabilities. Also the timeout value must be non-null to obtain the expected
6586 results.
6587
6588 Example:
6589 http-request set-timeout server 5s
6590 http-request set-timeout hdr(host),map_int(host.lst)
6591
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006592http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6593
6594 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
6595 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
6596 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
6597 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
6598 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
6599 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
6600 information from the request.
6601
6602 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
6603
6604http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6605
6606 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
6607 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
6608 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
6609 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
6610 path and the query string.
6611 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
6612
6613http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6614
6615 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
6616 inline.
6617
6618 Arguments:
6619 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
6620 scope. The scopes allowed are:
6621 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
6622 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
6623 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
6624 (request and response)
6625 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
6626 processing
6627 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
6628 processing
6629 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
6630 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
6631 and '_'.
6632
6633 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6634 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006635
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006636 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006637 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006638
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006639http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
6640 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006641
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006642 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
6643 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
6644 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
6645 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
6646 agent name must be used.
6647
6648 Arguments:
6649 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
6650
6651 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
6652 configuration.
6653
6654http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6655
6656 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
6657 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
6658 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
6659 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
6660 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
6661 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
6662 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
6663 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
6664 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
6665 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
6666 action.
6667 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
6668 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
6669 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
6670 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
6671 you fully understand how it works.
6672
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006673http-request strict-mode { on | off }
6674
6675 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
6676 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
6677 performing a rewrite on the requests. When the strict mode is enabled, any
6678 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
6679 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006680 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the request
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006681 processing.
6682
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01006683 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006684 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
6685 the frontend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the backend
6686 rules evaluation.
6687
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006688http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6689http-request tarpit [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6690 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6691 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6692 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6693 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006694
6695 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
6696 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
6697 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006698 is still connected, a response is returned so that the client does not
6699 suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT". The goal of
6700 the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when they're limited
6701 on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very efficient against very
6702 dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load on firewalls compared to
6703 a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly" developed robots, it can make
6704 things worse by forcing haproxy and the front firewall to support insane
6705 number of concurrent connections. By default an HTTP error 500 is returned.
6706 But the response may be customized using same syntax than
6707 "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request return" for details.
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006708 For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined, or only "deny_status",
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006709 the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
6710 "http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
6711 "http-request tarpit [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
6712 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6713 See also "http-request return" and "http-request silent-drop".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006714
6715http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6716http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6717http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6718
6719 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
6720 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
6721 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
6722 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
Matteo Contrini1857b8c2020-10-16 17:35:54 +02006723 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). The first
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006724 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
6725 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
6726 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
6727 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
6728 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
6729 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
6730 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
6731
6732 Arguments :
6733 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
6734 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
6735 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
6736 select which table entry to update the counters.
6737
6738 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
6739 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
6740 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
6741 that table until the session ends.
6742
6743 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
6744 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
6745 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
6746 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
6747 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
6748 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
6749 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
6750 useful information.
6751
6752 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
6753 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
6754 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
6755 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
6756 checks that make use of it.
6757
6758http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6759
6760 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006761
6762 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006763 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006764
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01006765http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6766
6767 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
6768 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
6769 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
6770 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
6771 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
6772 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6773
6774 Arguments :
6775 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
6776
6777 Example:
6778 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
6779
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02006780http-request wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
6781 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6782
6783 This will delay the processing of the request waiting for the payload for at
6784 most <time> milliseconds. if "at-least" argument is specified, HAProxy stops
6785 to wait the payload when the first <bytes> bytes are received. 0 means no
6786 limit, it is the default value. Regardless the "at-least" argument value,
6787 HAProxy stops to wait if the whole payload is received or if the request
6788 buffer is full. This action may be used as a replacement to "option
6789 http-buffer-request".
6790
6791 Arguments :
6792
6793 <time> is mandatory. It is the maximum time to wait for the body. It
6794 follows the HAProxy time format and is expressed in milliseconds.
6795
6796 <bytes> is optional. It is the minimum payload size to receive to stop to
6797 wait. It fallows the HAProxy size format and is expressed in
6798 bytes.
6799
6800 Example:
6801 http-request wait-for-body time 1s at-least 1k if METH_POST
6802
6803 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
6804
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006805http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006806
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006807 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
6808 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
6809 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006810
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006811
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006812http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006813 Access control for Layer 7 responses
6814
6815 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6816 no | yes | yes | yes
6817
6818 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
6819 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
6820 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
6821 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
6822 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
6823 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
6824
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006825 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
6826 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006827
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006828 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006829
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006830 Example:
6831 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02006832
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006833 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006834
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006835 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
6836 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006837
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006838 Example:
6839 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006840
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006841 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006842
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006843 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
6844 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006845
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006846 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
6847 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006848
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006849http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006850
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006851 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6852 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6853 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6854 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
6855 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
6856 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
6857 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6858 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006859
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006860http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006861
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006862 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
6863 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
6864 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
6865 example, or to pass some internal information.
6866 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
6867 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
6868 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006869
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006870http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006871
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006872 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
6873 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006874
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02006875http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006876
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006877 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006878
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006879http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006880
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006881 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
6882 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
6883 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
6884 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
6885 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
6886 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
6887 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02006888
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006889 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
6890 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
6891 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
6892 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
6893 keyword.
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01006894
6895 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
6896 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
6897 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
6898 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02006899
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006900http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02006901
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006902 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6903 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6904 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6905 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6906 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6907 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02006908
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006909http-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02006910
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006911 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
6912 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
6913 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
6914 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
6915 method is used.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02006916
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006917http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02006918
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006919 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6920 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6921 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6922 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6923 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
6924 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006925
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006926http-response deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6927http-response deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6928 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6929 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6930 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6931 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006932
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006933 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response.
6934 By default an HTTP 502 error is returned. But the response may be customized
6935 using same syntax than "http-response return" rules. Thus, see
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006936 "http-response return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006937 argument is defined, or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles"
6938 is implied. It means "http-response deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias
6939 of "http-response deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01006940 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006941 See also "http-response return".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006942
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006943http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006944
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006945 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
6946 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
6947 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
6948 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
6949 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
6950 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02006951
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006952http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
6953 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02006954
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006955 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
6956 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01006957
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006958 Example:
6959 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02006960
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006961 # applied to:
6962 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006963
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006964 # outputs:
6965 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006966
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006967 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006968
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006969http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
6970 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006971
Tim Duesterhus6bd909b2020-01-17 15:53:18 +01006972 This works like "http-request replace-value" except that it works on the
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006973 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006974
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006975 Example:
6976 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006977
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006978 # applied to:
6979 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006980
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006981 # outputs:
6982 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006983
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006984http-response return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
6985 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6986 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006987 [ hdr <name> <value> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006988 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6989
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006990 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006991 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
6992 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006993 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006994 be defined. If can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006995 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006996 are followed to create the response :
6997
6998 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
6999 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
7000 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
7001 ignored.
7002
7003 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
7004 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007005 status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007006 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if
7007 any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007008
7009 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
7010 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
7011 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007012 by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501,
7013 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007014
7015 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
7016 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
7017 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007018 must be one of the status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007019 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02007020 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007021
7022 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
7023 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
7024 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
7025 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
7026 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
7027 as a raw content.
7028
7029 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
7030 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
7031 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
7032 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
7033 considered as a raw string.
7034
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01007035 When the response is not based an errorfile, it is possible to appends HTTP
7036 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
7037 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
7038 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
7039
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007040 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
7041 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05007042 reserved to the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007043
7044 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
7045
7046 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007047 http-response return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007048 if { status eq 404 }
7049
7050 http-response return content-type text/plain \
7051 string "This is the end !" \
7052 if { status eq 500 }
7053
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007054http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7055http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08007056
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007057 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
7058 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
7059 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02007060
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01007061http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7062 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02007063
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01007064 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
7065 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
7066 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
7067 evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01007068
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007069http-response send-spoe-group [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02007070
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007071 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
7072 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
7073 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
7074 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
7075 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007076
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007077 Arguments:
7078 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007079
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007080 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
7081 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007082
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007083http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007084
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007085 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
7086 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
7087 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007088
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007089http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7090
7091 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
7092 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
7093 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
7094 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
7095 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
7096
7097http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
7098
7099 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
7100 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
7101 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
7102 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
7103 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
7104 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
7105 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
7106 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
7107 be triggered by an HTTP response.
7108
7109http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7110
7111 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
7112 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
7113 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
7114 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
7115 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
7116 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
7117 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
7118
7119http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7120
7121 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
7122 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
7123 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
7124 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
7125 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
7126 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
7127 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
7128 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
7129
7130http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
7131 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7132
7133 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
7134 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
7135 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
7136 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007137
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007138 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007139 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
7140 http-response set-status 431
7141 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
7142 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007143
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007144http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007145
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007146 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
7147 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
7148 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
7149 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
7150 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
7151 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
7152 based on some information from the request.
7153
7154 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
7155
7156http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7157
7158 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
7159 inline.
7160
7161 Arguments:
7162 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
7163 scope. The scopes allowed are:
7164 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
7165 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
7166 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
7167 (request and response)
7168 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
7169 processing
7170 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
7171 processing
7172 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
7173 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
7174 and '_'.
7175
7176 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
7177 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007178
7179 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007180 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007181
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007182http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007183
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007184 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
7185 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
7186 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
7187 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
7188 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
7189 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
7190 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
7191 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
7192 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
7193 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
7194 action.
7195 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
7196 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
7197 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
7198 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
7199 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007200
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007201http-response strict-mode { on | off }
7202
7203 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
7204 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
7205 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
7206 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
7207 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007208 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007209 processing.
7210
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01007211 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007212 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007213 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007214 rules evaluation.
7215
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007216http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7217http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7218http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007219
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007220 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
7221 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
7222 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
7223 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
7224 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
7225 supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
7226
7227http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7228
7229 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
7230 about <var-name>.
7231
7232 Example:
7233 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
7234
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007235http-response wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
7236 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7237
7238 This will delay the processing of the response waiting for the payload for at
7239 most <time> milliseconds. if "at-least" argument is specified, HAProxy stops
7240 to wait the payload when the first <bytes> bytes are received. 0 means no
7241 limit, it is the default value. Regardless the "at-least" argument value,
7242 HAProxy stops to wait if the whole payload is received or if the response
7243 buffer is full.
7244
7245 Arguments :
7246
7247 <time> is mandatory. It is the maximum time to wait for the body. It
7248 follows the HAProxy time format and is expressed in milliseconds.
7249
7250 <bytes> is optional. It is the minimum payload size to receive to stop to
7251 wait. It fallows the HAProxy size format and is expressed in
7252 bytes.
7253
7254 Example:
7255 http-response wait-for-body time 1s at-least 10k
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02007256
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007257http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
7258 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
7259
7260 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7261 yes | no | yes | yes
7262
7263 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007264 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
7265 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
7266 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007267
7268 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
7269
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007270 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
7271 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
7272 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
7273 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
7274 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
7275 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
7276 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
7277 such an application could be an old haproxy using cookie
7278 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
7279 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007280
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007281 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
7282 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
7283 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
7284 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
7285 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
7286 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
7287 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
Amaury Denoyelle27179652020-10-14 18:17:12 +02007288 effects. There is also a special handling for the connections
7289 using protocols subject to Head-of-line blocking (backend with
7290 h2 or fcgi). In this case, when at least one stream is
7291 processed, the used connection is reserved to handle streams
7292 of the same session. When no more streams are processed, the
7293 connection is released and can be reused.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007294
7295 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
7296 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
7297 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
7298 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
7299 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
7300 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
7301 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
7302 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02007303 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007304 downsides of rare connection failures.
7305
7306 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
7307 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
7308 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
7309 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
7310 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
7311 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007312 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007313 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
7314 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
7315 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
7316 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
7317 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
7318
7319 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Amaury Denoyelled773a4e2021-01-29 15:18:49 +01007320 connection properties and compatibility. Indeed, some properties are specific
7321 and it is not possibly to reuse it blindly. Those are the SSL SNI, source
7322 and destination address and proxy protocol block. A connection is reused only
7323 if it shares the same set of properties with the request.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007324
Amaury Denoyelled773a4e2021-01-29 15:18:49 +01007325 Also note that connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying
7326 on the connection) like NTLM are marked private and never shared.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007327
Lukas Tribuse8adfeb2019-11-06 11:50:25 +01007328 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007329
7330 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
7331 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
7332 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
7333
7334 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
7335
7336
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007337http-send-name-header [<header>]
7338 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007339 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7340 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007341 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007342 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
7343
Willy Tarreau81bef7e2019-10-07 14:58:02 +02007344 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
7345 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
7346 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
7347 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
7348 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
7349 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
7350 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
7351 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
7352 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
7353 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
7354 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
7355 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
7356 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
7357 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
7358 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
7359 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007360
7361 See also : "server"
7362
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01007363id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02007364 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
7365 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7366 no | yes | yes | yes
7367 Arguments : none
7368
7369 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
7370 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
7371 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01007372
7373
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007374ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
7375 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
7376 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01007377 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007378
7379 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
7380 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
7381 and running).
7382
7383 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
7384 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
7385 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007386 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007387 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
7388
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007389 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
7390 "unless" condition is met.
7391
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03007392 Example:
7393 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
7394 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
7395 ignore-persist if url_static
7396
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007397 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
7398
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007399load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
7400 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
7401 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7402 yes | no | yes | yes
7403
7404 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
7405 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
7406 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007407 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007408 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
7409 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
7410 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
7411 over the stats socket and redirect output.
7412
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007413 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007414 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02007415 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007416
7417 Arguments:
7418 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
7419 named "server-state-file".
7420
7421 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
7422 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
7423 name is used as a file name.
7424
7425 none don't load any stat for this backend
7426
7427 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01007428 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
7429 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
7430 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007431 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01007432 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007433
7434 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
7435 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
7436
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007437 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007438
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007439 global
7440 stats socket /tmp/socket
7441 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007442
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007443 defaults
7444 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007445
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007446 backend bk
7447 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
7448 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007449
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007450
7451 Then one can run :
7452
7453 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
7454
7455 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
7456
7457 1
7458 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
7459 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7460 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7461
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007462 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007463
7464 global
7465 stats socket /tmp/socket
7466 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
7467
7468 defaults
7469 load-server-state-from-file local
7470
7471 backend bk
7472 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
7473 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
7474
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007475
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007476 Then one can run :
7477
7478 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
7479
7480 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
7481
7482 1
7483 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
7484 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7485 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7486
7487 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
7488 "show servers state"
7489
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007490
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007491log global
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01007492log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02007493 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007494no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007495 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
7496 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7497 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007498
7499 Prefix :
7500 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
7501 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
7502 prefix does not allow arguments.
7503
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007504 Arguments :
7505 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
7506 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
7507 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
7508 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
7509 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
7510 parameter.
7511
7512 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
7513 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
7514
7515 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
7516 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
7517 standard syslog port).
7518
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01007519 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
7520 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
7521 standard syslog port).
7522
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007523 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
7524 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
7525 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007526 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007527
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007528 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
7529 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
7530 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
7531 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
7532 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
7533 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
7534 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
7535 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
7536 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
7537 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
7538 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
7539 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
7540 significantly slow haproxy down as non-blocking calls will be
7541 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
7542 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
7543 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007544 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
7545 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007546
7547 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
7548 and "fd@2", see above.
7549
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02007550 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond
7551 to an in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the
7552 "show events" command, which will also list existing rings and
7553 their sizes. Such buffers are lost on reload or restart but
7554 when used as a complement this can help troubleshooting by
7555 having the logs instantly available.
7556
Emeric Brun94aab062021-04-02 10:41:36 +02007557 - An explicit stream address prefix such as "tcp@","tcp6@",
7558 "tcp4@" or "uxst@" will allocate an implicit ring buffer with
7559 a stream forward server targeting the given address.
7560
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007561 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7562 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01007563
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02007564 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
7565 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
7566 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
7567 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
7568 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
7569 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
7570 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
7571 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
7572 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
7573 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007574 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02007575
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02007576 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
7577 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
7578 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
7579 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
7580 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
7581
7582 <sample_size>
7583 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
7584 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
7585 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
7586 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
7587 (see also <ranges> parameter).
7588
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01007589 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
7590 one of the following :
7591
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01007592 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
7593 field is stripped. This is the default.
7594 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
7595 rfc3164.
7596
7597 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01007598 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
7599
7600 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
7601 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
7602
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02007603 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
7604 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
7605 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
7606 designed to be used with a local log server.
7607
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01007608 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
7609 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
7610 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
7611 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
7612 systemd logger consumes.
7613
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02007614 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
7615 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
7616 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
7617 used with a local log server.
7618
7619 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
7620 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
7621 designed to be used with a local log server.
7622
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007623 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
7624 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
7625 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
7626 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
7627
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007628 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
7629
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01007630 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
7631 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
7632 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
7633
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007634 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
7635 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
7636 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
7637 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007638
7639 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
7640 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
7641 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02007642 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
7643 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
7644 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
7645 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
7646 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007647
7648 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
7649
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007650 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
7651 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
7652 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007653
7654 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
7655 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
7656 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
7657 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
7658
7659 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
7660 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007661
7662 Example :
7663 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007664 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
7665 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
7666 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02007667 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
Emeric Brun94aab062021-04-02 10:41:36 +02007668 log tcp@127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output
7669 # level and send in tcp
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007670 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01007671
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007672
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007673log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01007674 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
7675 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7676 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007677
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01007678 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
7679 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
7680 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
7681 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
7682 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007683
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007684 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
7685 "option httplog" directives.
7686
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02007687log-format-sd <string>
7688 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
7689 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7690 yes | yes | yes | no
7691
7692 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
7693 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
7694 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
7695 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
7696 which covers the log format string in depth.
7697
7698 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
7699 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
7700
7701 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
7702 log format to "rfc5424".
7703
7704 Example :
7705 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
7706
7707
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01007708log-tag <string>
7709 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
7710 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7711 yes | yes | yes | yes
7712
7713 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
7714 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
7715 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
7716 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
7717 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
7718 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
7719 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
7720 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
7721 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007722
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007723max-keep-alive-queue <value>
7724 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
7725 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7726 yes | no | yes | yes
7727
7728 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
7729 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
7730 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
7731 servers.
7732
7733 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
7734 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
7735 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
7736 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
7737 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007738 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007739 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
7740 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
7741 picking a different server.
7742
7743 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
7744 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
7745 even if they have to be queued.
7746
7747 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
7748 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
7749
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01007750max-session-srv-conns <nb>
7751 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
7752 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
7753 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007754
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007755maxconn <conns>
7756 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
7757 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7758 yes | yes | yes | no
7759 Arguments :
7760 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
7761 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
7762 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
7763 closes.
7764
7765 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
7766 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
7767 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
7768 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01007769 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
7770 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
7771 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
7772 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007773
7774 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
7775 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
7776 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
7777
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01007778 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
7779 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02007780
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007781 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
7782
7783
Willy Tarreau77e0dae2020-10-14 15:44:27 +02007784mode { tcp|http }
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007785 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
7786 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7787 yes | yes | yes | yes
7788 Arguments :
7789 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
7790 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
7791 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
7792 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
7793
7794 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
7795 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
7796 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
7797 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
7798 brings HAProxy most of its value.
7799
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007800 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
7801 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
7802 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007803
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007804 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007805 defaults http_instances
7806 mode http
7807
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007808
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01007809monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007810 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007811 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7812 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007813 Arguments :
7814 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
7815 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007816 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007817 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
7818 backend and its backup.
7819
7820 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
7821 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
7822 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
7823 servers in a list of backends.
7824
7825 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
7826 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
7827 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
7828 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
7829 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
7830 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
7831 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02007832 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
7833 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007834
7835 Example:
7836 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007837 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007838 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
7839 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
7840 monitor-uri /site_alive
7841 monitor fail if site_dead
7842
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02007843 See also : "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007844
7845
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007846monitor-uri <uri>
7847 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
7848 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7849 yes | yes | yes | no
7850 Arguments :
7851 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
7852 health status instead of forwarding the request.
7853
7854 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
7855 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
7856 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
7857 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
7858 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
7859 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
7860 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
7861 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
7862
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01007863 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007864 and even before any "http-request". The only rulesets applied before are the
7865 tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
7866 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
7867 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
7868 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
7869 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007870
Christopher Faulet6072beb2020-02-18 15:34:58 +01007871 Note: if <uri> starts by a slash ('/'), the matching is performed against the
7872 request's path instead of the request's uri. It is a workaround to let
7873 the HTTP/2 requests match the monitor-uri. Indeed, in HTTP/2, clients
7874 are encouraged to send absolute URIs only.
7875
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007876 Example :
7877 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
7878 frontend www
7879 mode http
7880 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
7881
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02007882 See also : "monitor fail"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007883
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007884
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007885option abortonclose
7886no option abortonclose
7887 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
7888 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7889 yes | no | yes | yes
7890 Arguments : none
7891
7892 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
7893 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
7894 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
7895 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007896 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007897 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
7898 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
7899 encountered while delivering the response.
7900
7901 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
7902 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
7903 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
7904 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
7905 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
7906 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007907 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007908 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007909 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007910 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
7911 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
7912 still not served and not pollute the servers.
7913
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007914 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
7915 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007916 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
7917 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
7918 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
7919 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
7920 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
7921 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007922 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007923
7924 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7925 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7926
7927 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
7928
7929
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007930option accept-invalid-http-request
7931no option accept-invalid-http-request
7932 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
7933 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7934 yes | yes | yes | no
7935 Arguments : none
7936
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007937 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007938 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007939 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007940 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
7941 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
7942 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
7943 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
7944 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01007945 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
7946 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
7947 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
7948 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007949 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007950 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02007951 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
7952 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
7953 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007954
7955 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
7956 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
7957 been confirmed.
7958
7959 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
7960 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01007961 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
7962 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007963 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
7964
7965 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7966 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7967
7968 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
7969 stats socket.
7970
7971
7972option accept-invalid-http-response
7973no option accept-invalid-http-response
7974 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
7975 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7976 yes | no | yes | yes
7977 Arguments : none
7978
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007979 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007980 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007981 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007982 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
7983 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
7984 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
7985 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
7986 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007987 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
7988 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
7989 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007990
7991 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
7992 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
7993 been confirmed.
7994
7995 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
7996 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
7997 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
7998 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
7999
8000 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8001 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8002
8003 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
8004 stats socket.
8005
8006
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008007option allbackups
8008no option allbackups
8009 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
8010 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8011 yes | no | yes | yes
8012 Arguments : none
8013
8014 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
8015 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
8016 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
8017 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
8018 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
8019 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
8020 order between the backup servers anymore.
8021
8022 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
8023 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
8024
8025 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8026 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8027
8028
8029option checkcache
8030no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08008031 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008032 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8033 yes | no | yes | yes
8034 Arguments : none
8035
8036 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
8037 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008038 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008039 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
8040 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008041 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008042
8043 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008044 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008045 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008046 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
8047 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008048 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008049 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01008050 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
8051 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008052 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01008053 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
8054 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008055 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008056 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
8057 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
8058 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
8059 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
8060 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
8061 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
8062 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
8063 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
8064 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
8065
8066 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008067 just as if it was from an "http-response deny" rule, with an "HTTP 502 bad
8068 gateway". The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the
8069 response during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in
8070 the logs so that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008071
8072 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
8073 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008074 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008075 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008076
8077 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8078 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8079
8080
8081option clitcpka
8082no option clitcpka
8083 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
8084 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8085 yes | yes | yes | no
8086 Arguments : none
8087
8088 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
8089 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008090 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008091 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
8092
8093 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
8094 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
8095 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
8096 operating system and its tuning parameters.
8097
8098 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
8099 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
8100 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
8101 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
8102 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
8103
8104 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
8105
8106 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
8107 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
8108 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
8109
8110 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8111 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8112
8113 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
8114
8115
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008116option contstats
8117 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
8118 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8119 yes | yes | yes | no
8120 Arguments : none
8121
8122 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
8123 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
8124 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
8125 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01008126 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
8127 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
8128 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
8129 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
8130 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008131
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02008132option disable-h2-upgrade
8133no option disable-h2-upgrade
8134 Enable or disable the implicit HTTP/2 upgrade from an HTTP/1.x client
8135 connection.
8136 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8137 yes | yes | yes | no
8138 Arguments : none
8139
8140 By default, HAProxy is able to implicitly upgrade an HTTP/1.x client
8141 connection to an HTTP/2 connection if the first request it receives from a
8142 given HTTP connection matches the HTTP/2 connection preface (i.e. the string
8143 "PRI * HTTP/2.0\r\n\r\nSM\r\n\r\n"). This way, it is possible to support
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +01008144 HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 clients on a non-SSL connections. This option must be
8145 used to disable the implicit upgrade. Note this implicit upgrade is only
8146 supported for HTTP proxies, thus this option too. Note also it is possible to
8147 force the HTTP/2 on clear connections by specifying "proto h2" on the bind
8148 line. Finally, this option is applied on all bind lines. To disable implicit
8149 HTTP/2 upgrades for a specific bind line, it is possible to use "proto h1".
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02008150
8151 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8152 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008153
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008154option dontlog-normal
8155no option dontlog-normal
8156 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
8157 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8158 yes | yes | yes | no
8159 Arguments : none
8160
8161 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
8162 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
8163 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
8164 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
8165 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
8166 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
8167 logged.
8168
8169 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
8170 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
8171 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
8172
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008173 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008174 logging.
8175
8176
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008177option dontlognull
8178no option dontlognull
8179 Enable or disable logging of null connections
8180 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8181 yes | yes | yes | no
8182 Arguments : none
8183
8184 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
8185 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
8186 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
8187 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
8188 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
8189 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008190 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
8191 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
8192 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008193
8194 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008195 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008196 would not be logged.
8197
8198 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8199 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8200
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02008201 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-uri", and
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008202 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008203
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008204
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008205option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008206 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
8207 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8208 yes | yes | yes | yes
8209 Arguments :
8210 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
8211 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008212 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008213 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008214
8215 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
8216 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
8217 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
8218 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
8219 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
8220 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
8221 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008222 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
8223 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
8224 possible that the client has already brought one.
8225
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008226 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008227 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008228 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008229 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008230 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008231 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008232
8233 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
8234 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
8235 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
8236 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
8237 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
8238 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
Christopher Faulet5d1def62021-02-26 09:19:15 +01008239 private networks or 127.0.0.1. IPv4 and IPv6 are both supported.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008240
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008241 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
8242 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
8243 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
8244 are under the control of the end-user.
8245
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008246 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008247 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
8248 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008249 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
8250 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
8251 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008252
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02008253 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008254 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
8255 frontend www
8256 mode http
8257 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
8258
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008259 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
8260 backend www
8261 mode http
8262 option forwardfor header X-Client
8263
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008264 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008265 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008266
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008267
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02008268option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
8269no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
8270 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
8271 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8272 yes | yes | yes | no
8273 Arguments : none
8274
8275 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
8276 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
8277 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
8278 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
8279 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
8280 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
8281 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
8282
8283 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
8284 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
8285 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
8286 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
8287 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
8288 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
8289 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
8290 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
8291 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
8292 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
8293
8294 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
8295
8296 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8297 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8298
8299 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
8300 "h1-case-adjust-file".
8301
8302
8303option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
8304no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
8305 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
8306 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8307 yes | no | yes | yes
8308 Arguments : none
8309
8310 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
8311 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
8312 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
8313 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
8314 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
8315 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
8316 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
8317
8318 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
8319 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
8320 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
8321 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
8322 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
8323 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
8324 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
8325 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
8326 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
8327 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
8328
8329 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
8330
8331 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8332 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8333
8334 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
8335 "h1-case-adjust-file".
8336
8337
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008338option http-buffer-request
8339no option http-buffer-request
8340 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
8341 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8342 yes | yes | yes | yes
8343 Arguments : none
8344
8345 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
8346 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
8347 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
8348 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
8349 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
8350 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
Christopher Faulet6db8a2e2019-11-19 16:27:25 +01008351 body is received or the request buffer is full. It can have undesired side
8352 effects with some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered
8353 transmissions between the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely
8354 not be used by default.
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008355
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02008356 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request",
8357 "http-request wait-for-body"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008358
8359
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008360option http-ignore-probes
8361no option http-ignore-probes
8362 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
8363 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8364 yes | yes | yes | no
8365 Arguments : none
8366
8367 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
8368 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
8369 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
8370 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
8371 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
8372 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
8373 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
8374 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
8375 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008376 was received over a connection before it was closed;
8377 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008378 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
8379
8380 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
8381 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
8382 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
8383 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
8384 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
8385 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
8386 are often the only way to detect them.
8387
8388 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8389 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8390
8391 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
8392
8393
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008394option http-keep-alive
8395no option http-keep-alive
8396 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
8397 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8398 yes | yes | yes | yes
8399 Arguments : none
8400
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008401 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8402 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008403 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8404 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008405 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". This option allows to
8406 set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when another mode was used
8407 in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008408
8409 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
8410 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008411 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
8412 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
8413 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
8414 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
8415 situations where this option may be useful :
8416
8417 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008418 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008419
8420 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
8421 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
8422
8423 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
8424 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
8425 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
8426 request.
8427
8428 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
8429 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008430 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
8431 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
8432 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008433
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008434 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
8435 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
8436 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
8437 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
8438 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
8439 not set.
8440
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008441 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
8442 http-server-close". When backend and frontend options differ, all of these 4
8443 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008444
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008445 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008446 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01008447 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008448
8449
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008450option http-no-delay
8451no option http-no-delay
8452 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
8453 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8454 yes | yes | yes | yes
8455 Arguments : none
8456
8457 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
8458 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
8459 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
8460 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
8461 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
8462 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
8463 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
8464 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
8465 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
8466 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
8467 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
8468 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
8469 affected.
8470
8471 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
8472 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
8473 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
8474 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
8475 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
8476 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
8477 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
8478 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
8479 latency environments.
8480
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008481 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
8482
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008483
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008484option http-pretend-keepalive
8485no option http-pretend-keepalive
8486 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
8487 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02008488 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008489 Arguments : none
8490
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008491 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", haproxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008492 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
8493 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
8494 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
8495 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
8496 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
8497 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
8498 consider the response complete.
8499
8500 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
8501 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
8502 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
8503 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008504 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008505 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
8506
8507 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
8508 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
8509 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
8510 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
8511 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
8512 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
8513 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
8514
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02008515 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
8516 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
8517 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
8518 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
8519 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
8520 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008521
8522 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8523 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8524
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008525 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008526 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008527
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008528
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008529option http-server-close
8530no option http-server-close
8531 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
8532 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8533 yes | yes | yes | yes
8534 Arguments : none
8535
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008536 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8537 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
8538 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8539 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008540 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". Setting "option
8541 http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server side
8542 while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the
8543 client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
8544 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
8545 resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits non-keepalive
8546 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
8547 conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers do not
8548 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
8549 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
8550 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008551
8552 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
8553 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
8554 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
8555 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01008556 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
8557 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008558
8559 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
8560 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008561 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
8562 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
8563 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008564
8565 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8566 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8567
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008568 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
8569 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008570
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008571option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01008572no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008573 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
8574 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8575 yes | yes | yes | no
8576 Arguments : none
8577
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00008578 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008579 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
8580 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
8581 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
8582 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
8583 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
8584 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
8585
8586 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
8587 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01008588 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
8589 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
8590 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008591
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01008592 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
8593 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
8594 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
8595 front of an existing proxy.
8596
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008597 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
8598
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008599 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008600
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008601option httpchk
8602option httpchk <uri>
8603option httpchk <method> <uri>
8604option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008605 Enables HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008606 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8607 yes | no | yes | yes
8608 Arguments :
8609 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
8610 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
8611 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
8612 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
8613 ones.
8614
8615 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
8616 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
8617 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
8618
8619 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
8620 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
8621 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02008622 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "http-check send" directive to add it.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008623
8624 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
8625 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
8626 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
8627 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
8628 the lack of any response.
8629
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02008630 Combined with "http-check" directives, it is possible to customize the
8631 request sent during the HTTP health checks or the matching rules on the
8632 response. It is also possible to configure a send/expect sequence, just like
8633 with the directive "tcp-check" for TCP health checks.
8634
8635 The server configuration is used by default to open connections to perform
8636 HTTP health checks. By it is also possible to overwrite server parameters
8637 using "http-check connect" rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008638
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02008639 "httpchk" option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works
8640 with plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02008641 bound to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon. However, it will always
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04008642 internally relies on an HTX multiplexer. Thus, it means the request
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02008643 formatting and the response parsing will be strict.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008644
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02008645 Note : For a while, there was no way to add headers or body in the request
8646 used for HTTP health checks. So a workaround was to hide it at the end
8647 of the version string with a "\r\n" after the version. It is now
8648 deprecated. The directive "http-check send" must be used instead.
8649
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008650 Examples :
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008651 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
8652 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
8653 backend https_relay
8654 mode tcp
8655 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1
8656 http-check send hdr Host www
8657 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008658
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09008659 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
8660 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
8661 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008662
8663
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008664option httpclose
8665no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008666 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008667 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8668 yes | yes | yes | yes
8669 Arguments : none
8670
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008671 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8672 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
8673 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8674 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008675 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008676
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008677 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
8678 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05008679 also check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008680 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
8681 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008682
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008683 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
8684 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
8685 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008686
8687 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
8688 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008689 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close" or "option
8690 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
8691 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008692
8693 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8694 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8695
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008696 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008697
8698
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008699option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008700 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
8701 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01008702 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008703 Arguments :
8704 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
8705 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
8706 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008707 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008708 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008709
8710 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
8711 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
8712 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
8713 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
8714 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
8715 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
8716 ports.
8717
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01008718 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
8719 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008720
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02008721 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
8722
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008723 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008724
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008725
8726option http_proxy
8727no option http_proxy
8728 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
8729 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8730 yes | yes | yes | yes
8731 Arguments : none
8732
8733 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
8734 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
8735 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
8736 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
8737 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
8738
8739 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
8740 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01008741 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
8742 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008743
8744 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8745 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8746
8747 Example :
8748 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
8749 backend direct_forward
8750 option httpclose
8751 option http_proxy
8752
8753 See also : "option httpclose"
8754
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008755
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008756option independent-streams
8757no option independent-streams
8758 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008759 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8760 yes | yes | yes | yes
8761 Arguments : none
8762
8763 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
8764 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
8765 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
8766 receive data or not.
8767
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008768 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008769 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
8770 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
8771 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
8772 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
8773 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
8774 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
8775 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
8776 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
8777 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
8778 socket buffers.
8779
8780 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
8781 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
8782 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
8783 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
8784 slow lines, so use it with caution.
8785
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008786 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008787
8788
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02008789option ldap-check
8790 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
8791 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8792 yes | no | yes | yes
8793 Arguments : none
8794
8795 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
8796 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
8797 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
8798 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
8799
8800 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
8801 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
8802
8803 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
8804 configure it.
8805
8806 Example :
8807 option ldap-check
8808
8809 See also : "option httpchk"
8810
8811
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008812option external-check
8813 Use external processes for server health checks
8814 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8815 yes | no | yes | yes
8816
8817 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
8818 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
8819 command".
8820
8821 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
8822
8823 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
8824
8825
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008826option log-health-checks
8827no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008828 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008829 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8830 yes | no | yes | yes
8831 Arguments : none
8832
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008833 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
8834 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
8835 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008836
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008837 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
8838 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
8839 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
8840 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
8841 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
8842
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008843 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008844 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008845
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008846 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
8847 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
8848 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008849
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008850
8851option log-separate-errors
8852no option log-separate-errors
8853 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
8854 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8855 yes | yes | yes | no
8856 Arguments : none
8857
8858 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
8859 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
8860 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
8861 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
8862 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
8863 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
8864 provides very important information.
8865
8866 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
8867 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
8868 error logs.
8869
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008870 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008871 logging.
8872
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008873
8874option logasap
8875no option logasap
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02008876 Enable or disable early logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008877 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8878 yes | yes | yes | no
8879 Arguments : none
8880
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02008881 By default, logs are emitted when all the log format variables and sample
8882 fetches used in the definition of the log-format string return a value, or
8883 when the session is terminated. This allows the built in log-format strings
8884 to account for the transfer time, or the number of bytes in log messages.
8885
8886 When handling long lived connections such as large file transfers or RDP,
8887 it may take a while for the request or connection to appear in the logs.
8888 Using "option logasap", the log message is created as soon as the server
8889 connection is established in mode tcp, or as soon as the server sends the
8890 complete headers in mode http. Missing information in the logs will be the
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05008891 total number of bytes which will only indicate the amount of data transferred
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02008892 before the message was created and the total time which will not take the
8893 remainder of the connection life or transfer time into account. For the case
8894 of HTTP, it is good practice to capture the Content-Length response header
8895 so that the logs at least indicate how many bytes are expected to be
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05008896 transferred.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008897
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008898 Examples :
8899 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
8900 mode http
8901 option httplog
8902 option logasap
8903 log 192.168.2.200 local3
8904
8905 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
8906 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
8907 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
8908 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
8909
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008910 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008911 logging.
8912
8913
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02008914option mysql-check [ user <username> [ { post-41 | pre-41 } ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008915 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008916 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8917 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008918 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008919 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
8920 server.
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02008921 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks (the default)
8922 pre-41 Send pre v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008923
8924 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
8925 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008926 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008927 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
8928 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
8929 in the MySQL table, like this :
8930
8931 USE mysql;
8932 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
8933 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
8934
8935 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008936 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008937 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
8938 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
8939 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
8940 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
8941 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
8942 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
8943 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
8944
8945 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
8946 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008947
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02008948 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008949
8950 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
8951 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
8952 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
8953 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02008954 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
8955 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008956
8957 See also: "option httpchk"
8958
8959
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008960option nolinger
8961no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008962 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008963 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8964 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008965 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008966
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008967 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008968 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
8969 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
8970 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
8971 connections.
8972
8973 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
8974 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02008975 a TCP RST is emitted, any pending data are truncated, and the session is
8976 instantly purged from the system's tables. The generally visible effect for
8977 a client is that responses are truncated if the close happens with a last
8978 block of data (e.g. on a redirect or error response). On the server side,
8979 it may help release the source ports immediately when forwarding a client
8980 aborts in tunnels. In both cases, TCP resets are emitted and given that
8981 the session is instantly destroyed, there will be no retransmit. On a lossy
8982 network this can increase problems, especially when there is a firewall on
8983 the lossy side, because the firewall might see and process the reset (hence
8984 purge its session) and block any further traffic for this session,, including
8985 retransmits from the other side. So if the other side doesn't receive it,
8986 it will never receive any RST again, and the firewall might log many blocked
8987 packets.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008988
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02008989 For all these reasons, it is strongly recommended NOT to use this option,
8990 unless absolutely needed as a last resort. In most situations, using the
8991 "client-fin" or "server-fin" timeouts achieves similar results with a more
8992 reliable behavior. On Linux it's also possible to use the "tcp-ut" bind or
8993 server setting.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008994
8995 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
8996 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02008997 for servers. While this option is technically supported in "defaults"
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +05008998 sections, it must really not be used there as it risks to accidentally
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02008999 propagate to sections that must no use it and to cause problems there.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009000
9001 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9002 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9003
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009004 See also: "timeout client-fin", "timeout server-fin", "tcp-ut" bind or server
9005 keywords.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009006
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009007option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
9008 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
9009 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9010 yes | yes | yes | yes
9011 Arguments :
9012 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
9013 matching <network>
9014 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
9015 header name.
9016
9017 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
9018 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
9019 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
9020 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
9021 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
9022 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
9023 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
9024 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
9025 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
9026 possible that the client has already brought one.
9027
9028 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
9029 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
9030 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
9031 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
9032 header and requires different one.
9033
9034 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
9035 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
9036 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
Amaury Denoyellef8b42922021-03-04 18:41:14 +01009037 header for a known destination address or network by adding the "except"
9038 keyword followed by the network address. In this case, any destination IP
9039 matching the network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common
9040 uses are with private networks or 127.0.0.1. IPv4 and IPv6 are both
9041 supported.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009042
9043 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
9044 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
9045 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
9046 both are defined.
9047
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009048 Examples :
9049 # Original Destination address
9050 frontend www
9051 mode http
9052 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
9053
9054 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
9055 backend www
9056 mode http
9057 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
9058
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009059 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009060
9061
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009062option persist
9063no option persist
9064 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
9065 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9066 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009067 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009068
9069 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
9070 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
9071 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
9072 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
9073 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
9074 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
9075 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
9076 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
9077 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
9078 redirected to another valid server.
9079
9080 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9081 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9082
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01009083 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009084
9085
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01009086option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
9087 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
9088 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9089 yes | no | yes | yes
9090 Arguments :
9091 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
9092 PostgreSQL server.
9093
9094 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
9095 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
9096 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
9097 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
9098
9099 See also: "option httpchk"
9100
9101
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009102option prefer-last-server
9103no option prefer-last-server
9104 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
9105 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9106 yes | no | yes | yes
9107 Arguments : none
9108
9109 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
9110 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
9111 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
9112 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
9113 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
9114 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
9115 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
9116 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
9117 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01009118 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
9119 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02009120 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
9121 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
9122 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01009123 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
9124 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
9125 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009126
9127 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9128 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9129
9130 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
9131
9132
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009133option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009134option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009135no option redispatch
9136 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
9137 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9138 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009139 Arguments :
9140 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
9141 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
9142 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009143 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009144 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009145 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009146 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
9147 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
9148 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
9149
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009150
9151 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
9152 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
9153 be able to access the service anymore.
9154
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01009155 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
9156 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009157
Olivier Carrère6e6f59b2020-04-15 11:30:18 +02009158 Active servers are selected from a subset of the list of available
9159 servers. Active servers that are not down or in maintenance (i.e., whose
9160 health is not checked or that have been checked as "up"), are selected in the
9161 following order:
9162
9163 1. Any active, non-backup server, if any, or,
9164
9165 2. If the "allbackups" option is not set, the first backup server in the
9166 list, or
9167
9168 3. If the "allbackups" option is set, any backup server.
9169
9170 When a retry occurs, HAProxy tries to select another server than the last
9171 one. The new server is selected from the current list of servers.
9172
9173 Sometimes, if the list is updated between retries (e.g., if numerous retries
9174 occur and last longer than the time needed to check that a server is down,
9175 remove it from the list and fall back on the list of backup servers),
9176 connections may be redirected to a backup server, though.
9177
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009178 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009179 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
9180 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009181
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009182 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9183 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9184
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02009185 See also : "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009186
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009187
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02009188option redis-check
9189 Use redis health checks for server testing
9190 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9191 yes | no | yes | yes
9192 Arguments : none
9193
9194 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
9195 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
9196 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
9197 find the "+PONG" response message.
9198
9199 Example :
9200 option redis-check
9201
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009202 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02009203
9204
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009205option smtpchk
9206option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
9207 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
9208 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9209 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009210 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009211 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02009212 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009213 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
9214
9215 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
9216 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
9217 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
9218
9219 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
9220 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
9221 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
9222 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
9223 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
9224 dead server.
9225
9226 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
9227 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009228 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009229 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
9230
9231 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
9232 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
9233 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
9234 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02009235 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009236
9237 Example :
9238 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
9239
9240 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
9241
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009242
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02009243option socket-stats
9244no option socket-stats
9245
9246 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
9247 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9248 yes | yes | yes | no
9249
9250 Arguments : none
9251
9252
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009253option splice-auto
9254no option splice-auto
9255 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
9256 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9257 yes | yes | yes | yes
9258 Arguments : none
9259
9260 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
9261 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009262 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009263 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009264 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009265 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
9266 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
9267 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
9268 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9269
9270 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
9271 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
9272 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
9273 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
9274 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
9275 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
9276 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
9277 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
9278 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
9279 keyword.
9280
9281 Example :
9282 option splice-auto
9283
9284 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9285 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9286
9287 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
9288 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9289
9290
9291option splice-request
9292no option splice-request
9293 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
9294 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9295 yes | yes | yes | yes
9296 Arguments : none
9297
9298 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009299 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009300 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
9301 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
9302 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
9303 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9304
9305 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
9306
9307 Example :
9308 option splice-request
9309
9310 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9311 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9312
9313 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
9314 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9315
9316
9317option splice-response
9318no option splice-response
9319 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
9320 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9321 yes | yes | yes | yes
9322 Arguments : none
9323
9324 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009325 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009326 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
9327 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
9328 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
9329 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9330
9331 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
9332
9333 Example :
9334 option splice-response
9335
9336 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9337 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9338
9339 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
9340 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9341
9342
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01009343option spop-check
9344 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
9345 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9346 no | no | no | yes
9347 Arguments : none
9348
9349 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
9350 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
9351 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
9352 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
9353
9354 Example :
9355 option spop-check
9356
9357 See also : "option httpchk"
9358
9359
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009360option srvtcpka
9361no option srvtcpka
9362 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
9363 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9364 yes | no | yes | yes
9365 Arguments : none
9366
9367 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
9368 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009369 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009370 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
9371
9372 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
9373 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
9374 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
9375 operating system and its tuning parameters.
9376
9377 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
9378 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
9379 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
9380 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
9381 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
9382
9383 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
9384
9385 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
9386 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
9387 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
9388
9389 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9390 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9391
9392 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
9393
9394
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009395option ssl-hello-chk
9396 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
9397 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9398 yes | no | yes | yes
9399 Arguments : none
9400
9401 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
9402 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
9403 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
9404 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
9405 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
9406 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
9407 hello message.
9408
9409 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
9410 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
9411 messages, which is appreciable.
9412
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009413 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
9414 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
9415 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009416
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009417 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
9418
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009419
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009420option tcp-check
9421 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
9422 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9423 yes | no | yes | yes
9424
9425 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
9426 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
9427
9428 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
9429 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
9430 attempt, which remains the default mode.
9431
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009432 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009433 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
9434 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
9435 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
9436 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
9437 only.
9438
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009439 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009440 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
9441 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
9442 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
9443 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
9444
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009445 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009446 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
9447 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009448 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009449 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
9450 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
9451 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
9452 the respective protocols.
9453 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009454 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009455
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009456 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the script.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009457
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009458 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
9459 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr in
9460 debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting. The
9461 "comment" is of course optional.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009462
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009463 During the execution of a health check, a variable scope is made available to
9464 store data samples, using the "tcp-check set-var" operation. Freeing those
9465 variable is possible using "tcp-check unset-var".
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +01009466
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009467
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009468 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009469 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009470 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009471 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009472
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009473 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009474 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009475 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009476
9477 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
9478 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009479 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009480 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009481 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009482 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02009483 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009484 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009485 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9486 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009487 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009488 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
9489 tcp-check expect string +OK
9490
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009491 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009492 (send many headers before analyzing)
9493 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009494 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009495 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
9496 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
9497 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
9498 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009499 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009500
9501
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009502 See also : "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect" and "tcp-check send".
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009503
9504
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009505option tcp-smart-accept
9506no option tcp-smart-accept
9507 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
9508 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9509 yes | yes | yes | no
9510 Arguments : none
9511
9512 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
9513 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
9514 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
9515 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
9516 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
9517 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
9518
9519 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
9520 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
9521 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
9522 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
9523
9524 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
9525 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
9526 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009527 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009528
9529 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
9530 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
9531 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
9532
9533 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
9534 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
9535 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
9536
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02009537 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
9538
9539
9540option tcp-smart-connect
9541no option tcp-smart-connect
9542 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
9543 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9544 yes | no | yes | yes
9545 Arguments : none
9546
9547 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
9548 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
9549 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
9550 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
9551 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
9552
9553 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
9554 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
9555 complex.
9556
9557 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
9558 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
9559 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
9560
9561 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9562 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9563
9564 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
9565
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009566
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009567option tcpka
9568 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
9569 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9570 yes | yes | yes | yes
9571 Arguments : none
9572
9573 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
9574 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009575 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009576 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
9577
9578 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
9579 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
9580 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
9581 operating system and its tuning parameters.
9582
9583 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
9584 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
9585 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
9586 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
9587 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
9588
9589 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
9590
9591 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
9592 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
9593 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
9594 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
9595 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
9596 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
9597 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
9598 backends.
9599
9600 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
9601
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009602
9603option tcplog
9604 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
9605 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01009606 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009607 Arguments : none
9608
9609 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
9610 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
9611 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
9612 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
9613 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
9614 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
9615 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
9616 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
9617
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02009618 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
9619
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009620 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009621
9622
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009623option transparent
9624no option transparent
9625 Enable client-side transparent proxying
9626 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01009627 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009628 Arguments : none
9629
9630 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
9631 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
9632 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
9633 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
9634 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
9635 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
9636 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
9637 appropriate server.
9638
9639 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
9640 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
9641
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01009642 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009643 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009644
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009645
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009646external-check command <command>
9647 Executable to run when performing an external-check
9648 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9649 yes | no | yes | yes
9650
9651 Arguments :
9652 <command> is the external command to run
9653
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009654 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
9655
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01009656 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009657
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01009658 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
9659 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
9660 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
9661 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
9662 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
9663 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009664
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01009665 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
9666
9667 Environment variables :
9668 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
9669 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
9670
9671 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
9672
9673 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
9674
9675 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
9676 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
9677 for a UNIX socket).
9678
9679 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
9680
9681 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
9682
9683 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
9684
9685 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
9686
9687 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
9688
9689 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
9690 socket).
9691
9692 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
9693 the command may be set using "external-check path".
9694
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +02009695 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
9696
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009697 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
9698 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
9699 failed.
9700
9701 Example :
9702 external-check command /bin/true
9703
9704 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
9705
9706
9707external-check path <path>
9708 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
9709 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9710 yes | no | yes | yes
9711
9712 Arguments :
9713 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
9714
9715 The default path is "".
9716
9717 Example :
9718 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
9719
9720 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
9721 "external-check command"
9722
9723
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009724persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009725persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009726 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
9727 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9728 yes | no | yes | yes
9729 Arguments :
9730 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02009731 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
9732 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009733
9734 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
9735 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009736 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009737 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
9738 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
9739 forwarded to this server.
9740
9741 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
9742 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
9743 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009744 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009745 a single "listen" section.
9746
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02009747 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
9748 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
9749 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
9750
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009751 Example :
9752 listen tse-farm
9753 bind :3389
9754 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
9755 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9756 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
9757 # apply RDP cookie persistence
9758 persist rdp-cookie
9759 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009760 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009761 balance rdp-cookie
9762 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
9763 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
9764
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09009765 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
9766 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009767
9768
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009769rate-limit sessions <rate>
9770 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
9771 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9772 yes | yes | yes | no
9773 Arguments :
9774 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
9775 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
9776
9777 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
9778 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
9779 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
9780 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
9781 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
9782 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
9783
9784 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
9785 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
9786 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
9787 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
9788
9789 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
9790 listen smtp
9791 mode tcp
9792 bind :25
9793 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02009794 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009795
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02009796 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
9797 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
9798 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009799
9800 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
9801
9802
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009803redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9804redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9805redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009806 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
9807 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9808 no | yes | yes | yes
9809
9810 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01009811 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009812
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009813 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009814 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009815 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
9816 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
9817 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009818
9819 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
9820 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
9821 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
9822 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
9823 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009824 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
9825 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
9826 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
9827 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009828
9829 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
9830 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
9831 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
9832 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
9833 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
9834 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009835 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009836 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009837 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
9838 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
9839 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009840
9841 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01009842 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
9843 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
9844 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02009845 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01009846 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
9847 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
9848 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
9849 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009850
9851 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009852 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009853
9854 - "drop-query"
9855 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
9856 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
9857 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
9858 with a location-type redirect.
9859
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01009860 - "append-slash"
9861 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
9862 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
9863 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
9864 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
9865
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009866 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
9867 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
9868 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
9869 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
9870 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
9871 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
9872 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
9873
9874 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
9875 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
9876 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
9877 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
9878 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
9879 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
9880 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009881
9882 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
9883 acl clear dst_port 80
9884 acl secure dst_port 8080
9885 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009886 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01009887 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009888 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
9889
9890 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01009891 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
9892 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
9893 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009894 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009895
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01009896 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
9897 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
9898 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
9899
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009900 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01009901 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009902
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009903 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02009904 http-request redirect code 301 location \
9905 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
9906 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009907
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009908 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009909
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01009910
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02009911retries <value>
9912 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
9913 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9914 yes | no | yes | yes
9915 Arguments :
9916 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
9917 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
9918 default value is 3.
9919
9920 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
9921 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
9922 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
9923
9924 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009925 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
9926 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02009927
9928 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
9929 server even if a cookie references a different server.
9930
9931 See also : "option redispatch"
9932
9933
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009934retry-on [list of keywords]
Jerome Magnin5ce3c142020-05-13 20:09:57 +02009935 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request.
9936 This setting is only valid when "mode" is set to http and is silently ignored
9937 otherwise.
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009938 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9939 yes | no | yes | yes
9940 Arguments :
9941 <keywords> is a list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each representing a
9942 type of failure event on which an attempt to retry the request
9943 is desired. Please read the notes at the bottom before changing
9944 this setting. The following keywords are supported :
9945
9946 none never retry
9947
9948 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
9949 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
9950
9951 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
9952 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
9953 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
9954 request timeout on the server side, poor network
9955 condition, or a server crash or restart while
9956 processing the request.
9957
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +02009958 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
9959 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
9960 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
9961 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
9962 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
9963 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
9964 overflow attack for example).
9965
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009966 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
9967 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
9968 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
9969 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
9970 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
9971 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
9972 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
9973 amplify denial of service attacks.
9974
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +02009975 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
9976 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
9977 considered to be safe to retry.
9978
Julien Pivotto2de240a2020-11-12 11:14:05 +01009979 <status> any HTTP status code among "401" (Unauthorized), "403"
9980 (Forbidden), "404" (Not Found), "408" (Request Timeout),
9981 "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server Error), "501" (Not
9982 Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway), "503" (Service
9983 Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009984
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +02009985 all-retryable-errors
9986 retry request for any error that are considered
9987 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
9988 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
9989 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
9990
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009991 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
9992 not cumulative.
9993
9994 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
9995 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
9996 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
9997 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
9998
9999 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
10000 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
10001 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
10002 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
10003 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
10004 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
10005 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
10006 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
10007 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
10008 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
10009 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
10010 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
10011
10012 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
10013 should not use this directive.
10014
10015 The default is "conn-failure".
10016
10017 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
10018
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +010010019server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010020 Declare a server in a backend
10021 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10022 no | no | yes | yes
10023 Arguments :
10024 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010025 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -050010026 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010027
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +010010028 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
10029 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
10030 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
10031 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +020010032 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
10033 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
10034 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
10035 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
10036 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010037 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
10038 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
10039 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
10040 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
10041 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
10042 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
10043 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +020010044 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +020010045 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
10046 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
10047 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
10048 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
10049 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
10050 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +020010051 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
10052 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010010053 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
10054 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010055
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010056 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010057 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
10058 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
10059 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
10060 adding this value to the client's port.
10061
10062 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
10063 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010064 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010065
10066 Examples :
10067 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
10068 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010069 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +020010070 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
10071 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
10072 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010073
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +020010074 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
10075 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
10076 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
10077 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
10078 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
10079
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -050010080 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
10081 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010082
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010083server-state-file-name [ { use-backend-name | <file> } ]
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010084 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010085 this backend.
10086 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10087 no | no | yes | yes
10088
10089 It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file" is set to
10090 "local". When <file> is not provided, if "use-backend-name" is used or if
10091 this directive is not set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a
10092 slash '/', then it is considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is
10093 concatenated to the global directive "server-state-base".
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010094
10095 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
10096 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
10097
10098 global
10099 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
10100
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010010101 backend bk
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010102 load-server-state-from-file
10103
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010104 See also: "server-state-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010105 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010106
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +020010107server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
10108 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
10109 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
10110 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10111 no | no | yes | yes
10112
10113 Arguments:
10114 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
10115
10116 <num | range>
10117 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
10118 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
10119 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
10120 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
10121
10122 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
10123
10124 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
10125
10126 <params*>
10127 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
10128 keyword.
10129
10130 Examples:
10131 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
10132 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
10133 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
10134
10135 # or
10136 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
10137
10138 # would be equivalent to:
10139 server srv1 google.com:80 check
10140 server srv2 google.com:80 check
10141 server srv3 google.com:80 check
10142
10143
10144
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010145source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010146source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +010010147source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010148 Set the source address for outgoing connections
10149 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10150 yes | no | yes | yes
10151 Arguments :
10152 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
10153 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010154
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010155 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010156 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
10157 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
10158 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
10159 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
10160 supported prefixes are :
10161 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
10162 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
10163 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +020010164 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020010165 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
10166 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010167
10168 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
10169 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020010170 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
10171 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
10172 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010173
10174 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
10175 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
10176 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
10177 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
10178 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
10179 <addr>.
10180
10181 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
10182 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
10183 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
10184 port.
10185
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010186 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
10187 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
10188 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
10189 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +010010190 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010191 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
10192 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
10193 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
10194 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
10195 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
10196 HTTP header.
10197
10198 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
10199 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010200 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010201 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
10202 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
10203 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
10204 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
10205 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
10206 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
10207 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
10208
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +010010209 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
10210 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
10211 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
10212 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
10213 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
10214 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
10215
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010216 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
10217 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
10218 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
10219 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
10220
10221 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
10222 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
10223 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
10224 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
10225 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
10226 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
10227
10228 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
10229 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
10230 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
10231 there are two methods :
10232
10233 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
10234 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
10235 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
10236 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
10237 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
10238 of the client ranges may be used.
10239
10240 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
10241 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
10242 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
10243 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
10244 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
10245 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
10246 same session.
10247
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010248 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
10249 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
10250 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010251 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010252
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +020010253 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
10254
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010255 Examples :
10256 backend private
10257 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
10258 source 192.168.1.200
10259
10260 backend transparent_ssl1
10261 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
10262 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
10263
10264 backend transparent_ssl2
10265 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
10266 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
10267 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
10268
10269 backend transparent_ssl3
10270 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
10271 # is more conntrack-friendly.
10272 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
10273
10274 backend transparent_smtp
10275 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
10276 # with Tproxy version 4.
10277 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
10278
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010279 backend transparent_http
10280 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
10281 # proxy.
10282 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
10283
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010284 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010285 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
10286
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010287
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010288srvtcpka-cnt <count>
10289 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
10290 the connection on the server side.
10291 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10292 yes | no | yes | yes
10293 Arguments :
10294 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
10295
10296 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
10297 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010298 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10299 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010300
10301 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-idle", "srvtcpka-intvl".
10302
10303
10304srvtcpka-idle <timeout>
10305 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
10306 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
10307 server side.
10308 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10309 yes | no | yes | yes
10310 Arguments :
10311 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
10312 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
10313 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
10314 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
10315
10316 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
10317 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010318 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10319 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010320
10321 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-intvl".
10322
10323
10324srvtcpka-intvl <timeout>
10325 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the server side.
10326 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10327 yes | no | yes | yes
10328 Arguments :
10329 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
10330 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
10331 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
10332 document.
10333
10334 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
10335 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010336 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10337 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010338
10339 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-idle".
10340
10341
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010342stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
10343 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
10344 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010345 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010346
10347 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
10348 matched.
10349
10350 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
10351 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
10352
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010353 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10354 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010355 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010356
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +010010357 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
10358 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
10359 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
10360 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010361
10362 Example :
10363 # statistics admin level only for localhost
10364 backend stats_localhost
10365 stats enable
10366 stats admin if LOCALHOST
10367
10368 Example :
10369 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
10370 backend stats_auth
10371 stats enable
10372 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
10373 stats admin if TRUE
10374
10375 Example :
10376 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
10377 userlist stats-auth
10378 group admin users admin
10379 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
10380 group readonly users haproxy
10381 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
10382
10383 backend stats_auth
10384 stats enable
10385 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
10386 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
10387 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
10388 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
10389
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010390 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
10391 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
10392 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010393
10394
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010395stats auth <user>:<passwd>
10396 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
10397 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010398 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010399 Arguments :
10400 <user> is a user name to grant access to
10401
10402 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
10403
10404 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
10405 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
10406 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
10407 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
10408 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
10409 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
10410
10411 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
10412 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
10413 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020010414 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010415
10416 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
10417 report using "stats scope".
10418
10419 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10420 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10421 unobvious parameters.
10422
10423 Example :
10424 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10425 backend public_www
10426 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10427 stats enable
10428 stats hide-version
10429 stats scope .
10430 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010431 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010432 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10433 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10434
10435 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10436 backend private_monitoring
10437 stats enable
10438 stats uri /admin?stats
10439 stats refresh 5s
10440
10441 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
10442
10443
10444stats enable
10445 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
10446 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010447 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010448 Arguments : none
10449
10450 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
10451 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
10452 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
10453 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
10454 - stats auth : no authentication
10455 - stats scope : no restriction
10456
10457 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10458 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10459 unobvious parameters.
10460
10461 Example :
10462 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10463 backend public_www
10464 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10465 stats enable
10466 stats hide-version
10467 stats scope .
10468 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010469 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010470 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10471 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10472
10473 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10474 backend private_monitoring
10475 stats enable
10476 stats uri /admin?stats
10477 stats refresh 5s
10478
10479 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10480
10481
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010482stats hide-version
10483 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010484 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010485 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010486 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010487
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010488 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
10489 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
10490 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
10491 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
10492 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
10493 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010494
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020010495 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10496 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10497 unobvious parameters.
10498
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010499 Example :
10500 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10501 backend public_www
10502 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020010503 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010504 stats hide-version
10505 stats scope .
10506 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010507 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010508 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10509 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010510
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010511 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10512 backend private_monitoring
10513 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010514 stats uri /admin?stats
10515 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +010010516
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010517 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010518
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010010519
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +020010520stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
10521 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
10522 Access control for statistics
10523
10524 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10525 no | no | yes | yes
10526
10527 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
10528 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
10529 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
10530 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
10531 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
10532 should be asked to enter a username and password.
10533
10534 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
10535 instance.
10536
10537 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
10538 about ACL usage.
10539
10540
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010541stats realm <realm>
10542 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
10543 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010544 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010545 Arguments :
10546 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
10547 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
10548 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
10549
10550 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
10551 using a backslash ('\').
10552
10553 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
10554 only related to authentication.
10555
10556 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10557 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10558 unobvious parameters.
10559
10560 Example :
10561 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10562 backend public_www
10563 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10564 stats enable
10565 stats hide-version
10566 stats scope .
10567 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010568 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010569 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10570 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10571
10572 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10573 backend private_monitoring
10574 stats enable
10575 stats uri /admin?stats
10576 stats refresh 5s
10577
10578 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
10579
10580
10581stats refresh <delay>
10582 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
10583 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010584 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010585 Arguments :
10586 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
10587 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
10588 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
10589 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
10590 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
10591 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
10592
10593 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
10594 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
10595 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
Jackie Tapia749f74c2020-07-22 18:59:40 -050010596 they want automatic refresh of the page or not.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010597
10598 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10599 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10600 unobvious parameters.
10601
10602 Example :
10603 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10604 backend public_www
10605 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10606 stats enable
10607 stats hide-version
10608 stats scope .
10609 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010610 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010611 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10612 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10613
10614 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10615 backend private_monitoring
10616 stats enable
10617 stats uri /admin?stats
10618 stats refresh 5s
10619
10620 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10621
10622
10623stats scope { <name> | "." }
10624 Enable statistics and limit access scope
10625 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010626 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010627 Arguments :
10628 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
10629 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
10630 section in which the statement appears.
10631
10632 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
10633 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
10634 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
10635 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
10636 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
10637 exists.
10638
10639 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10640 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10641 unobvious parameters.
10642
10643 Example :
10644 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10645 backend public_www
10646 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10647 stats enable
10648 stats hide-version
10649 stats scope .
10650 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010651 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010652 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10653 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10654
10655 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10656 backend private_monitoring
10657 stats enable
10658 stats uri /admin?stats
10659 stats refresh 5s
10660
10661 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10662
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010663
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010664stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010665 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
10666 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010667 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010668
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010669 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010670 description from global section is automatically used instead.
10671
10672 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
10673 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
10674
10675 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10676 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010677 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010678
10679 Example :
10680 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10681 backend private_monitoring
10682 stats enable
10683 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
10684 stats uri /admin?stats
10685 stats refresh 5s
10686
10687 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
10688 global section.
10689
10690
10691stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010692 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
10693 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10694 yes | yes | yes | yes
10695 Arguments : none
10696
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010697 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010698 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
10699 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
10700 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
10701 - IP (socket, server)
10702 - cookie (backend, server)
10703
10704 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10705 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010706 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010707
10708 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
10709
10710
Amaury Denoyelle0b70a8a2020-10-05 11:49:45 +020010711stats show-modules
10712 Enable display of extra statistics module on the statistics page
10713 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10714 yes | yes | yes | yes
10715 Arguments : none
10716
10717 New columns are added at the end of the line containing the extra statistics
10718 values as a tooltip.
10719
10720 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10721 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10722 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
10723
10724 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
10725
10726
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010727stats show-node [ <name> ]
10728 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
10729 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010730 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010731 Arguments:
10732 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
10733 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
10734
10735 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
10736 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010737 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010738
10739 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10740 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10741 unobvious parameters.
10742
10743 Example:
10744 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10745 backend private_monitoring
10746 stats enable
10747 stats show-node Europe-1
10748 stats uri /admin?stats
10749 stats refresh 5s
10750
10751 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
10752 section.
10753
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010754
10755stats uri <prefix>
10756 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
10757 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010758 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010759 Arguments :
10760 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
10761 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
10762 query string.
10763
10764 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
10765 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
10766 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
10767 possible to reach it in the application.
10768
10769 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010770 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010771 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
10772 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
10773 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
10774 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
10775
10776 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
10777 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
10778 an address or a port to statistics only.
10779
10780 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10781 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10782 unobvious parameters.
10783
10784 Example :
10785 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10786 backend public_www
10787 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10788 stats enable
10789 stats hide-version
10790 stats scope .
10791 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010792 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010793 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10794 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10795
10796 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10797 backend private_monitoring
10798 stats enable
10799 stats uri /admin?stats
10800 stats refresh 5s
10801
10802 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
10803
10804
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010805stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
10806 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010807 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010808 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010809
10810 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010811 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010812 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010813 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010814 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
10815
10816 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
10817 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
10818 the "stick-table" statement.
10819
10820 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
10821 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
10822 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
10823 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
10824 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
10825
10826 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
10827 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
10828 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
10829 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
10830 transformation rules.
10831
10832 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
10833 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
10834 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
10835 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
10836 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
10837 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
10838 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
10839
10840 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
10841 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
10842 ACL based conditions.
10843
10844 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
10845 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
10846 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
10847 matches can be used as fallbacks.
10848
10849 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
10850 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
10851 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
10852 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
10853
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010854 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10855 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010856 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010857
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010858 Example :
10859 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
10860 # last 30 minutes
10861 backend pop
10862 mode tcp
10863 balance roundrobin
10864 stick store-request src
10865 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
10866 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
10867 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
10868
10869 backend smtp
10870 mode tcp
10871 balance roundrobin
10872 stick match src table pop
10873 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
10874 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
10875
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010876 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010877 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010878
10879
10880stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
10881 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
10882 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10883 no | no | yes | yes
10884
10885 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
10886 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
10887 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
10888 for writing more maintainable configurations.
10889
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010890 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10891 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010892 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010893
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010894 Examples :
10895 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +010010896 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010897
10898 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
10899 stick match src table pop if !localhost
10900 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
10901
10902
10903 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
10904 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
10905 backend http
10906 mode http
10907 balance roundrobin
10908 stick on src table https
10909 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
10910 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
10911 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
10912
10913 backend https
10914 mode tcp
10915 balance roundrobin
10916 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
10917 stick on src
10918 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
10919 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
10920
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010921 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010922
10923
10924stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
10925 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
10926 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10927 no | no | yes | yes
10928
10929 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010930 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010931 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010932 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010933 server is selected.
10934
10935 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
10936 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
10937 the "stick-table" statement.
10938
10939 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
10940 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
10941 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
10942 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
10943 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
10944 address.
10945
10946 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
10947 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
10948 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
10949 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
10950 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
10951 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
10952 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
10953 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
10954 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
10955 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
10956
10957 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
10958 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
10959 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
10960 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
10961 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
10962 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
10963 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
10964
10965 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
10966 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
10967 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
10968 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
10969
10970 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
10971 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
10972 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
10973 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
10974 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
10975 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010010976 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
10977 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
10978 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
10979 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
10980 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
10981 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010982
10983 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
10984 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
10985 the request.
10986
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010987 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10988 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010989 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010990
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010991 Example :
10992 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
10993 # last 30 minutes
10994 backend pop
10995 mode tcp
10996 balance roundrobin
10997 stick store-request src
10998 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
10999 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
11000 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
11001
11002 backend smtp
11003 mode tcp
11004 balance roundrobin
11005 stick match src table pop
11006 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
11007 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
11008
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011009 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011010 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011011
11012
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011013stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Thayne McCombs92149f92020-11-20 01:28:26 -070011014 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>] [srvkey <srvkey>]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020011015 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +080011016 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011017 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020011018 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011019
11020 Arguments :
11021 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
11022 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
11023 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
11024 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
11025
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +010011026 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
11027 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
11028 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
11029 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
11030
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011031 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
11032 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
11033 instance.
11034
11035 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
11036 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
11037 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
11038 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
11039 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
11040 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011041 to 32 characters.
11042
11043 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
11044 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
11045 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011046 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011047 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
11048 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011049
11050 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011051 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
11052 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011053 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
11054 increase.
11055
11056 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010011057 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
11058 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
11059 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011060
11061 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
11062 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
11063 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
11064 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011065 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011066 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
11067 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
11068 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
11069 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
11070 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
11071 parameter (see below).
11072
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020011073 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
11074 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
11075 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
11076 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
11077 soft restart.
11078
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +020011079 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
11080 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011081
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011082 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
11083 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
11084 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
11085 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +010011086 section 2.5 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011087 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011088 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
11089 if not expiration delay is specified.
11090
Thayne McCombs92149f92020-11-20 01:28:26 -070011091 <srvkey> specifies how each server is identified for the purposes of the
11092 stick table. The valid values are "name" and "addr". If "name" is
11093 given, then <name> argument for the server (may be generated by
11094 a template). If "addr" is given, then the server is identified
11095 by its current network address, including the port. "addr" is
11096 especially useful if you are using service discovery to generate
11097 the addresses for servers with peered stick-tables and want
11098 to consistently use the same host across peers for a stickiness
11099 token.
11100
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020011101 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
11102 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
11103 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
11104 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011105 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
11106 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
11107 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
11108 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
11109 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
11110 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
11111 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
11112 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
11113 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
11114 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
11115 types and their arguments.
11116
11117 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
11118 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
11119 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
11120 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
11121
11122 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11123 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
11124 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011125 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011126
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011127 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
11128 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
11129 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011130 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011131 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011132 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011133
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011134 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11135 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
11136 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
11137 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
11138
11139 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
11140 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
11141 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
11142 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
11143 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
11144 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
11145
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011146 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
11147 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
11148 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
11149 they were received.
11150
11151 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11152 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
11153 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
11154 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
11155 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
11156
11157 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11158 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11159 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11160 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
11161 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11162
11163 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
11164 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
11165 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
11166
11167 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11168 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11169 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11170 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
11171 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11172
11173 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11174 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
11175 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
11176 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
11177 the client side.
11178
11179 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11180 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11181 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11182 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
11183 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
11184 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
11185 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
11186
11187 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11188 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
11189 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
11190 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
11191 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
11192 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011193 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011194
11195 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11196 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11197 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11198 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
11199 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
11200 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11201
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010011202 - http_fail_cnt : HTTP Failure Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11203 counts the absolute number of HTTP response failures induced by servers
11204 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
11205 responses, as well as any 5xx response other than 501 or 505. It aims at
11206 being used combined with path or URI to detect service failures.
11207
11208 - http_fail_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
11209 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11210 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11211 HTTP response failure rate over that period, in requests per period (see
11212 http_fail_cnt above for what is accounted as a failure). The result is an
11213 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11214
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011215 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011216 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011217 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
11218 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
11219
11220 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11221 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11222 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11223 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
11224 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
11225 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
11226 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
11227 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
11228 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
11229 recommended for better fairness.
11230
11231 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011232 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011233 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
11234 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
11235
11236 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
11237 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11238 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11239 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
11240 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
11241 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
11242 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
11243 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
11244 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
11245 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020011246
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020011247 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
11248 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011249 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
11250 reference it.
11251
11252 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
11253 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +010011254 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
11255 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
11256 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011257
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011258 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
11259 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
11260 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
11261 something that can be ignored.
11262
11263 Example:
11264 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
11265 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
11266 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
11267 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
11268
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +010011269 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.5
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +010011270 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011271
11272
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011273stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +010011274 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011275 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11276 no | no | yes | yes
11277
11278 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011279 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011280 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011281 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011282 server is selected.
11283
11284 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
11285 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
11286 the "stick-table" statement.
11287
11288 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
11289 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
11290 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
11291 when the response is a SSL server hello.
11292
11293 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
11294 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
11295 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
11296 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
11297 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
11298 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011299 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011300 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
11301 rules.
11302
11303 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
11304 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
11305 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
11306 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
11307 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
11308 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
11309 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
11310
11311 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
11312 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
11313 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
11314 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
11315
11316 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
11317 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
11318 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
11319 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
11320 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
11321 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010011322 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
11323 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
11324 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
11325 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
11326 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
11327 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
11328 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
11329 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
11330 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011331
11332 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
11333
11334 Example :
11335 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
11336 backend https
11337 mode tcp
11338 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011339 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011340 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011341
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011342 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
11343 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
11344
11345 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
11346 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
11347 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
11348
11349 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
11350 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011351
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011352 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
11353 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
11354 # at offset 44.
11355
11356 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
11357 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
11358
11359 # Learn on response if server hello.
11360 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011361
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011362 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
11363 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
11364
11365 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
11366 extraction.
11367
11368
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011369tcp-check comment <string>
11370 Defines a comment for the following the tcp-check rule, reported in logs if
11371 it fails.
11372 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11373 yes | no | yes | yes
11374
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011375 Arguments :
11376 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following tcp-check
11377 rule fails.
11378
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011379 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
11380 user-friendly error reporting.
11381
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011382 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send" and
11383 "tcp-check expect".
11384
11385
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011386tcp-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy] [via-socks4]
11387 [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020011388 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011389 Opens a new connection
11390 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011391 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011392
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011393 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011394 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11395
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020011396 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040011397 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020011398
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020011399 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011400 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
11401 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020011402 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011403
11404 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011405
11406 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
11407
Christopher Faulet085426a2020-03-30 13:07:02 +020011408 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
11409
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011410 ssl opens a ciphered connection
11411
Christopher Faulet79b31d42020-03-30 13:00:05 +020011412 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
11413
Christopher Faulet98572322020-03-30 13:16:44 +020011414 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
11415 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
11416 for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
11417 If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
11418
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020011419 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
11420 It must be a TCP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
11421 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
11422 haproxy -vv.
11423
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011424 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011425
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011426 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
11427 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
11428 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
11429
11430 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
11431 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
11432 of the sequence.
11433
11434 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
11435 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
11436 do.
11437
11438 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
11439 unset-var or comment rules.
11440
11441 Examples :
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011442 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
11443 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
11444 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
11445 option tcp-check
11446 tcp-check connect
11447 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
11448 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
11449 tcp-check send \r\n
11450 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
11451 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
11452 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
11453 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
11454 tcp-check send \r\n
11455 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
11456 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
11457
11458 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
11459 option tcp-check
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011460 tcp-check connect port 110 linger
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011461 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
11462 tcp-check connect port 143
11463 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
11464 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
11465
11466 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
11467
11468
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011469tcp-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011470 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020011471 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011472 [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011473 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011474 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011475 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011476
11477 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011478 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11479
Gaetan Rivet1afd8262020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011480 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
11481 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
11482 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
11483 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
11484 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
11485 incomplete. If an exact string (string or binary) is used, the
11486 minimum between the string length and this parameter is used.
11487 This parameter is ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule
11488 does not match, the check will wait for more data. If set to 0,
11489 the evaluation result is always conclusive.
11490
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011491 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011492 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring", "binary" or
11493 "rbinary".
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011494 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
11495 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
11496 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
11497
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011498 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
11499 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
11500 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011501 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
11502 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010011503 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
11504 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011505 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
11506 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011507 By default "L7OK" is used.
11508
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011509 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
11510 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010011511 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
11512 supported :
11513 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
11514 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011515 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
11516 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
11517 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
11518 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
11519 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011520
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011521 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011522 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011523 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
11524 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
11525 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
11526 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011527 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
11528
Christopher Fauletbe52b4d2020-04-01 16:30:22 +020011529 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
11530 informational message reported in logs if the expect
11531 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
11532 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
11533
11534 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
11535 informational message reported in logs if an error
11536 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
11537 log-format string.
11538
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020011539 status-code <expr> is optional and can be used to set the check status code
11540 reported in logs, on success or on error. <expr> is a
11541 standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11542 followed by some converters.
11543
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011544 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
11545 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
11546 with the usual backslash ('\').
11547 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011548 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011549 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
11550 used upper or lower case.
11551
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011552 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
11553
11554 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
11555 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11556 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
11557 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
11558 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
11559 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
11560 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
11561 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
11562
11563 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
11564 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11565 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
11566 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
11567 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
11568 expression.
11569
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020011570 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the response's buffer.
11571 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11572 response's buffer contains the string resulting of the
11573 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
11574 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
11575 considered invalid if the buffer contains the string.
11576
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011577 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
11578 in the response buffer. A health check response will
11579 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
11580 this exact hexadecimal string.
11581 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
11582
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011583 rbinary <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer, like
11584 "rstring". However, the response buffer is transformed
11585 into its hexadecimal form, including NUL-bytes. This
11586 allows using all regex engines to match any binary
11587 content. The hexadecimal transformation takes twice the
11588 size of the original response. As such, the expected
11589 pattern should work on at-most half the response buffer
11590 size.
11591
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020011592 binary-lf <hexfmt> : test a log-format string in its hexadecimal form
11593 match in the response's buffer. A health check response
11594 will be considered valid if the response's buffer
11595 contains the hexadecimal string resulting of the
11596 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format
11597 rules. If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
11598 considered invalid if the buffer contains the
11599 hexadecimal string. The hexadecimal string is converted
11600 in a binary string before matching the response's
11601 buffer.
11602
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011603 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011604 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011605 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
11606 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
11607 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
11608 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
11609 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
11610 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
11611 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
11612 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
11613 the null character.
11614
11615 Examples :
11616 # perform a POP check
11617 option tcp-check
11618 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
11619
11620 # perform an IMAP check
11621 option tcp-check
11622 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
11623
11624 # look for the redis master server
11625 option tcp-check
11626 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +020011627 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011628 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
11629 tcp-check expect string role:master
11630 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
11631 tcp-check expect string +OK
11632
11633
11634 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011635 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011636
11637
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011638tcp-check send <data> [comment <msg>]
11639tcp-check send-lf <fmt> [comment <msg>]
11640 Specify a string or a log-format string to be sent as a question during a
11641 generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011642 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011643 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011644
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011645 Arguments :
11646 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11647
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011648 <data> is the string that will be sent during a generic health
11649 check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020011650
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011651 <fmt> is the log-format string that will be sent, once evaluated,
11652 during a generic health check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011653
11654 Examples :
11655 # look for the redis master server
11656 option tcp-check
11657 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
11658 tcp-check expect string role:master
11659
11660 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011661 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011662
11663
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011664tcp-check send-binary <hexstring> [comment <msg>]
11665tcp-check send-binary-lf <hexfmt> [comment <msg>]
11666 Specify an hex digits string or an hex digits log-format string to be sent as
11667 a binary question during a raw tcp health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011668 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011669 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011670
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011671 Arguments :
11672 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011673
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011674 <hexstring> is the hexadecimal string that will be send, once converted
11675 to binary, during a generic health check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020011676
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011677 <hexfmt> is the hexadecimal log-format string that will be send, once
11678 evaluated and converted to binary, during a generic health
11679 check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011680
11681 Examples :
11682 # redis check in binary
11683 option tcp-check
11684 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
11685 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
11686
11687
11688 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011689 "tcp-check send", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011690
11691
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011692tcp-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011693 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011694 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011695 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011696
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011697 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011698 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
11699 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
11700 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
11701 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
11702 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
11703 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
11704 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
11705 and '-'.
11706
11707 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
11708
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011709 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011710 tcp-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
11711
11712
11713tcp-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011714 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011715 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011716 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011717
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011718 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011719 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
11720 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
11721 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
11722 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
11723 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
11724 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
11725 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
11726 and '-'.
11727
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011728 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011729 tcp-check unset-var(check.port)
11730
11731
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011732tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11733 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020011734 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11735 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011736 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020011737 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11738 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020011739
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011740 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011741
11742 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
11743 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011744 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
11745 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
11746 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
11747 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
11748 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
11749 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011750
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011751 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
11752 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
11753 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
11754 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011755
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020011756 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011757 - accept :
11758 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11759 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
11760 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011761
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011762 - reject :
11763 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11764 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
11765 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
11766 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
11767 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
11768 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
11769 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
11770 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
11771 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
11772 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
11773 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011774 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011775
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020011776 - expect-proxy layer4 :
11777 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
11778 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
11779 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
11780 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
11781 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
11782 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
11783 hosts.
11784
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010011785 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
11786 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
11787 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
11788 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
11789 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
11790 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
11791 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
11792 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
11793
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011794 - capture <sample> len <length> :
11795 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
11796 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
11797 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
11798 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
11799 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
11800 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
11801 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
11802 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020011803 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
11804 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011805
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011806 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011807 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020011808 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
11809 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
11810 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011811 haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
Matteo Contrini1857b8c2020-10-16 17:35:54 +020011812 and (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020011813 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
11814 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
11815 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
11816 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
11817 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
11818 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
11819 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011820
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011821 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011822 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011823 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011824 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011825 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
11826 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
11827 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011828
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011829 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
11830 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
11831 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
11832 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011833
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011834 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
11835 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
11836 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
11837 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
11838 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011839 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
11840 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
11841 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
11842 layer7 information is extracted.
11843
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011844 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
11845 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
11846 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
11847 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
11848 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011849
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020011850 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
11851 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
11852 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
11853 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
11854
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011855 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
11856 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
11857 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
11858 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
11859
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011860 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }:
11861 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
11862 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
11863 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
11864 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011865
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011866 - set-src <expr> :
11867 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
11868 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
11869 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020011870 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011871
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020011872 Arguments:
11873 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11874 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011875
11876 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011877 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
11878
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020011879 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
11880 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011881
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011882 - set-src-port <expr> :
11883 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
11884 expression.
11885
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020011886 Arguments:
11887 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11888 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011889
11890 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011891 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
11892
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020011893 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
11894 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
11895 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011896
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020011897 - set-dst <expr> :
11898 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
11899 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
11900 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
11901 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
11902 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
11903
11904 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11905 followed by some converters.
11906
11907 Example:
11908
11909 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
11910 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
11911
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020011912 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
11913 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
11914
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020011915 - set-dst-port <expr> :
11916 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
11917 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
11918 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
11919
11920
11921 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11922 followed by some converters.
11923
11924 Example:
11925
11926 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
11927
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020011928 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
11929 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
11930 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
11931
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011932 - "silent-drop" :
11933 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011934 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011935 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
11936 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
11937 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
11938 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
11939 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011940 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
11941 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011942 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
11943 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011944 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011945 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
11946 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
11947 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
11948 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
11949
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011950 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
11951 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
11952 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011953
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011954 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
11955 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
11956 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011957
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011958 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011959 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011960 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011961
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011962 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
11963 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
11964 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011965
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011966 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011967 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
11968 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011969
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020011970 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
11971
11972 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
11973
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011974 See section 7 about ACL usage.
11975
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011976 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011977
11978
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011979tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11980 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011981 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020011982 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011983 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020011984 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11985 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011986
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011987 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011988
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011989 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011990 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
11991 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010011992 "accept", a "reject" or a "switch-mode" rule matches, or the TCP request
11993 inspection delay expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011994
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011995 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
11996 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
11997 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
11998 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010011999 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
12000 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
12001 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
12002 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
12003 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
12004 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012005 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012006 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012007
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012008 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
12009 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
12010 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
12011 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012012
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012013 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020012014 - accept : the request is accepted
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010012015 - do-resolve: perform a DNS resolution
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020012016 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
12017 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040012018 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012019 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020012020 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012021 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012022 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020012023 - set-dst <expr>
12024 - set-dst-port <expr>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012025 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012026 - switch-mode http [ proto <name> ]
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012027 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012028 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012029 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010012030 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012031
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012032 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
12033 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010012034 For "do-resolve" action, please check the "http-request do-resolve"
12035 configuration section.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012036
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012037 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
12038 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
12039 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
12040 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
12041 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
12042 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012043
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012044 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012045 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12046 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012047
Christopher Faulet2079a4a2020-10-02 11:48:57 +020012048 Note also that it is recommended to use a "tcp-request session" rule to track
12049 information that does *not* depend on Layer 7 contents, especially for HTTP
12050 frontends. Some HTTP processing are performed at the session level and may
12051 lead to an early rejection of the requests. Thus, the tracking at the content
12052 level may be disturbed in such case. A warning is emitted during startup to
12053 prevent, as far as possible, such unreliable usage.
12054
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012055 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Christopher Faulet7ea509e2020-10-02 11:38:46 +020012056 rules from a TCP proxy, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to
12057 preliminarily parse the contents of a buffer before extracting the required
12058 data. If the buffered contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the
12059 ACL does not match. The parser which is involved there is exactly the same
12060 as for all other HTTP processing, so there is no risk of parsing something
12061 differently. In an HTTP frontend or an HTTP backend, it is guaranteed that
12062 HTTP contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated
12063 first because the HTTP parsing is performed in the early stages of the
12064 connection processing, at the session level. But for such proxies, using
12065 "http-request" rules is much more natural and recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012066
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012067 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012068 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
12069 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
12070 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012071
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020012072 The "set-dst" and "set-dst-port" are used to set respectively the destination
12073 IP and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-dst".
12074
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012075 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012076 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
12077 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012078
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012079 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
12080 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012081 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012082 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12083 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012084 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012085 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012086 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012087 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
12088 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012089 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012090 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
12091 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012092
12093 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12094 followed by some converters.
12095
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012096 The "switch-mode" is used to perform a conntection upgrade. Only HTTP
12097 upgrades are supported for now. The protocol may optionally be
12098 specified. This action is only available for a proxy with the frontend
12099 capability. The connection upgrade is immediately performed, following
12100 "tcp-request content" rules are not evaluated. This upgrade method should be
12101 preferred to the implicit one consisting to rely on the backend mode. When
12102 used, it is possible to set HTTP directives in a frontend without any
12103 warning. These directives will be conditionnaly evaluated if the HTTP upgrade
12104 is performed. However, an HTTP backend must still be selected. It remains
12105 unsupported to route an HTTP connection (upgraded or not) to a TCP server.
12106
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +010012107 See section 4 about Proxies for more details on HTTP upgrades.
12108
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012109 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
12110 <var-name>.
12111
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040012112 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
12113 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
12114 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
12115 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
12116 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
12117
12118 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
12119 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
12120 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
12121 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
12122 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
12123 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
12124 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
12125 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
12126 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
12127 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
12128 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
12129
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012130 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
12131 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
12132 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
12133 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
12134 the SPOE agent name must be used.
12135
12136 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
12137
12138 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
12139
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010012140 The "use-service" is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the
12141 request and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to
12142 reply by sending any valid response or it may immediately close the
12143 connection without sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible
12144 to write your own services in Lua. No further "tcp-request" rules are
12145 evaluated.
12146
12147 Example:
12148 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
12149
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012150 Example:
12151
12152 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012153 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012154
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012155 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012156 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012157 # and reject everything else. (Only works for HTTP/1 connections)
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012158 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
12159 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020012160 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012161 tcp-request content reject
12162
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012163 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
12164 # and reject everything else. (works for HTTP/1 and HTTP/2 connections)
12165 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
12166 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
12167 tcp-request switch-mode http if HTTP
12168 tcp-request reject # non-HTTP traffic is implicit here
12169 ...
12170 http-request reject unless is_host_com
12171
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012172 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012173 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
12174 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
12175 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012176 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012177
12178 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
12179 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
12180 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012181 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012182 tcp-request content reject
12183
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012184 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012185 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012186 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012187 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012188 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
12189 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012190
12191 Example:
12192 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
12193 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012194 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012195
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012196 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012197 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012198
12199 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012200 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012201 # protecting all our sites
12202 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012203 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
12204 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012205 ...
12206 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
12207
12208 backend http_dynamic
12209 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012210 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012211 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012212 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012213 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012214 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012215 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012216
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012217 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012218
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030012219 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
12220 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012221
12222
12223tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
12224 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
12225 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020012226 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012227 Arguments :
12228 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12229 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12230 as explained at the top of this document.
12231
12232 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
12233 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
12234 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
12235 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
12236 data for at most the specified amount of time.
12237
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020012238 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
12239 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
12240 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
12241 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
12242
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012243 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
12244 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012245 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012246 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010012247 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
12248 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
12249 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
12250 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012251
12252 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
12253 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
12254 it pass through unaffected.
12255
12256 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
12257 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
12258 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012259 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012260 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
12261 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020012262 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
12263 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
12264 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012265
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012266 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012267 "timeout client".
12268
12269
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012270tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12271 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
12272 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12273 no | no | yes | yes
12274 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020012275 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12276 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012277
12278 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
12279
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012280 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012281 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
12282 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012283 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
12284 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012285
12286 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
12287
12288 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
12289 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
12290 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
12291 inserted.
12292
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012293 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012294 - accept :
12295 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
12296 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
12297 the rules evaluation.
12298
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012299 - close :
12300 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
12301 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
12302 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
12303 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
12304 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
12305 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012306 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012307 protocols.
12308
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012309 - reject :
12310 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
12311 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012312 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012313
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012314 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
12315 Sets a variable.
12316
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012317 - unset-var(<var-name>)
12318 Unsets a variable.
12319
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020012320 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
12321 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
12322 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
12323 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
12324
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012325 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
12326 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
12327 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
12328 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
12329
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012330 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12331 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
12332 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
12333 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
12334 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012335
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012336 - "silent-drop" :
12337 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012338 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012339 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
12340 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
12341 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
12342 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
12343 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012344 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
12345 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012346 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
12347 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012348 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012349 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
12350 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
12351 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
12352 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
12353
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012354 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
12355 Send a group of SPOE messages.
12356
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012357 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12358 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12359 for changing the default action to a reject.
12360
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012361 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
12362 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
12363 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
12364 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012365 period.
12366
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012367 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
12368 declared inline.
12369
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012370 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
12371 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012372 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012373 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12374 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012375 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012376 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012377 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012378 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
12379 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012380 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012381 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
12382 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012383
12384 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12385 followed by some converters.
12386
12387 Example:
12388
12389 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
12390
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012391 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
12392 <var-name>.
12393
12394 Example:
12395
12396 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
12397
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012398 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
12399 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
12400 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
12401 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
12402 the SPOE agent name must be used.
12403
12404 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
12405
12406 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
12407
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012408 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12409
12410 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
12411
12412
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012413tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12414 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
12415 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12416 no | yes | yes | no
12417 Arguments :
12418 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12419 below.
12420
12421 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
12422
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012423 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012424 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
12425 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
12426 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
12427 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
12428 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
12429 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
12430 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012431 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012432 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
12433 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
12434 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
12435 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
12436 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
12437 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
12438 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
12439 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
12440 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
12441 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
12442 instead.
12443
12444 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
12445 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
12446 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
12447 rules which may be inserted.
12448
12449 Several types of actions are supported :
12450 - accept : the request is accepted
12451 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
12452 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
12453 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012454 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012455 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012456 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012457 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012458 - silent-drop
12459
12460 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
12461 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
12462 sections for a complete description.
12463
12464 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12465 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12466 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
12467
12468 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
12469 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
12470 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
12471 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
12472 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
12473
12474 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
12475 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12476
12477 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
12478 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
12479 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
12480
12481 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12482 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
12483 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12484
12485 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
12486 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
12487 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
12488
12489 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12490 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12491 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
12492
12493 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12494
12495 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
12496
12497
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012498tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
12499 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
12500 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12501 no | no | yes | yes
12502 Arguments :
12503 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12504 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12505 as explained at the top of this document.
12506
12507 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
12508
12509
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012510timeout check <timeout>
12511 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
12512 established.
12513
12514 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12515 yes | no | yes | yes
12516 Arguments:
12517 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12518 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12519 as explained at the top of this document.
12520
12521 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
12522 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012523 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012524 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010012525 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
12526 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
12527 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012528
12529 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
12530 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
12531
12532 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
12533 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010012534 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012535
12536 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12537 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12538 forget about it.
12539
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010012540 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
12541 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012542
12543
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012544timeout client <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012545 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
12546 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12547 yes | yes | yes | no
12548 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012549 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012550 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12551 as explained at the top of this document.
12552
12553 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
12554 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
12555 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010012556 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
12557 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
12558 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
12559 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012560 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
12561 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
12562 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012563 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012564 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012565 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
12566 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012567 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
12568 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012569
12570 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
12571 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12572 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12573 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012574 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012575 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12576
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012577 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010012578
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012579 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012580
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012581
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012582timeout client-fin <timeout>
12583 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
12584 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12585 yes | yes | yes | no
12586 Arguments :
12587 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12588 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12589 as explained at the top of this document.
12590
12591 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
12592 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
12593 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
12594 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
12595 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
12596 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
12597 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010012598 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
12599 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
12600 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012601
12602 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
12603 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
12604 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
12605
12606 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
12607
12608
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012609timeout connect <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012610 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
12611 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12612 yes | no | yes | yes
12613 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012614 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012615 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12616 as explained at the top of this document.
12617
12618 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012619 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012620 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012621 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012622 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
12623 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012624
12625 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12626 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12627 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12628 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012629 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012630 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12631
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012632 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012633
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012634
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012635timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
12636 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
12637 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12638 yes | yes | yes | yes
12639 Arguments :
12640 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12641 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12642 as explained at the top of this document.
12643
12644 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
12645 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
12646 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
12647 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
12648 once the request has started to present itself.
12649
12650 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
12651 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
12652 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
12653 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
12654 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
12655
12656 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
12657 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
12658 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
12659 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
12660
12661 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
12662 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012663 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012664 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
12665 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020012666 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012667
12668 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
12669 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
12670 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
12671 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
12672
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012673 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
12674 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010012675 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
12676
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012677 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
12678
12679
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012680timeout http-request <timeout>
12681 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
12682 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020012683 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012684 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012685 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012686 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12687 as explained at the top of this document.
12688
12689 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
12690 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
12691 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
12692 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
12693 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
12694 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
12695 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020012696 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
12697 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
12698 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
12699 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012700 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020012701 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
12702 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012703
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010012704 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
12705 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
12706 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
12707 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
12708 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012709 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012710
12711 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
12712 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012713 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012714 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
12715 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
12716
12717 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020012718 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
12719 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
12720 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012721
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020012722 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010012723 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012724
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012725
12726timeout queue <timeout>
12727 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
12728 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12729 yes | no | yes | yes
12730 Arguments :
12731 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12732 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12733 as explained at the top of this document.
12734
12735 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
12736 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
12737 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
12738 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
12739 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
12740
12741 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
12742 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
12743 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
12744 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
12745
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012746 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012747
12748
12749timeout server <timeout>
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012750 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
12751 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12752 yes | no | yes | yes
12753 Arguments :
12754 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12755 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12756 as explained at the top of this document.
12757
12758 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
12759 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
12760 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
12761 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
12762 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
12763 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
12764 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
12765
12766 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
12767 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
12768 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
12769 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
12770 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012771 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012772 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012773 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
12774 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012775 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
12776 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012777
12778 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12779 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12780 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12781 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012782 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012783 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12784
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012785 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012786
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012787
12788timeout server-fin <timeout>
12789 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
12790 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12791 yes | no | yes | yes
12792 Arguments :
12793 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12794 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12795 as explained at the top of this document.
12796
12797 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
12798 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
12799 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
12800 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
12801 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
12802 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
12803 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
12804 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
12805 situations, it should not be needed.
12806
12807 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12808 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
12809 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
12810
12811 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
12812
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012813
12814timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010012815 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012816 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12817 yes | yes | yes | yes
12818 Arguments :
12819 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
12820 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12821 as explained at the top of this document.
12822
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020012823 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit", it is maintained
12824 open with no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout
12825 tarpit" defines how long it will be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012826
12827 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
12828 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
12829 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
12830 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010012831 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012832
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012833 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012834
12835
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012836timeout tunnel <timeout>
12837 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
12838 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12839 yes | no | yes | yes
12840 Arguments :
12841 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12842 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12843 as explained at the top of this document.
12844
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012845 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012846 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
12847 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
12848 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012849 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
12850 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012851 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
12852 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
12853 specified.
12854
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012855 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
12856 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
12857 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
12858 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
12859 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
12860 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
12861 state.
12862
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012863 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
12864 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
12865 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
12866 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012867 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012868
12869 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12870 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12871 forget about it.
12872
12873 Example :
12874 defaults http
12875 option http-server-close
12876 timeout connect 5s
12877 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012878 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012879 timeout server 30s
12880 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
12881
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012882 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012883
12884
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012885transparent (deprecated)
12886 Enable client-side transparent proxying
12887 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010012888 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012889 Arguments : none
12890
12891 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
12892 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
12893 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
12894 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
12895 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
12896 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
12897 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
12898 appropriate server.
12899
12900 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
12901
12902 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
12903 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
12904
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012905 See also: "option transparent"
12906
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012907unique-id-format <string>
12908 Generate a unique ID for each request.
12909 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12910 yes | yes | yes | no
12911 Arguments :
12912 <string> is a log-format string.
12913
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012914 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
12915 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
12916 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
12917 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012918
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012919 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
12920 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
12921 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
12922 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
12923 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
12924 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
12925 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
12926 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012927
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012928 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
12929 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012930
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012931 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012932
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050012933 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012934
12935 will generate:
12936
12937 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
12938
12939 See also: "unique-id-header"
12940
12941unique-id-header <name>
12942 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
12943 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12944 yes | yes | yes | no
12945 Arguments :
12946 <name> is the name of the header.
12947
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012948 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
12949 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012950
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012951 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012952
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050012953 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012954 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
12955
12956 will generate:
12957
12958 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
12959
12960 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012961
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020012962use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020012963 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012964 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12965 no | yes | yes | no
12966 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010012967 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
12968 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012969
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020012970 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
12971 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012972
12973 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
12974 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
12975 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020012976 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012977 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020012978 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
12979 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012980
12981 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
12982 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
12983 assign the backend.
12984
12985 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
12986 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
12987 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
12988 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
12989 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
12990 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
12991
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020012992 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012993 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020012994 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
12995 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
12996 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
12997
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010012998 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
12999 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
13000 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
13001 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
13002 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
13003 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
13004 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
13005 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
13006 cannot be forced from the request.
13007
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013008 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010013009 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
13010 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
13011
13012 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
13013 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013014
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020013015use-fcgi-app <name>
13016 Defines the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
13017 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13018 no | no | yes | yes
13019 Arguments :
13020 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
13021
13022 See section 10.1 about FastCGI application setup for details.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013023
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013024use-server <server> if <condition>
13025use-server <server> unless <condition>
13026 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
13027 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13028 no | no | yes | yes
13029 Arguments :
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013030 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section
13031 or a "log-format" string resolving to a server name.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013032
13033 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
13034
13035 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
13036 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
13037 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
13038
13039 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
13040 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
13041 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
13042 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
13043 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
13044 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
13045 matches will assign the server.
13046
13047 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
13048 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
13049 with the next rules until one matches.
13050
13051 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
13052 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
13053 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
13054 according to other persistence mechanisms.
13055
13056 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
13057 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
13058 stripped.
13059
13060 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
13061 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020013062 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field when using protocols with
13063 implicit TLS (also see "req_ssl_sni"). And if these servers have their weight
13064 set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013065
13066 Example :
13067 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
13068 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
13069 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
13070 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020013071 server mail 192.168.0.1:465 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013072 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000013073 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013074 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
13075 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
13076
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013077 When <server> is a simple name, it is checked against existing servers in the
13078 configuration and an error is reported if the specified server does not exist.
13079 If it is a log-format, no check is performed when parsing the configuration,
13080 and if we can't resolve a valid server name at runtime but the use-server rule
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050013081 was conditioned by an ACL returning true, no other use-server rule is applied
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013082 and we fall back to load balancing.
13083
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013084 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013085
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013086
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100130875. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013088--------------------------
13089
13090The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
13091depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
13092settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
13093written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
13094described in this section.
13095
13096
130975.1. Bind options
13098-----------------
13099
13100The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
13101as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
13102no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
13103parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
13104while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
13105provided immediately after the setting name.
13106
13107The currently supported settings are the following ones.
13108
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013109accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
13110 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
13111 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
13112 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
13113 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
13114 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
13115 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
13116 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
13117 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
13118 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010013119 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
13120 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
13121 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013122
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013123accept-proxy
13124 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020013125 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
13126 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013127 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
13128 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
13129 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
13130 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013131 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013132 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
13133 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020013134 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
13135 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013136
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020013137allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010013138 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010013139 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013140 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010013141 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
13142 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020013143
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013144alpn <protocols>
13145 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
13146 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
13147 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013148 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013149 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010013150 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
13151 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
13152 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
13153 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
13154 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
13155 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
13156 preference, like below :
13157
13158 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013159
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013160backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010013161 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013162 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
13163
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010013164curves <curves>
13165 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
13166 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
13167 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
13168 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
13169 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
13170 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
13171
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020013172ecdhe <named curve>
13173 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010013174 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
13175 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020013176
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020013177ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013178 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13179 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
13180 client's certificate.
13181
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013182ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
13183 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
13184 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
13185 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
13186 error is ignored.
13187
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013188ca-sign-file <cafile>
13189 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13190 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
13191 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
13192 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
13193 'generate-certificates' for details.
13194
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000013195ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013196 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
13197 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
13198 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
13199 'generate-certificates' for details.
13200
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010013201ca-verify-file <cafile>
13202 This setting designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to
13203 verify client's certificate. It designates CA certificates which must not be
13204 included in CA names sent in server hello message. Typically, "ca-file" must
13205 be defined with intermediate certificates, and "ca-verify-file" with
13206 certificates to ending the chain, like root CA.
13207
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013208ciphers <ciphers>
13209 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
13210 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000013211 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013212 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013213 information and recommendations see e.g.
13214 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
13215 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
13216 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
13217
13218ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
13219 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
13220 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
13221 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
13222 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013223 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
13224 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013225
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020013226crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013227 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13228 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
13229 to verify client's certificate.
13230
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013231crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013232 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13233 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
13234 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
13235 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
13236 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +010013237 file. Intermediate certificate can also be shared in a directory via
13238 "issuers-chain-path" directive.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013239
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +010013240 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load
13241 the key at the same path suffixed by a ".key".
13242
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013243 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
13244 are loaded.
13245
13246 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
William Lallemand3f25ae32020-02-24 16:30:12 +010013247 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends
13248 with '.key', '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This
13249 directive may be specified multiple times in order to load certificates from
13250 multiple files or directories. The certificates will be presented to clients
13251 who provide a valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their
13252 CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*'
13253 is used instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010013254 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013255
13256 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
13257 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
13258 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
13259 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010013260 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
13261 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013262
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020013263 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013264
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013265 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013266 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013267 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
13268 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013269 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
13270 clients).
13271
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020013272 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
13273 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
13274 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
13275 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
13276 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
13277 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
13278 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
13279 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
13280 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
13281 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
13282 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
13283 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
13284 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
13285
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010013286 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
13287 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
13288 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
13289 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
13290 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
13291
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050013292 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
13293 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
13294 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
13295 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013296
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020013297 To achieve this, OpenSSL 1.1.1 is required, you can configure this behavior
13298 by providing one crt entry per certificate type, or by configuring a "cert
13299 bundle" like it was required before HAProxy 1.8. See "ssl-load-extra-files".
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013300
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013301crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013302 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013303 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013304 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013305 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013306
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013307crt-list <file>
13308 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013309 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
13310 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013311
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013312 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
13313
William Lallemand5d036392020-06-30 16:11:36 +020013314 sslbindconf supports "allow-0rtt", "alpn", "ca-file", "ca-verify-file",
13315 "ciphers", "ciphersuites", "crl-file", "curves", "ecdhe", "no-ca-names",
13316 "npn", "verify" configuration. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1
13317 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported. It overrides the
13318 configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013319
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020013320 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013321 useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI, or
13322 after the first certificate to exclude a pattern from its CN or Subject Alt
13323 Name (SAN). The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid
13324 TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI
13325 filter is specified, the CN and SAN are used. This directive may be specified
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020013326 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
13327 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
13328 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013329
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020013330 Multi-cert bundling (see "ssl-load-extra-files") is supported with crt-list,
13331 as long as only the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do
13332 the same work on all bundled certificates.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013333
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020013334 Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a hash ('#') will be ignored.
13335
Joao Moraisaa8fcc42020-11-24 08:24:30 -030013336 The first declared certificate of a bind line is used as the default
13337 certificate, either from crt or crt-list option, which haproxy should use in
13338 the TLS handshake if no other certificate matches. This certificate will also
13339 be used if the provided SNI matches its CN or SAN, even if a matching SNI
13340 filter is found on any crt-list. The SNI filter !* can be used after the first
13341 declared certificate to not include its CN and SAN in the SNI tree, so it will
13342 never match except if no other certificate matches. This way the first
13343 declared certificate act as a fallback.
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013344
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013345 crt-list file example:
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013346 cert1.pem !*
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020013347 # comment
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010013348 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013349 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010013350 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013351
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013352defer-accept
13353 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
13354 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
13355 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013356 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013357 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
13358 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
13359 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
13360 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
13361 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
13362 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
13363 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
13364
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020013365expose-fd listeners
13366 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
13367 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020013368 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
13369 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013370 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020013371
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013372force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013373 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013374 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013375 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013376 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013377
13378force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013379 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013380 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013381 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013382
13383force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013384 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013385 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013386 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013387
13388force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013389 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013390 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013391 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013392
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013393force-tlsv13
13394 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
13395 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013396 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013397
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013398generate-certificates
13399 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13400 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
13401 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
13402 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
13403 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
13404 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
13405 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
13406 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
13407 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
13408 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
13409 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
13410
13411 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
13412 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013413 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013414 certificate is used many times.
13415
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013416gid <gid>
13417 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
13418 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
13419 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
13420 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
13421 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13422
13423group <group>
13424 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
13425 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
13426 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
13427 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
13428 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13429
13430id <id>
13431 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
13432 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
13433 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
13434 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
13435
13436interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010013437 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
13438 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
13439 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
13440 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
13441 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
13442 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010013443 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
13444 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
13445 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
13446 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
13447 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
13448 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013449
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013450level <level>
13451 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
13452 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
13453 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013454 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013455 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
13456 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
13457 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013458 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013459 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013460 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013461 all counters).
13462
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020013463severity-output <format>
13464 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
13465 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
13466 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
13467 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
13468 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
13469 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
13470 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
13471 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
13472 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
13473 rfc5424 convention.
13474
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013475maxconn <maxconn>
13476 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
13477 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
13478 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
13479 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
13480 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
13481 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
13482 eat all memory.
13483
13484mode <mode>
13485 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
13486 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
13487 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
13488 UNIX sockets.
13489
13490mss <maxseg>
13491 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
13492 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
13493 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
13494 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
13495 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
13496 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
13497 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
13498 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
13499 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
13500 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
13501 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
13502
13503name <name>
13504 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
13505 page.
13506
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020013507namespace <name>
13508 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
13509 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
13510 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
13511 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
13512
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013513nice <nice>
13514 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
13515 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
13516 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
13517 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
13518 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
13519 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
13520 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
13521 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
13522 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
13523 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
13524 one for an RDP socket.
13525
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020013526no-ca-names
13527 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13528 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010013529 Use "ca-verify-file" instead of "ca-file" with "no-ca-names".
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020013530
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013531no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013532 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013533 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013534 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013535 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013536 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
13537 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013538
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020013539no-tls-tickets
13540 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13541 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
13542 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013543 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
13544 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010013545 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
13546 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
13547 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020013548
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013549no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013550 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013551 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013552 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013553 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013554 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13555 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013556
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013557no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013558 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013559 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013560 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013561 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013562 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13563 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013564
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013565no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013566 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013567 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013568 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013569 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013570 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13571 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013572
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013573no-tlsv13
13574 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13575 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
13576 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
13577 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013578 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13579 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013580
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020013581npn <protocols>
13582 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
13583 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
13584 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013585 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013586 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010013587 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
13588 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
13589 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
13590 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
13591 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020013592
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000013593prefer-client-ciphers
13594 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
13595 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
13596 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020013597 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
13598 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
13599 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000013600
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013601process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010013602 This restricts the list of processes or threads on which this listener is
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013603 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013604 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013605 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
13606 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
13607 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
13608 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013609 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010013610 connections for this listener, for the the process set. If multiple processes
13611 and threads are configured, a warning is emitted, as it either results from a
13612 configuration error or a misunderstanding of these models. For the unlikely
13613 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated.
13614 <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013615
13616 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
13617
13618 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
13619 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
13620 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
13621 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
13622 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
13623 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
13624 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
13625 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020013626
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013627proto <name>
13628 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
13629 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
13630 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010013631 in haproxy -vv. The protocols properties are reported : the mode (TCP/HTTP),
13632 the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
13633
13634 Some protocols report errors on aborts (flag=CLEAN_ABRT). Some others are
13635 subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally
13636 some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG). The HTX compatibility is
13637 also reported (flag=HTX).
13638
13639 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "proto" directive on
13640 a bind line :
13641
13642 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|CLEAN_ABRT|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
13643 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
13644 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
13645
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040013646 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013647 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080013648 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013649 h2" on the bind line.
13650
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013651ssl
13652 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013653 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013654 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
13655 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020013656 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
13657 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013658
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013659ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
13660 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020013661 from this listener. Using this setting without "ssl-min-ver" can be
13662 ambiguous because the default ssl-min-ver value could change in future HAProxy
13663 versions. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013664 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
13665
13666ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020013667 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections
13668 instantiated from this listener. The default value is "TLSv1.2". This option
13669 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
13670 See also "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013671
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010013672strict-sni
13673 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
13674 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
13675 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
13676 See the "crt" option for more information.
13677
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013678tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013679 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013680 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
13681 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013682 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013683 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
13684 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
13685 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
13686 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
13687 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
13688 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
13689 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
13690
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013691tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010013692 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013693 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
13694 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
13695 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
13696 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
13697 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
13698 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
13699 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020013700 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
13701 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
13702 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013703
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010013704tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
13705 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010013706 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
13707 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
13708 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
13709 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
13710 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
13711 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
13712 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
13713 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
13714 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
13715 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010013716 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
13717 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
13718
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013719transparent
13720 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
13721 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
13722 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
13723 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
13724 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
13725 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
13726 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
13727 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
13728 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
13729 so check for support with your vendor.
13730
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010013731v4v6
13732 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
13733 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
13734 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
13735 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013736 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010013737
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010013738v6only
13739 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
13740 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
13741 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010013742 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
13743 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010013744
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013745uid <uid>
13746 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
13747 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
13748 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
13749 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
13750 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13751
13752user <user>
13753 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
13754 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
13755 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
13756 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
13757 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13758
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013759verify [none|optional|required]
13760 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
13761 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
13762 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
13763 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
13764 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020013765 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
13766 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
13767 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
13768 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013769
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200137705.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010013771------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013772
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010013773The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
13774which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
13775arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
13776settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
13777after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
13778Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
13779address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013780
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013781 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010013782 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013783
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013784Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
13785keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
13786
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013787The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013788
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020013789addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013790 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010013791 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
13792 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
13793 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
13794 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
13795 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013796
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013797agent-check
13798 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013799 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010013800 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
13801 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
13802 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013803
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013804 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013805 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020013806 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
13807 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
13808 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013809
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013810 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
13811 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
13812 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
13813 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
13814 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020013815
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013816 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013817 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013818
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013819 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
13820 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
13821 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013822
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013823 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
13824 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
13825 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013826
William Dauchyf8e795c2020-09-26 13:35:51 +020013827 - The words "down", "fail", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013828 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
13829 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
13830 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
13831 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013832 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013833 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013834
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013835 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
13836 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013837
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013838 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
13839 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
13840 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
13841 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
13842 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
13843 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
13844 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
13845 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
13846 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013847
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090013848 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
13849 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013850 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
13851 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
13852 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010013853 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090013854
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013855 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013856 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013857
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070013858agent-send <string>
13859 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
13860 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
13861 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
13862 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
13863 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
13864
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013865agent-inter <delay>
13866 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
13867 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
13868
13869 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
13870 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
13871 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
13872 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
13873 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
13874 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
13875 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
13876 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
13877 of backends use the same servers.
13878
13879 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
13880
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010013881agent-addr <addr>
13882 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
13883
13884 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
13885 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
13886 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
13887 hostname, it will be resolved.
13888
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013889agent-port <port>
13890 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
13891
13892 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
13893
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020013894allow-0rtt
13895 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020013896 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
13897 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020013898
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010013899alpn <protocols>
13900 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
13901 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
13902 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013903 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010013904 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
13905 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
13906 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
13907 now obsolete NPN extension.
13908 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
13909 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
13910
13911 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
13912
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013913backup
13914 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
13915 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
13916 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
13917 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013918 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
13919 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013920
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020013921ca-file <cafile>
13922 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13923 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
13924 server's certificate.
13925
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013926check
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020013927 This option enables health checks on a server:
13928 - when not set, no health checking is performed, and the server is always
13929 considered available.
13930 - when set and no other check method is configured, the server is considered
13931 available when a connection can be established at the highest configured
13932 transport layer. This means TCP by default, or SSL/TLS when "ssl" or
13933 "check-ssl" are set, both possibly combined with connection prefixes such
13934 as a PROXY protocol header when "send-proxy" or "check-send-proxy" are
13935 set.
13936 - when set and an application-level health check is defined, the
13937 application-level exchanges are performed on top of the configured
13938 transport layer and the server is considered available if all of the
13939 exchanges succeed.
13940
13941 By default, health checks are performed on the same address and port as
13942 configured on the server, using the same encapsulation parameters (SSL/TLS,
13943 proxy-protocol header, etc... ). It is possible to change the destination
13944 address using "addr" and the port using "port". When done, it is assumed the
13945 server isn't checked on the service port, and configured encapsulation
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +050013946 parameters are not reused. One must explicitly set "check-send-proxy" to send
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020013947 connection headers, "check-ssl" to use SSL/TLS.
13948
13949 When "sni" or "alpn" are set on the server line, their value is not used for
13950 health checks and one must use "check-sni" or "check-alpn".
13951
13952 The default source address for health check traffic is the same as the one
13953 defined in the backend. It can be changed with the "source" keyword.
13954
13955 The interval between checks can be set using the "inter" keyword, and the
13956 "rise" and "fall" keywords can be used to define how many successful or
13957 failed health checks are required to flag a server available or not
13958 available.
13959
13960 Optional application-level health checks can be configured with "option
13961 httpchk", "option mysql-check" "option smtpchk", "option pgsql-check",
13962 "option ldap-check", or "option redis-check".
13963
13964 Example:
13965 # simple tcp check
13966 backend foo
13967 server s1 192.168.0.1:80 check
13968 # this does a tcp connect + tls handshake
13969 backend foo
13970 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
13971 # simple tcp check is enough for check success
13972 backend foo
13973 option tcp-check
13974 tcp-check connect
13975 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013976
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020013977check-send-proxy
13978 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
13979 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
13980 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
13981 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
13982 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
13983 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
13984 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
13985
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010013986check-alpn <protocols>
13987 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
13988 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
13989 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
13990
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020013991check-proto <name>
13992 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the server's health-check
13993 connections. It must be compatible with the health-check type (TCP or
13994 HTTP). It must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010013995 protocols is reported in haproxy -vv. The protocols properties are
13996 reported : the mode (TCP/HTTP), the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
13997
13998 Some protocols report errors on aborts (flag=CLEAN_ABRT). Some others are
13999 subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally
14000 some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG). The HTX compatibility is
14001 also reported (flag=HTX).
14002
14003 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "check-proto"
14004 directive on a server line:
14005
14006 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|CLEAN_ABRT|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14007 fcgi : mode=HTTP side=BE mux=FCGI flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14008 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
14009 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
14010
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040014011 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020014012 protocol for health-check connections established to this server.
14013 If not defined, the server one will be used, if set.
14014
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010014015check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020014016 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010014017 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
14018 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020014019
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014020check-ssl
14021 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
14022 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
14023 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
14024 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014025 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014026 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
14027 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014028 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014029 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
14030 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014031
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014032check-via-socks4
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014033 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014034 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
14035 for normal traffic.
14036
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014037ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014038 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
14039 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
14040 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000014041 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
14042 information and recommendations see e.g.
14043 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
14044 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
14045 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014046
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014047ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
14048 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
14049 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
14050 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
14051 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000014052 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
14053 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
14054 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014055
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014056cookie <value>
14057 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
14058 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
14059 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
14060 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
14061 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
14062 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
14063 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
14064
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014065crl-file <crlfile>
14066 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14067 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
14068 to verify server's certificate.
14069
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020014070crt <cert>
14071 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
14072 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
14073 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
14074 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
14075 certificate request.
14076
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014077disabled
14078 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
14079 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
14080 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
14081 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
14082 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014083 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014084
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014085enabled
14086 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
14087 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
14088 default value.
14089 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
14090 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014091
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014092error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010014093 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
14094 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
14095 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014096
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014097 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014098
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014099fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014100 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
14101 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
14102 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
14103
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014104force-sslv3
14105 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
14106 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014107 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014108 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014109
14110force-tlsv10
14111 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014112 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014113 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014114
14115force-tlsv11
14116 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014117 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014118 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014119
14120force-tlsv12
14121 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014122 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014123 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014124
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014125force-tlsv13
14126 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
14127 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014128 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014129
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014130id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020014131 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
14132 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
14133 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014134
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014135init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
14136 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
14137 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014138 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014139 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
14140 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
14141 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
14142 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
14143 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
14144 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
14145 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
14146 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
14147 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014148 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014149 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
14150 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
14151 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
14152 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
14153 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
14154 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014155 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014156
14157 Example:
14158 defaults
14159 # never fail on address resolution
14160 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
14161
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014162inter <delay>
14163fastinter <delay>
14164downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014165 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
14166 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
14167 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
14168 between checks depending on the server state :
14169
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020014170 Server state | Interval used
14171 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14172 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
14173 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14174 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
14175 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
14176 or yet unchecked. |
14177 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14178 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
14179 | "inter" otherwise.
14180 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014181
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014182 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
14183 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
14184 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
14185 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014186 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
14187 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
14188 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
14189 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
14190 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014191
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +020014192log-proto <logproto>
14193 The "log-proto" specifies the protocol used to forward event messages to
14194 a server configured in a ring section. Possible values are "legacy"
14195 and "octet-count" corresponding respectively to "Non-transparent-framing"
14196 and "Octet counting" in rfc6587. "legacy" is the default.
14197
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014198maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014199 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
14200 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010014201 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
14202 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014203 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
14204 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
14205 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
14206 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
14207
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010014208 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
14209 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
14210 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
14211 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
14212 than 50 concurrent requests.
14213
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014214maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014215 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
14216 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
14217 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
14218 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
Willy Tarreau8ae8c482020-10-22 17:19:07 +020014219 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. Some load
14220 balancing algorithms such as leastconn take this into account and accept to
14221 add requests into a server's queue up to this value if it is explicitly set
14222 to a value greater than zero, which often allows to better smooth the load
14223 when dealing with single-digit maxconn values. The default value is "0" which
14224 means the queue is unlimited. See also the "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters
14225 and "balance leastconn".
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014226
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010014227max-reuse <count>
14228 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
14229 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
14230 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
14231 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
14232 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
14233 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
14234 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
14235 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
14236
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014237minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014238 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
14239 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
14240 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
14241 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
14242 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
14243 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014244 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014245 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014246
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020014247namespace <name>
14248 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
14249 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
14250 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
14251 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
14252
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014253no-agent-check
14254 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
14255 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14256 default value.
14257 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14258 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
14259
14260no-backup
14261 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
14262 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14263 default value.
14264 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14265 "default-server" "backup" setting.
14266
14267no-check
14268 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
14269 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14270 default value.
14271 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14272 "default-server" "check" setting.
14273
14274no-check-ssl
14275 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
14276 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14277 default value.
14278 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14279 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
14280
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014281no-send-proxy
14282 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
14283 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14284 default value.
14285 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14286 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
14287
14288no-send-proxy-v2
14289 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
14290 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14291 default value.
14292 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14293 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
14294
14295no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
14296 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
14297 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14298 default value.
14299 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14300 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
14301
14302no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
14303 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
14304 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14305 default value.
14306 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14307 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
14308
14309no-ssl
14310 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
14311 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14312 default value.
14313 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14314 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
14315
William Dauchyf6370442020-11-14 19:25:33 +010014316 Note that using `default-server ssl` setting and `no-ssl` on server will
14317 however init SSL connection, so it can be later be enabled through the
14318 runtime API: see `set server` commands in management doc.
14319
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010014320no-ssl-reuse
14321 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
14322 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
14323 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
14324 and for paranoid users.
14325
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014326no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014327 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
14328 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014329 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014330
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014331 Supported in default-server: No
14332
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020014333no-tls-tickets
14334 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14335 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
14336 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014337 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
14338 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010014339 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
14340 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
14341 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014342 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020014343
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014344no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014345 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014346 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14347 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014348 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14349 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014350 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014351
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014352 Supported in default-server: No
14353
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014354no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014355 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014356 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14357 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014358 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14359 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014360 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014361
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014362 Supported in default-server: No
14363
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014364no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014365 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014366 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14367 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014368 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14369 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014370 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014371
14372 Supported in default-server: No
14373
14374no-tlsv13
14375 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
14376 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14377 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
14378 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14379 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014380 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014381
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014382 Supported in default-server: No
14383
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014384no-verifyhost
14385 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
14386 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14387 default value.
14388 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14389 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014390
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020014391no-tfo
14392 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
14393 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14394 default value.
14395 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14396 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
14397
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090014398non-stick
14399 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
14400 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
14401 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
14402
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014403npn <protocols>
14404 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
14405 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
14406 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014407 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014408 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
14409 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
14410 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
14411
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014412observe <mode>
14413 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
14414 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
14415 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
14416 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
14417 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
14418 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010014419 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014420
14421 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
14422
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014423on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014424 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
14425 Currently, four modes are available:
14426 - fastinter: force fastinter
14427 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
14428 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
14429 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
14430 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
14431
14432 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
14433
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090014434on-marked-down <action>
14435 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
14436 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014437 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
14438 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
14439 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
14440 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
14441 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
14442 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
14443 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
14444 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090014445
14446 Actions are disabled by default
14447
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014448on-marked-up <action>
14449 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
14450 Currently one action is available:
14451 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
14452 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
14453 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
14454 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014455 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
14456 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014457 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
14458 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
14459
14460 Actions are disabled by default
14461
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020014462pool-low-conn <max>
14463 Set a low threshold on the number of idling connections for a server, below
14464 which a thread will not try to steal a connection from another thread. This
14465 can be useful to improve CPU usage patterns in scenarios involving many very
14466 fast servers, in order to ensure all threads will keep a few idle connections
14467 all the time instead of letting them accumulate over one thread and migrating
14468 them from thread to thread. Typical values of twice the number of threads
14469 seem to show very good performance already with sub-millisecond response
14470 times. The default is zero, indicating that any idle connection can be used
14471 at any time. It is the recommended setting for normal use. This only applies
14472 to connections that can be shared according to the same principles as those
Willy Tarreau0784db82021-02-19 11:45:22 +010014473 applying to "http-reuse". In case connection sharing between threads would
14474 be disabled via "tune.idle-pool.shared", it can become very important to use
14475 this setting to make sure each thread always has a few connections, or the
14476 connection reuse rate will decrease as thread count increases.
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020014477
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010014478pool-max-conn <max>
14479 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
14480 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
14481 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
14482 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
14483 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
14484 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
14485
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010014486pool-purge-delay <delay>
14487 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010014488 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020014489 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010014490
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014491port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014492 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
William Dauchy4858fb22021-02-03 22:30:09 +010014493 send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
14494 desirable to dedicate a port to a specific component able to perform complex
14495 tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application. It is
14496 common to run a simple script in inetd for instance. This parameter is
14497 ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "addr" parameter.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014498
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014499proto <name>
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014500 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
14501 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
14502 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010014503 reported in haproxy -vv.The protocols properties are reported : the mode
14504 (TCP/HTTP), the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
14505
14506 Some protocols report errors on aborts (flag=CLEAN_ABRT). Some others are
14507 subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally
14508 some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG). The HTX compatibility is
14509 also reported (flag=HTX).
14510
14511 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "proto" directive on
14512 a server line :
14513
14514 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|CLEAN_ABRT|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14515 fcgi : mode=HTTP side=BE mux=FCGI flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14516 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
14517 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
14518
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040014519 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014520 protocol for all connections established to this server.
14521
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014522redir <prefix>
14523 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
14524 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
14525 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
14526 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
14527 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
14528 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
14529 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
14530 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014531 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014532 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014533 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
14534 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
14535 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
14536 loop between the client and HAProxy!
14537
14538 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
14539
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014540rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014541 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
14542 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
14543 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
14544
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020014545resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
14546 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
14547 server.
14548
14549 Available options:
14550
14551 * allow-dup-ip
14552 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
14553 resolution at runtime is in operation.
14554 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
14555 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
14556 For such case, simply enable this option.
14557 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
14558
Daniel Corbettf8716912019-11-17 09:48:56 -050014559 * ignore-weight
14560 Ignore any weight that is set within an SRV record. This is useful when
14561 you would like to control the weights using an alternate method, such as
14562 using an "agent-check" or through the runtime api.
14563
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020014564 * prevent-dup-ip
14565 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
14566 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
14567 same fqdn.
14568 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
14569
14570 Example:
14571 backend b_myapp
14572 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
14573 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
14574 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
14575
14576 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
14577 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
14578 it
14579 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
14580 different address
14581
14582 Default value: not set
14583
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014584resolve-prefer <family>
14585 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
14586 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
14587 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
14588 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
14589
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020014590 Default value: ipv6
14591
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014592 Example:
14593
14594 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014595
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014596resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014597 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014598 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014599 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014600 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
14601 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014602 configured network, another address is selected.
14603
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014604 Example:
14605
14606 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014607
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014608resolvers <id>
14609 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
14610 hostname.
14611
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014612 Example:
14613
14614 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014615
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014616 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014617
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010014618send-proxy
14619 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
14620 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
14621 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
14622 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014623 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
14624 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
14625 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
14626 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
14627 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
14628 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
14629 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
14630 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
14631 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
14632 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014633 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
14634 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010014635
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014636send-proxy-v2
14637 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
14638 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14639 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14640 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020014641 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
14642 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
14643 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
14644 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014645
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010014646proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
Tim Duesterhuscf6e0c82020-03-13 12:34:24 +010014647 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add options to send in PROXY protocol
14648 version 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are:
14649
14650 - ssl : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl".
14651 - cert-cn : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn".
14652 - ssl-cipher: Name of the used cipher.
14653 - cert-sig : Signature algorithm of the used certificate.
14654 - cert-key : Key algorithm of the used certificate
14655 - authority : Host name value passed by the client (only SNI from a TLS
14656 connection is supported).
14657 - crc32c : Checksum of the PROXYv2 header.
14658 - unique-id : Send a unique ID generated using the frontend's
14659 "unique-id-format" within the PROXYv2 header.
14660 This unique-id is primarily meant for "mode tcp". It can
14661 lead to unexpected results in "mode http", because the
14662 generated unique ID is also used for the first HTTP request
14663 within a Keep-Alive connection.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010014664
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014665send-proxy-v2-ssl
14666 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
14667 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14668 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14669 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
14670 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
14671 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
14672 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014673 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
14674 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014675
14676send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
14677 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
14678 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14679 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14680 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
14681 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
14682 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
14683 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
14684 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014685 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
14686 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014687
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014688slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014689 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
14690 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
14691 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
14692 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
14693 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
14694 parameters :
14695
14696 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
14697 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
14698
14699 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
14700 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
14701 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
14702 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
14703
14704 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
14705 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
14706 seen as failed.
14707
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020014708sni <expression>
14709 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
14710 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
14711 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
14712 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020014713 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
14714 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014715 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010014716 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
14717 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020014718
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020014719source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020014720source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020014721source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014722 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
14723 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
14724 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
14725 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
14726
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020014727 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
14728 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
14729 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
14730 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
14731 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
14732 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
14733 server.
14734
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000014735 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
14736 specifying the source address without port(s).
14737
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014738ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020014739 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
14740 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
14741 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
14742 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
14743 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
14744 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014745 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
14746 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014747
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014748ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
14749 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
14750 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
14751 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
14752
14753ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
14754 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
14755 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
14756 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
14757
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014758ssl-reuse
14759 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
14760 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14761 default value.
14762 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14763 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
14764
14765stick
14766 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
14767 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14768 default value.
14769 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14770 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014771
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014772socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014773 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014774 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
14775 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
14776
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020014777tcp-ut <delay>
14778 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
14779 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
14780 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014781 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020014782 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
14783 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
14784 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
14785 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
14786 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
14787 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
14788 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
14789 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
14790 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
14791
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010014792tfo
14793 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
14794 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
14795 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
14796 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
14797 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or haproxy
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020014798 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010014799
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014800track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020014801 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
14802 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
14803 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
14804 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014805 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
14806
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014807tls-tickets
14808 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
14809 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14810 default value.
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010014811 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
14812 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
14813 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014814 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
Bjoern Jacke5ab7eb62020-02-13 14:16:16 +010014815 "default-server" "no-tls-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014816
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014817verify [none|required]
14818 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010014819 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014820 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
14821 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014822 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014823 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
14824 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
14825 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
14826 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
14827 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
14828 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
14829 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
14830 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014831
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070014832verifyhost <hostname>
14833 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014834 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
14835 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
14836 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
14837 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
14838 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
14839 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
14840 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
14841 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070014842
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014843weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014844 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
14845 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
14846 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020014847 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
14848 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
14849 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
14850 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
14851 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
14852 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014853
14854
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200148555.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
14856-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014857
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014858HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
14859using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070014860configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process's life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014861This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
14862can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
14863workload.
14864This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
14865resolution at run time.
14866Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
14867carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
14868
14869
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200148705.3.1. Global overview
14871----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014872
14873As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
14874different steps of the process life:
14875
14876 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
14877 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
14878 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
14879
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014880 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
14881 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014882
14883A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
14884 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
14885 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
14886 resolution to know this new IP.
14887
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014888When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014889HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014890SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
14891from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
14892will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, haproxy
14893will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020014894
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014895A few things important to notice:
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014896 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014897 first valid response.
14898
14899 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
14900 servers return an error.
14901
14902
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200149035.3.2. The resolvers section
14904----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014905
14906This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014907HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
14908contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014909
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014910When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
14911uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
14912is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
14913answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
14914
14915When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014916used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014917
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014918 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
14919 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
14920 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014921
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014922 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
14923 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014924
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014925 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
14926 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
14927 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014928
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014929For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
14930following scenarios are possible:
14931
14932 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
14933 ignored
14934
14935 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
14936 applied
14937
14938 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
14939 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
14940
14941 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
14942 retries the query with a new type
14943
14944 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
14945 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014946
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020014947As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, haproxy keeps
14948a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014949<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020014950
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014951
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014952resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014953 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014954
14955A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
14956
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020014957accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014958 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014959 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020014960 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
14961 by RFC 6891)
14962
Emeric Brun4c751952021-03-08 16:41:29 +010014963 Note: the maximum allowed value is 65535. Recommended value for UDP is
14964 4096 and it is not recommended to exceed 8192 except if you are sure
14965 that your system and network can handle this (over 65507 makes no sense
14966 since is the maximum UDP payload size). If you are using only TCP
14967 nameservers to handle huge DNS responses, you should put this value
14968 to the max: 65535.
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020014969
Emeric Brunc8f3e452021-04-07 16:04:54 +020014970nameserver <name> <address>[:port] [param*]
14971 Used to configure a nameserver. <name> of the nameserver should ne unique.
14972 By default the <address> is considered of type datagram. This means if an
14973 IPv4 or IPv6 is configured without special address prefixes (paragraph 11.)
14974 the UDP protocol will be used. If an stream protocol address prefix is used,
14975 the nameserver will be considered as a stream server (TCP for instance) and
14976 "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph which are relevant for DNS
14977 resolving will be considered. Note: currently, in TCP mode, 4 queries are
14978 pipelined on the same connections. A batch of idle connections are removed
14979 every 5 seconds. "maxconn" can be configured to limit the amount of those
Emeric Brun56fc5d92021-02-12 20:05:45 +010014980 concurrent connections and TLS should also usable if the server supports.
14981
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060014982parse-resolv-conf
14983 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
14984 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
14985 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
14986
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014987hold <status> <period>
14988 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
14989 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010014990 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020014991 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014992 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
14993 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
14994 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
14995
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020014996 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014997
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014998resolve_retries <nb>
14999 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
15000 giving up.
15001 Default value: 3
15002
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015003 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
15004 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
15005 type.
15006
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015007timeout <event> <time>
15008 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
15009 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
15010 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015011 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
15012 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015013 Default value: 1s
15014 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015015 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015016 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015017 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
15018 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
15019
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020015020 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015021
15022 resolvers mydns
15023 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
15024 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Emeric Brunc8f3e452021-04-07 16:04:54 +020015025 nameserver dns3 tcp@10.0.0.3:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060015026 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015027 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015028 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015029 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010015030 hold other 30s
15031 hold refused 30s
15032 hold nx 30s
15033 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015034 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015035 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015036
15037
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200150386. Cache
15039---------
15040
15041HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
15042(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
15043RAM.
15044
15045The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
15046this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
15047
15048If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
15049independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
15050when we try to allocate a new one.
15051
15052The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
15053
15054It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
15055"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
15056for more details.
15057
15058When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
15059replaced by "<CACHE>".
15060
15061
150626.1. Limitation
15063----------------
15064
15065The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
15066
15067- If the response is not a 200
Remi Tricot-Le Breton4f730832020-11-26 15:51:50 +010015068- If the response contains a Vary header and either the process-vary option is
15069 disabled, or a currently unmanaged header is specified in the Vary value (only
15070 accept-encoding and referer are managed for now)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015071- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
15072- If the response is not cacheable
Remi Tricot-Le Bretond493bc82020-11-26 15:51:29 +010015073- If the response does not have an explicit expiration time (s-maxage or max-age
15074 Cache-Control directives or Expires header) or a validator (ETag or Last-Modified
15075 headers)
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015076- If the process-vary option is enabled and there are already max-secondary-entries
15077 entries with the same primary key as the current response
Remi Tricot-Le Breton6ca89162021-01-07 14:50:51 +010015078- If the process-vary option is enabled and the response has an unknown encoding (not
15079 mentioned in https://www.iana.org/assignments/http-parameters/http-parameters.xhtml)
15080 while varying on the accept-encoding client header
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015081
15082- If the request is not a GET
15083- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
15084- If the request contains an Authorization header
15085
15086
150876.2. Setup
15088-----------
15089
15090To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
15091the corresponding http-request and response actions.
15092
15093
150946.2.1. Cache section
15095---------------------
15096
15097cache <name>
15098 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
15099 size of cache is mandatory.
15100
15101total-max-size <megabytes>
15102 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
15103 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
15104
15105max-object-size <bytes>
15106 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
15107 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
15108 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
15109
15110max-age <seconds>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015111 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set as the lowest
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015112 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
15113 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
15114 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
15115 default.
15116
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone6cc5b52020-12-23 18:13:53 +010015117process-vary <on/off>
15118 Enable or disable the processing of the Vary header. When disabled, a response
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010015119 containing such a header will never be cached. When enabled, we need to calculate
15120 a preliminary hash for a subset of request headers on all the incoming requests
15121 (which might come with a cpu cost) which will be used to build a secondary key
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone6cc5b52020-12-23 18:13:53 +010015122 for a given request (see RFC 7234#4.1). The default value is off (disabled).
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010015123
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015124max-secondary-entries <number>
15125 Define the maximum number of simultaneous secondary entries with the same primary
15126 key in the cache. This needs the vary support to be enabled. Its default value is 10
15127 and should be passed a strictly positive integer.
15128
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015129
151306.2.2. Proxy section
15131---------------------
15132
15133http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
15134 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
15135 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
15136 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
15137 after this one.
15138
15139http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
15140 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
15141 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
15142 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
15143 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
15144
15145
15146Example:
15147
15148 backend bck1
15149 mode http
15150
15151 http-request cache-use foobar
15152 http-response cache-store foobar
15153 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
15154
15155 cache foobar
15156 total-max-size 4
15157 max-age 240
15158
15159
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200151607. Using ACLs and fetching samples
15161----------------------------------
15162
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015163HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015164client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
15165The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
15166these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
15167but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
15168data called patterns.
15169
15170
151717.1. ACL basics
15172---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015173
15174The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
15175content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
15176from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
15177simple :
15178
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015179 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015180 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015181 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
15182 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015183
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015184The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
15185adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015186
15187In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
15188
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015189 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015190
15191This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
15192Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
15193and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015194an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
15195conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
15196as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
15197are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015198
15199ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
15200'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
15201which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
15202
15203There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
15204performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
15205
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015206The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
15207specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
15208this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015209methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
15210ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015211
15212Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
15213 - boolean
15214 - integer (signed or unsigned)
15215 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
15216 - string
15217 - data block
15218
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015219Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
15220converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
15221would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
15222The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
15223which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
15224
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015225Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
15226keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
15227fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
15228which are summarized in the table below :
15229
15230 +---------------------+-----------------+
15231 | Sample or converter | Default |
15232 | output type | matching method |
15233 +---------------------+-----------------+
15234 | boolean | bool |
15235 +---------------------+-----------------+
15236 | integer | int |
15237 +---------------------+-----------------+
15238 | ip | ip |
15239 +---------------------+-----------------+
15240 | string | str |
15241 +---------------------+-----------------+
15242 | binary | none, use "-m" |
15243 +---------------------+-----------------+
15244
15245Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
15246matching method, see below.
15247
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015248The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
15249 - boolean
15250 - integer or integer range
15251 - IP address / network
15252 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
15253 - regular expression
15254 - hex block
15255
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015256The following ACL flags are currently supported :
15257
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015258 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
15259 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015260 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015261 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010015262 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010015263 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015264 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
15265
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015266The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
15267read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
15268if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
15269lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
15270will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
15271beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
15272a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
15273lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
15274exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
15275
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010015276The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
15277parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
15278ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
15279a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
15280check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
15281
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010015282The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
15283socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
15284file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
15285
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015286Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
15287loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
15288
15289 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
15290
15291In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
15292the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
15293case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
15294as well.
15295
15296The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
15297sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
15298do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
15299methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
15300is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015301obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015302followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
15303default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
15304that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
15305string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
15306
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015307The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
15308By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
15309string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
15310resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
15311server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015312waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015313flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
15314function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
15315
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015316There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
15317sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
15318be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015319
15320 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
15321 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015322 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
15323 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
15324 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
15325 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015326
15327 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
15328 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015329 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015330
15331 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015332 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015333
15334 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015335 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015336
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015337 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015338 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
15339
15340 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
15341 binary or string samples.
15342
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015343 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
15344 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015345
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015346 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
15347 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
15348 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015349
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015350 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
15351 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015352
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015353 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
15354 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015355
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015356 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
15357 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015358
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015359 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
15360 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015361 This may be used with binary or string samples.
15362
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015363 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
15364 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
15365 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015366
15367For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
15368request, it is possible to do :
15369
15370 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
15371
15372In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
15373buffer, one would use the following acl :
15374
15375 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
15376
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015377On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
15378possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
15379
15380 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
15381
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015382All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
15383criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
15384method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
15385to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
15386criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
15387the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015388
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015389If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015390the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
15391For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015392
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015393 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
15394 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
15395 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
15396 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015397
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015398
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015399The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
15400types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
15401combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
15402brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
15403default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015404
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015405 +-------------------------------------------------+
15406 | Input sample type |
15407 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015408 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015409 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
15410 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
15411 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015412 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015413 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015414 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015415 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015416 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015417 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015418 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015419 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015420 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015421 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015422 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015423 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015424 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015425 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015426 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015427 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015428 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015429 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015430 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015431 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015432 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015433 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
15434 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
15435 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015436
15437
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200154387.1.1. Matching booleans
15439------------------------
15440
15441In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
15442Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
15443When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
15444that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
15445
15446Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
15447return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
15448"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
15449
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015450
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200154517.1.2. Matching integers
15452------------------------
15453
15454Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
15455enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
15456to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
15457
15458Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
15459matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
15460lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015461
15462For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
15463unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
15464representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
15465
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015466As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
15467two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
15468instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
15469ranges and operators.
15470
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015471For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015472operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
15473Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
15474of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015475
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015476Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015477
15478 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
15479 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
15480 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
15481 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
15482 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
15483
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015484For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015485
15486 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
15487
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015488This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
15489
15490 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
15491
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015492
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200154937.1.3. Matching strings
15494-----------------------
15495
15496String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
15497different forms :
15498
15499 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015500 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015501
15502 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015503 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015504
15505 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
15506 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
15507
15508 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
15509 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
15510
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010015511 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015512 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
15513 matches.
15514
15515 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
15516 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
15517 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015518
15519String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
15520exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
15521characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
15522string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
15523to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015524before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015525
Mathias Weiersmuellercb250fc2019-12-02 09:43:40 +010015526Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
15527(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
15528Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
15529
15530Example:
15531 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
15532 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
15533
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015534
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200155357.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
15536---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015537
15538Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
15539they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
15540possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
15541passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
15542the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015543the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
15544match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015545
15546
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200155477.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
15548-------------------------------------
15549
15550It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
15551not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
15552a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
15553to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
15554digits may be used upper or lower case.
15555
15556Example :
15557 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
15558 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
15559
15560
155617.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
15562---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015563
15564IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
15565netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
15566within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010015567host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015568difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
15569at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
15570does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
15571parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015572
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020015573The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
15574abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
15575
15576 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15577 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
15578 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15579 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
15580 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
15581 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
15582 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
15583 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15584
15585Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
15586192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
15587
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020015588IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
15589Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
15590trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
15591IPv6 patterns.
15592
15593HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
15594following situations :
15595 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
15596 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
15597 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
15598 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
15599 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
15600 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
15601 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
15602 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
15603 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
15604 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
15605
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015606
156077.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
15608----------------------------------
15609
15610Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
15611combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
15612
15613 - AND (implicit)
15614 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
15615 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015616
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015617A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015618
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015619 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020015620
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015621Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
15622indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020015623
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015624For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
15625"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
15626requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
15627is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
15628
15629 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015630 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
15631 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
15632 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015633
15634To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
15635and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
15636
15637 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
15638 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
15639 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
15640 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
15641
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015642 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015643 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
15644 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
15645 use_backend www if host_www
15646
15647It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
15648expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
15649be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
15650the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
15651
15652 The following rule :
15653
15654 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015655 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015656
15657 Can also be written that way :
15658
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015659 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015660
15661It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
15662to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
15663simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
15664sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
15665good use is the following :
15666
15667 With named ACLs :
15668
15669 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
15670 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
15671 monitor fail if site_dead
15672
15673 With anonymous ACLs :
15674
15675 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
15676
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015677See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
15678keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015679
15680
156817.3. Fetching samples
15682---------------------
15683
15684Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
15685against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
15686sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
15687ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
15688of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
15689available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
15690
15691This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
15692Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
15693compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
15694deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
15695
15696The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
15697matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
15698method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
15699indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
15700
15701As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
15702when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
15703mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
15704the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
15705ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
15706
15707Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
15708multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
15709when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015710incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
15711are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015712is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
15713all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
15714
15715Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
15716 - name
15717 - name(arg1)
15718 - name(arg1,arg2)
15719
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015720
157217.3.1. Converters
15722-----------------
15723
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015724Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
15725of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
15726is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
15727was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015728has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015729unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
15730
15731These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
15732sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
15733the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015734support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015735
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015736A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
15737support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
15738supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
15739(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
15740bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
15741
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015742The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015743
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001574451d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
15745 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
15746 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
15747 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
15748 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
15749 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
15750
15751 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015752 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
15753 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000015754 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
15755 frontend http-in
15756 bind *:8081
15757 default_backend servers
15758 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
15759 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
15760
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015761add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015762 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015763 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015764 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
15765 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015766 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015767 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15768 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15769 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15770 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015771 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015772 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015773
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010015774aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
15775 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
15776 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
15777 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
15778 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
15779 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
15780 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
15781
15782 Example:
15783 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
15784 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
15785
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015786and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015787 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015788 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015789 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
15790 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015791 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015792 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15793 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15794 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15795 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015796 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015797 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015798
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020015799b64dec
15800 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
15801 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020015802 For base64url("URL and Filename Safe Alphabet" (RFC 4648)) variant
15803 see "ub64dec".
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020015804
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020015805base64
15806 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015807 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020015808 an SSL ID can be copied in a header). For base64url("URL and Filename
15809 Safe Alphabet" (RFC 4648)) variant see "ub64enc".
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020015810
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015811bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015812 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015813 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015814 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015815 presence of a flag).
15816
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010015817bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
15818 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
15819 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010015820 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010015821
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010015822concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
15823 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
15824 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
15825 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
15826 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
15827 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
15828 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
15829 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
15830 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
15831 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
15832 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015833 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. If commas or closing
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040015834 parenthesis are needed as delimiters, they must be protected by quotes or
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015835 backslashes, themselves protected so that they are not stripped by the first
15836 level parser. See examples below.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010015837
15838 Example:
15839 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
15840 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
15841 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015842 tcp-request session set-var(txn.ipport) "str(),concat('addr=(',sess.ip),concat(',',sess.port,')')"
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010015843 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
15844
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015845cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015846 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
15847 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015848
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010015849crc32([<avalanche>])
15850 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
15851 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15852 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15853 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
15854 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
15855 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
15856 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
15857 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
15858 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
15859 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010015860 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
15861
15862crc32c([<avalanche>])
15863 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
15864 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15865 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15866 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
15867 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
15868 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
15869 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
15870 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010015871
Christopher Fauletea159d62020-04-01 16:21:44 +020015872cut_crlf
15873 Cuts the string representation of the input sample on the first carriage
15874 return ('\r') or newline ('\n') character found. Only the string length is
15875 updated.
15876
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010015877da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020015878 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
15879 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
15880 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
15881 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000015882 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020015883 configuration language.
15884
15885 Example:
15886 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020015887 bind *:8881
15888 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000015889 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020015890
Willy Tarreau0851fd52019-12-17 10:07:25 +010015891debug([<prefix][,<destination>])
15892 This converter is used as debug tool. It takes a capture of the input sample
15893 and sends it to event sink <destination>, which may designate a ring buffer
15894 such as "buf0", as well as "stdout", or "stderr". Available sinks may be
15895 checked at run time by issuing "show events" on the CLI. When not specified,
15896 the output will be "buf0", which may be consulted via the CLI's "show events"
15897 command. An optional prefix <prefix> may be passed to help distinguish
15898 outputs from multiple expressions. It will then appear before the colon in
15899 the output message. The input sample is passed as-is on the output, so that
15900 it is safe to insert the debug converter anywhere in a chain, even with non-
15901 printable sample types.
15902
15903 Example:
15904 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src,debug(track-sc)
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020015905
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020015906digest(<algorithm>)
15907 Converts a binary input sample to a message digest. The result is a binary
15908 sample. The <algorithm> must be an OpenSSL message digest name (e.g. sha256).
15909
15910 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
15911 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
15912
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015913div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015914 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
15915 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015916 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015917 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
15918 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015919 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015920 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15921 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15922 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15923 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015924 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015925 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015926
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015927djb2([<avalanche>])
15928 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
15929 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15930 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15931 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
15932 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
15933 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
15934 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010015935 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
15936 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015937
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015938even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015939 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015940 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
15941
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020015942field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
15943 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
15944 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
15945 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
15946 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
15947 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
15948 fields.
15949
15950 Example :
15951 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
15952 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
15953 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
15954 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
15955 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010015956
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020015957fix_is_valid
15958 Parses a binary payload and performs sanity checks regarding FIX (Financial
15959 Information eXchange):
15960
15961 - checks that all tag IDs and values are not empty and the tags IDs are well
15962 numeric
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050015963 - checks the BeginString tag is the first tag with a valid FIX version
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020015964 - checks the BodyLength tag is the second one with the right body length
Christopher Fauleted4bef72021-03-18 17:40:56 +010015965 - checks the MsgType tag is the third tag.
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020015966 - checks that last tag in the message is the CheckSum tag with a valid
15967 checksum
15968
15969 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
15970 the server can be parsed.
15971
15972 This converter returns a boolean, true if the payload contains a valid FIX
15973 message, false if not.
15974
15975 See also the fix_tag_value converter.
15976
15977 Example:
15978 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
15979 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
15980
15981fix_tag_value(<tag>)
15982 Parses a FIX (Financial Information eXchange) message and extracts the value
15983 from the tag <tag>. <tag> can be a string or an integer pointing to the
15984 desired tag. Any integer value is accepted, but only the following strings
15985 are translated into their integer equivalent: BeginString, BodyLength,
Daniel Corbettbefef702021-03-09 23:00:34 -050015986 MsgType, SenderCompID, TargetCompID, CheckSum. More tag names can be easily
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020015987 added.
15988
15989 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
15990 the server can be parsed. No message validation is performed by this
15991 converter. It is highly recommended to validate the message first using
15992 fix_is_valid converter.
15993
15994 See also the fix_is_valid converter.
15995
15996 Example:
15997 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
15998 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
15999 # MsgType tag ID is 35, so both lines below will return the same content
16000 tcp-request content set-var(txn.foo) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(35)
16001 tcp-request content set-var(txn.bar) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(MsgType)
16002
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016003hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016004 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016005 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016006 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016007 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010016008
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020016009hex2i
16010 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016011 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020016012
Christopher Faulet4ccc12f2020-04-01 09:08:32 +020016013htonl
16014 Converts the input integer value to its 32-bit binary representation in the
16015 network byte order. Because sample fetches own signed 64-bit integer, when
16016 this converter is used, the input integer value is first casted to an
16017 unsigned 32-bit integer.
16018
Tim Duesterhusa3082092021-01-21 17:40:49 +010016019hmac(<algorithm>,<key>)
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016020 Converts a binary input sample to a message authentication code with the given
16021 key. The result is a binary sample. The <algorithm> must be one of the
16022 registered OpenSSL message digest names (e.g. sha256). The <key> parameter must
16023 be base64 encoded and can either be a string or a variable.
16024
16025 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
16026 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16027
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010016028http_date([<offset],[<unit>])
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016029 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
16030 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000016031 an offset value is specified, then it is added to the date before the
16032 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit Date header fields,
16033 Expires values in responses when combined with a positive offset, or
16034 Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
16035 If a unit value is specified, then consider the timestamp as either
16036 "s" for seconds (default behavior), "ms" for milliseconds, or "us" for
16037 microseconds since epoch. Offset is assumed to have the same unit as
16038 input timestamp.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016039
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020016040iif(<true>,<false>)
16041 Returns the <true> string if the input value is true. Returns the <false>
16042 string otherwise.
16043
16044 Example:
Tim Duesterhus870713b2020-09-11 17:13:12 +020016045 http-request set-header x-forwarded-proto %[ssl_fc,iif(https,http)]
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020016046
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016047in_table(<table>)
16048 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16049 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
16050 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016051 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016052 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
16053
Tim Duesterhusa3082092021-01-21 17:40:49 +010016054ipmask(<mask4>,[<mask6>])
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010016055 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016056 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010016057 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
16058 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
16059 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
16060 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
16061 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016062
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016063json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016064 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016065 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020016066 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016067 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
16068 of errors:
16069 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
16070 bytes, ...)
16071 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
16072 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
16073
16074 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
16075 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
16076 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
16077 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
16078 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
16079 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016080 - "ascii" : never fails;
16081 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
16082 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016083 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016084 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016085 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
16086 characters corresponding to the other errors.
16087
16088 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016089 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016090
16091 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016092 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020016093 capture request header user-agent len 150
16094 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016095
16096 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
16097 GET / HTTP/1.0
16098 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
16099
16100 Output log:
16101 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
16102
Alex51c8ad42021-04-15 16:45:15 +020016103json_query(<json_path>,[<output_type>])
16104 The json_query converter supports the JSON types string, boolean and
16105 number. Floating point numbers will be returned as a string. By
16106 specifying the output_type 'int' the value will be converted to an
16107 Integer. If conversion is not possible the json_query converter fails.
16108
16109 <json_path> must be a valid JSON Path string as defined in
16110 https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/draft-ietf-jsonpath-base/
16111
16112 Example:
16113 # get a integer value from the request body
16114 # "{"integer":4}" => 5
16115 http-request set-var(txn.pay_int) req.body,json_query('$.integer','int'),add(1)
16116
16117 # get a key with '.' in the name
16118 # {"my.key":"myvalue"} => myvalue
16119 http-request set-var(txn.pay_mykey) req.body,json_query('$.my\\.key')
16120
16121 # {"boolean-false":false} => 0
16122 http-request set-var(txn.pay_boolean_false) req.body,json_query('$.boolean-false')
16123
16124 # get the value of the key 'iss' from a JWT Bearer token
16125 http-request set-var(txn.token_payload) req.hdr(Authorization),word(2,.),ub64dec,json_query('$.iss')
16126
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016127language(<value>[,<default>])
16128 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
16129 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
16130 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
16131 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
16132 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
16133 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
16134 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
16135 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
16136 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016137 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016138 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
16139 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016140
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016141 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016142
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016143 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
16144 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016145
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016146 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
16147 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
16148 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
16149 use_backend spanish if es
16150 use_backend french if fr
16151 use_backend english if en
16152 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016153
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010016154length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010016155 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
16156 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
16157 type. The result is of type integer.
16158
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016159lower
16160 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
16161 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
16162 type. The result is of type string.
16163
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016164ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
16165 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
16166 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
16167 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
16168 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
16169 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
16170 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
16171
16172 Example :
16173
16174 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016175 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016176 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
16177
Christopher Faulet51fc9d12020-04-01 17:24:41 +020016178ltrim(<chars>)
16179 Skips any characters from <chars> from the beginning of the string
16180 representation of the input sample.
16181
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016182map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
16183map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
16184map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
16185 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
16186 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
16187 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
16188 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
16189 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
16190 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
16191 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
16192 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016193
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016194 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
16195 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
16196 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016197
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016198 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016199 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016200
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016201 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
16202 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16203 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
16204 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020016205 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
16206 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016207 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
16208 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16209 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
16210 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16211 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
16212 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16213 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
16214 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080016215 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
16216 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16217 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016218 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16219 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
16220 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16221 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
16222 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016223
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010016224 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
16225 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
16226 the corresponding match text.
16227
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016228 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
16229 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
16230 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
16231 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
16232 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016233
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016234 Example :
16235
16236 # this is a comment and is ignored
16237 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
16238 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
16239 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
16240 | | | `---------- value
16241 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
16242 | `---------------------------- key
16243 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
16244
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016245mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016246 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
16247 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016248 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016249 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016250 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016251 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16252 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16253 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16254 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016255 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016256 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016257
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010016258mqtt_field_value(<packettype>,<fieldname or property ID>)
16259 Returns value of <fieldname> found in input MQTT payload of type
16260 <packettype>.
16261 <packettype> can be either a string (case insensitive matching) or a numeric
16262 value corresponding to the type of packet we're supposed to extract data
16263 from.
16264 Supported string and integers can be found here:
16265 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v3.1.1/os/mqtt-v3.1.1-os.html#_Toc398718021
16266 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901022
16267
16268 <fieldname> depends on <packettype> and can be any of the following below.
16269 (note that <fieldname> matching is case insensitive).
16270 <property id> can only be found in MQTT v5.0 streams. check this table:
16271 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901029
16272
16273 - CONNECT (or 1): flags, protocol_name, protocol_version, client_identifier,
16274 will_topic, will_payload, username, password, keepalive
16275 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
16276 packets only):
16277 17: Session Expiry Interval
16278 33: Receive Maximum
16279 39: Maximum Packet Size
16280 34: Topic Alias Maximum
16281 25: Request Response Information
16282 23: Request Problem Information
16283 21: Authentication Method
16284 22: Authentication Data
16285 18: Will Delay Interval
16286 1: Payload Format Indicator
16287 2: Message Expiry Interval
16288 3: Content Type
16289 8: Response Topic
16290 9: Correlation Data
16291 Not supported yet:
16292 38: User Property
16293
16294 - CONNACK (or 2): flags, protocol_version, reason_code
16295 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
16296 packets only):
16297 17: Session Expiry Interval
16298 33: Receive Maximum
16299 36: Maximum QoS
16300 37: Retain Available
16301 39: Maximum Packet Size
16302 18: Assigned Client Identifier
16303 34: Topic Alias Maximum
16304 31: Reason String
16305 40; Wildcard Subscription Available
16306 41: Subscription Identifiers Available
16307 42: Shared Subscription Available
16308 19: Server Keep Alive
16309 26: Response Information
16310 28: Server Reference
16311 21: Authentication Method
16312 22: Authentication Data
16313 Not supported yet:
16314 38: User Property
16315
16316 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16317 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
16318 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
16319 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
16320
16321 Example:
16322
16323 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
16324 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
16325 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(connect,protocol_name) \
16326 if data_in_buffer
16327 # do the same as above
16328 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
16329 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(1,protocol_name) \
16330 if data_in_buffer
16331
16332mqtt_is_valid
16333 Checks that the binary input is a valid MQTT packet. It returns a boolean.
16334
16335 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16336 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
16337 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
16338 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
16339
16340 Example:
16341
16342 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
16343 tcp-request content reject unless req.payload(0,0),mqtt_is_valid
16344
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016345mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016346 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020016347 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
16348 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016349 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016350 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016351 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016352 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16353 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16354 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16355 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016356 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016357 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016358
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010016359nbsrv
16360 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
16361 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
16362 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
16363 map lookup.
16364
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016365neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016366 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
16367 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
16368 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
16369 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016370
16371not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016372 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016373 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016374 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016375 absence of a flag).
16376
16377odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016378 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016379 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
16380
16381or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016382 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016383 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016384 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
16385 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016386 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016387 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16388 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16389 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16390 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016391 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016392 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016393
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010016394protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
16395 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
16396 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
16397 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
16398 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
16399 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
16400 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
16401 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
16402 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
16403 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
16404 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
16405 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
16406
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010016407regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016408 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
16409 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
16410 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
16411 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
16412 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
16413 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
16414 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
16415 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
16416 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016417 The first use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence
16418 of characters with other ones.
16419
16420 It is highly recommended to enclose the regex part using protected quotes to
16421 improve clarity and never have a closing parenthesis from the regex mixed up
16422 with the parenthesis from the function. Just like in Bourne shell, the first
16423 level of quotes is processed when delimiting word groups on the line, a
16424 second level is usable for argument. It is recommended to use single quotes
16425 outside since these ones do not try to resolve backslashes nor dollar signs.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016426
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010016427 Examples:
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016428
16429 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
16430 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
16431 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016432 http-request set-header x-path "%[hdr(x-path),regsub('/+','/','g')]"
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016433
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010016434 # copy query string to x-query and drop all leading '?', ';' and '&'
16435 http-request set-header x-query "%[query,regsub([?;&]*,'')]"
16436
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010016437 # capture groups and backreferences
16438 # both lines do the same.
Willy Tarreau465dc7d2020-10-08 18:05:56 +020016439 http-request redirect location %[url,'regsub("(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?","\2\1",i)']
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010016440 http-request redirect location %[url,regsub(\"(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?\",\"\2\1\",i)]
16441
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020016442capture-req(<id>)
16443 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
16444 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
16445
16446 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020016447 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
16448 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020016449
16450capture-res(<id>)
16451 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
16452 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
16453
16454 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020016455 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
16456 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020016457
Christopher Faulet568415a2020-04-01 17:24:47 +020016458rtrim(<chars>)
16459 Skips any characters from <chars> from the end of the string representation
16460 of the input sample.
16461
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016462sdbm([<avalanche>])
16463 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
16464 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16465 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16466 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16467 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16468 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
16469 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016470 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
16471 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016472
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020016473secure_memcmp(<var>)
16474 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value. Both values are treated
16475 as a binary string. Returns a boolean indicating whether both binary strings
16476 match.
16477
16478 If both binary strings have the same length then the comparison will be
16479 performed in constant time.
16480
16481 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
16482 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16483
16484 Example :
16485
16486 http-request set-var(txn.token) hdr(token)
16487 # Check whether the token sent by the client matches the secret token
16488 # value, without leaking the contents using a timing attack.
16489 acl token_given str(my_secret_token),secure_memcmp(txn.token)
16490
Tim Duesterhusef4e45c2021-01-21 17:40:50 +010016491set-var(<var>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016492 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
16493 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
16494 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016495 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016496 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16497 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016498 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016499 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16500 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016501 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016502 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016503
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020016504sha1
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020016505 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA-1 digest. The result is a binary
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020016506 sample with length of 20 bytes.
16507
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020016508sha2([<bits>])
16509 Converts a binary input sample to a digest in the SHA-2 family. The result
16510 is a binary sample with length of <bits>/8 bytes.
16511
16512 Valid values for <bits> are 224, 256, 384, 512, each corresponding to
16513 SHA-<bits>. The default value is 256.
16514
16515 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
16516 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16517
Nenad Merdanovic177adc92019-08-27 01:58:13 +020016518srv_queue
16519 Takes an input value of type string, either a server name or <backend>/<server>
16520 format and returns the number of queued sessions on that server. Can be used
16521 in places where we want to look up queued sessions from a dynamic name, like a
16522 cookie value (e.g. req.cook(SRVID),srv_queue) and then make a decision to break
16523 persistence or direct a request elsewhere.
16524
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020016525strcmp(<var>)
16526 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
16527 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
16528 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
16529 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
16530 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
16531 shorter).
16532
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020016533 See also the secure_memcmp converter if you need to compare two binary
16534 strings in constant time.
16535
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020016536 Example :
16537
16538 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
16539 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
16540 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
16541
16542
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016543sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016544 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
16545 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016546 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016547 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
16548 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016549 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016550 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16551 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016552 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016553 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16554 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016555 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016556 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016557
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016558table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
16559 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16560 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16561 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
16562 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
16563 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
16564 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
16565
16566
16567table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
16568 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16569 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16570 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
16571 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
16572 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
16573 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
16574
16575table_conn_cnt(<table>)
16576 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16577 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016578 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016579 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
16580 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16581
16582table_conn_cur(<table>)
16583 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16584 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16585 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
16586 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
16587 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
16588
16589table_conn_rate(<table>)
16590 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16591 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16592 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
16593 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
16594 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
16595
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020016596table_gpt0(<table>)
16597 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16598 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
16599 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
16600 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
16601 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
16602
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016603table_gpc0(<table>)
16604 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16605 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16606 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
16607 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
16608 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
16609
16610table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
16611 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16612 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16613 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
16614 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
16615 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
16616 sample fetch keyword.
16617
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016618table_gpc1(<table>)
16619 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16620 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16621 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
16622 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
16623 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
16624
16625table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
16626 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16627 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16628 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
16629 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
16630 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
16631 sample fetch keyword.
16632
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016633table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
16634 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16635 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016636 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016637 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
16638 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16639
16640table_http_err_rate(<table>)
16641 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16642 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16643 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
16644 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
16645 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
16646 keyword.
16647
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010016648table_http_fail_cnt(<table>)
16649 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16650 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16651 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
16652 failures associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
16653 the sc_http_fail_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16654
16655table_http_fail_rate(<table>)
16656 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16657 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16658 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP failures associated with the
16659 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of failures over the
16660 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_fail_rate sample fetch
16661 keyword.
16662
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016663table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
16664 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16665 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016666 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016667 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
16668 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16669
16670table_http_req_rate(<table>)
16671 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16672 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16673 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
16674 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
16675 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
16676 keyword.
16677
16678table_kbytes_in(<table>)
16679 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16680 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016681 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016682 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
16683 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
16684 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
16685 keyword.
16686
16687table_kbytes_out(<table>)
16688 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16689 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016690 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016691 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
16692 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
16693 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
16694 keyword.
16695
16696table_server_id(<table>)
16697 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16698 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16699 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
16700 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
16701 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
16702 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
16703
16704table_sess_cnt(<table>)
16705 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16706 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016707 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016708 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
16709 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
16710 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
16711 keyword.
16712
16713table_sess_rate(<table>)
16714 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16715 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16716 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
16717 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
16718 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
16719 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
16720 keyword.
16721
16722table_trackers(<table>)
16723 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16724 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16725 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
16726 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
16727 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
16728 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
16729 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
16730 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
16731 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
16732 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
16733
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020016734ub64dec
16735 This converter is the base64url variant of b64dec converter. base64url
16736 encoding is the "URL and Filename Safe Alphabet" variant of base64 encoding.
16737 It is also the encoding used in JWT (JSON Web Token) standard.
16738
16739 Example:
16740 # Decoding a JWT payload:
16741 http-request set-var(txn.token_payload) req.hdr(Authorization),word(2,.),ub64dec
16742
16743ub64enc
16744 This converter is the base64url variant of base64 converter.
16745
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016746upper
16747 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
16748 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
16749 type. The result is of type string.
16750
Willy Tarreau62ba9ba2020-04-23 17:54:47 +020016751url_dec([<in_form>])
16752 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded version
16753 as output. The input and the output are of type string. If the <in_form>
16754 argument is set to a non-zero integer value, the input string is assumed to
16755 be part of a form or query string and the '+' character will be turned into a
16756 space (' '). Otherwise this will only happen after a question mark indicating
16757 a query string ('?').
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020016758
William Dauchy888b0ae2021-01-06 23:39:50 +010016759url_enc([<enc_type>])
16760 Takes a string provided as input and returns the encoded version as output.
16761 The input and the output are of type string. By default the type of encoding
16762 is meant for `query` type. There is no other type supported for now but the
16763 optional argument is here for future changes.
16764
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016765ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010016766 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010016767 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
16768 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
16769 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016770 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
16771 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
16772 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
16773 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010016774 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016775 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
16776 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010016777
16778 Example:
16779 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
16780 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
16781
16782 message Point {
16783 int32 latitude = 1;
16784 int32 longitude = 2;
16785 }
16786
16787 message PPoint {
16788 Point point = 59;
16789 }
16790
16791 message Rectangle {
16792 // One corner of the rectangle.
16793 PPoint lo = 48;
16794 // The other corner of the rectangle.
16795 PPoint hi = 49;
16796 }
16797
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020016798 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
16799 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
16800 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010016801
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016802 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
16803 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016804 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016805 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
16806
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020016807 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016808
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010016809 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016810
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020016811 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
16812 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
16813 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010016814
16815 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
16816 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
16817 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
16818
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020016819 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
16820 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
16821 interpret the previous binary sample.
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010016822
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010016823
Tim Duesterhusef4e45c2021-01-21 17:40:50 +010016824unset-var(<var>)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010016825 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
16826 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
16827 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
16828 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16829 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
16830 response),
16831 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16832 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
16833 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
16834 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
16835
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016836utime(<format>[,<offset>])
16837 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
16838 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
16839 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
16840 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
16841 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
16842 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
16843
16844 Example :
16845
16846 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016847 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016848 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
16849
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020016850word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
16851 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
16852 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
16853 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010016854 Delimiters at the beginning or end of the input string are ignored.
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020016855 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
16856 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
16857
16858 Example :
16859 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
16860 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
16861 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
16862 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
16863 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010016864 str(/f1/f2/f3/f4),word(1,/) # f1
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010016865
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016866wt6([<avalanche>])
16867 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
16868 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16869 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16870 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16871 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16872 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
16873 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016874 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
16875 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016876
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016877xor(<value>)
16878 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016879 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016880 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016881 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016882 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016883 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16884 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016885 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016886 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16887 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016888 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016889 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016890
Dragan Dosen04bf0cc2020-12-22 21:44:33 +010016891xxh3([<seed>])
16892 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the XXH3
16893 64-bit variant of the XXhash hash function. This hash supports a seed which
16894 defaults to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument.
16895 This hash is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash
16896 URLs and/or URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics
16897 with a low collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not
16898 considered as cryptographically secure.
16899
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010016900xxh32([<seed>])
16901 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
16902 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
16903 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
16904 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
16905 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
16906 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
16907 as cryptographically secure.
16908
16909xxh64([<seed>])
16910 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
16911 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
16912 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
16913 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
16914 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
16915 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
16916 as cryptographically secure.
16917
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016918
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200169197.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016920--------------------------------------------
16921
16922A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
16923not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
16924"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
16925The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
16926
16927always_false : boolean
16928 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
16929 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
16930
16931always_true : boolean
16932 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
16933 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
16934
16935avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016936 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016937 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
16938 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
16939 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
16940 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
16941 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
16942 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
16943 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
16944 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
16945 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
16946 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
16947 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
16948 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
16949 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010016950
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016951be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020016952 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
16953 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
16954 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
16955 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040016956 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
16957
16958be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
16959 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
16960 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
16961 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
16962 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
16963 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040016964 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
16965 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040016966
16967 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
16968 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
16969 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016970
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016971be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
16972 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
16973 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
16974 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016975 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016976 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
16977 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016978
16979 Example :
16980 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
16981 backend dynamic
16982 mode http
16983 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
16984 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016985
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016986bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020016987 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
16988 of the string.
16989
16990bool(<bool>) : bool
16991 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
16992 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
16993
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016994connslots([<backend>]) : integer
16995 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016996 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016997 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
16998 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050016999
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017000 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017001 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017002 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
17003
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017004 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
17005 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017006
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017007 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017008 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017009 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017010 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017011 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017012 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017013 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017014
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017015 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
17016 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017017 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017018 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017019
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017020cpu_calls : integer
17021 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
17022 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
17023 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
17024 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
17025 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
17026 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
17027
17028cpu_ns_avg : integer
17029 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
17030 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
17031 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
17032 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
17033 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
17034 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
17035 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
17036 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
17037 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
17038 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
17039 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
17040
17041cpu_ns_tot : integer
17042 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
17043 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
17044 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
17045 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
17046 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
17047 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
17048 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
17049 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
17050 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
17051 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
17052 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
17053 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
17054 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
17055
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010017056date([<offset>],[<unit>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020017057 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017058
17059 If an offset value is specified, then it is added to the current date before
17060 returning the value. This is particularly useful to compute relative dates,
17061 as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020017062 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
17063
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017064 <unit> is facultative, and can be set to "s" for seconds (default behavior),
17065 "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds.
17066 If unit is set, return value is an integer reflecting either seconds,
17067 milliseconds or microseconds since epoch, plus offset.
17068 It is useful when a time resolution of less than a second is needed.
17069
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020017070 Example :
17071
17072 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
17073 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020017074
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017075 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response, with
17076 # millisecond granularity
17077 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600000,ms),http_date(0,ms)]
17078
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010017079date_us : integer
17080 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
17081 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
17082 from the same timeval structure.
17083
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020017084distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
17085 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
17086 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
17087 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
17088 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
17089 haproxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
17090 list of supported tokens.
17091
17092distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
17093 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
17094 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
17095 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
17096 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
17097 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through haproxy.
17098 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
17099 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
17100 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
17101 supported tokens.
17102
17103 Example :
17104 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
17105 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
17106 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
17107 # send large files to the big farm
17108 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
17109
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020017110env(<name>) : string
17111 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
17112 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
17113 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
17114 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
17115 certain way.
17116
17117 Examples :
17118 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
17119 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
17120
17121 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
17122 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
17123
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017124fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
17125 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017126 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
17127 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017128 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
17129 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017130 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017131 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
17132 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017133
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020017134fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
17135 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
17136 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
17137 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
17138
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017139fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
17140 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
17141 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
17142 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
17143 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
17144 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
17145 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
17146 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
17147 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010017148
17149 Example :
17150 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
17151 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
17152 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
17153 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
17154 frontend mail
17155 bind :25
17156 mode tcp
17157 maxconn 100
17158 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
17159 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
17160 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
17161 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017162
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010017163hostname : string
17164 Returns the system hostname.
17165
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017166int(<integer>) : signed integer
17167 Returns a signed integer.
17168
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017169ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
17170 Returns an ipv4.
17171
17172ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
17173 Returns an ipv6.
17174
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017175lat_ns_avg : integer
17176 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
17177 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
17178 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
17179 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
17180 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
17181 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
17182 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
17183 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
17184 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020017185 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
17186 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
17187 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
17188 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
17189 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: this value is
17190 exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017191
17192lat_ns_tot : integer
17193 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
17194 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
17195 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
17196 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
17197 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
17198 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
17199 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
17200 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
17201 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020017202 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
17203 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
17204 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
17205 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
17206 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017207 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
17208 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
17209 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
17210 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
17211 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
17212 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
17213
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017214meth(<method>) : method
17215 Returns a method.
17216
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010017217nbproc : integer
17218 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
17219 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
17220 and debugging purposes.
17221
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017222nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
17223 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
17224 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
17225 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017226 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
17227 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
17228 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010017229
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040017230prio_class : integer
17231 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
17232 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
17233 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
17234
17235prio_offset : integer
17236 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
17237 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
17238 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
17239 set-priority-offset".
17240
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010017241proc : integer
17242 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
17243 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
17244 debugging purposes.
17245
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017246queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017247 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
17248 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
17249 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017250 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
17251 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
17252 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
17253 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
17254 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
17255
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010017256rand([<range>]) : integer
17257 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
17258 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
17259 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
17260 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
17261 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
17262
Luca Schimweg8a694b82019-09-10 15:42:52 +020017263uuid([<version>]) : string
17264 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
17265 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
17266 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
17267
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017268srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17269 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
17270 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
17271 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
17272 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
17273 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040017274 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
17275 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
17276
17277srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17278 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
17279 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
17280 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
17281 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
17282 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
17283 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
17284 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
17285
17286 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
17287 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017288
17289srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
17290 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
17291 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
17292 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017293 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017294 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
17295 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
17296 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
17297
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020017298srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17299 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
17300 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
17301 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
17302 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
17303 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
17304 fetch methods.
17305
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017306srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17307 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
17308 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017309 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017310 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
17311 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017312 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017313 overloading servers).
17314
17315 Example :
17316 # Redirect to a separate back
17317 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
17318 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
17319 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
17320
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020017321srv_iweight([<backend>/]<server>): integer
17322 Returns an integer corresponding to the server's initial weight. If <backend>
17323 is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. See also
17324 "srv_weight" and "srv_uweight".
17325
17326srv_uweight([<backend>/]<server>): integer
17327 Returns an integer corresponding to the user visible server's weight. If
17328 <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
17329 backend. See also "srv_weight" and "srv_iweight".
17330
17331srv_weight([<backend>/]<server>): integer
17332 Returns an integer corresponding to the current (or effective) server's
17333 weight. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
17334 backend. See also "srv_iweight" and "srv_uweight".
17335
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010017336stopping : boolean
17337 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
17338 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
17339 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
17340
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017341str(<string>) : string
17342 Returns a string.
17343
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017344table_avl([<table>]) : integer
17345 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
17346 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
17347
17348table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17349 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
17350 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
17351 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
17352
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010017353thread : integer
17354 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
17355 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
17356 and debugging purposes.
17357
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017358var(<var-name>) : undefined
17359 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017360 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
17361 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017362 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017363 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17364 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017365 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017366 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17367 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017368 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017369 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017370
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200173717.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017372----------------------------------
17373
17374The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
17375closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
17376methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
17377sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
17378TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017379the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
17380counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020017381"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
17382used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
17383can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
17384Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
17385table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
17386tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
17387currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017388
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017389bc_dst : ip
17390 This is the destination ip address of the connection on the server side,
17391 which is the server address HAProxy connected to. It is of type IP and works
17392 on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its
17393 IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291.
17394
17395bc_dst_port : integer
17396 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
17397 connection on the server side, which is the port HAproxy connected to.
17398
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010017399bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010017400 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
17401 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
17402 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
17403
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017404bc_src : ip
17405 This is the source ip address of the connection on the server side, which is
17406 the server address haproxy connected from. It is of type IP and works on both
17407 IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are mapped to their IPv6
17408 equivalent, according to RFC 4291.
17409
17410bc_src_port : integer
17411 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
17412 connection on the server side, which is the port HAproxy connected from.
17413
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017414be_id : integer
17415 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020017416 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
17417 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017418
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010017419be_name : string
17420 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020017421 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
17422 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010017423
Amaury Denoyelled91d7792020-12-10 13:43:56 +010017424be_server_timeout : integer
17425 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the server timeout of the
17426 current backend. This timeout can be overwritten by a "set-timeout" rule. See
17427 also the "cur_server_timeout".
17428
17429be_tunnel_timeout : integer
17430 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the tunnel timeout of the
17431 current backend. This timeout can be overwritten by a "set-timeout" rule. See
17432 also the "cur_tunnel_timeout".
17433
Amaury Denoyellef7719a22020-12-10 13:43:58 +010017434cur_server_timeout : integer
17435 Returns the currently applied server timeout in millisecond for the stream.
17436 In the default case, this will be equal to be_server_timeout unless a
17437 "set-timeout" rule has been applied. See also "be_server_timeout".
17438
17439cur_tunnel_timeout : integer
17440 Returns the currently applied tunnel timeout in millisecond for the stream.
17441 In the default case, this will be equal to be_tunnel_timeout unless a
17442 "set-timeout" rule has been applied. See also "be_tunnel_timeout".
17443
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017444dst : ip
17445 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
17446 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
17447 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
17448 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010017449 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
17450 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
17451 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
17452 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
17453 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
17454 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017455
17456dst_conn : integer
17457 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
17458 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
17459 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
17460 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
17461 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
17462 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
17463 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
17464 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017465
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020017466dst_is_local : boolean
17467 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
17468 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
17469 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
17470 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017471 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020017472 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
17473 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
17474 it only once per connection.
17475
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017476dst_port : integer
17477 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
17478 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
17479 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
17480 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
17481 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
17482 an HTTP header.
17483
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020017484fc_http_major : integer
17485 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
17486 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
17487 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
17488
Geoff Simmons7185b782019-08-27 18:31:16 +020017489fc_pp_authority : string
17490 Returns the authority TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
17491 if any.
17492
Tim Duesterhusd1b15b62020-03-13 12:34:23 +010017493fc_pp_unique_id : string
17494 Returns the unique ID TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
17495 if any.
17496
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010017497fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
17498 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
17499 header.
17500
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020017501fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
17502 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
17503 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
17504 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
17505 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
17506 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
17507 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17508
17509fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
17510 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
17511 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
17512 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
17513 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
17514 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
17515 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17516
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017517fc_unacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017518 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
17519 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
17520 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
17521 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17522
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017523fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017524 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
17525 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
17526 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
17527 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17528
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017529fc_retrans : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017530 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
17531 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17532 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17533 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17534
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017535fc_fackets : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017536 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
17537 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17538 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17539 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17540
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017541fc_lost : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017542 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
17543 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17544 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17545 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17546
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017547fc_reordering : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017548 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
17549 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17550 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17551 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17552
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020017553fe_defbe : string
17554 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
17555 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
17556
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017557fe_id : integer
17558 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010017559 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017560 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
17561
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010017562fe_name : string
17563 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
17564 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
17565 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
17566
Amaury Denoyelleda184d52020-12-10 13:43:55 +010017567fe_client_timeout : integer
17568 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the client timeout of the
17569 current frontend.
17570
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017571sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017572sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
17573sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
17574sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017575 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
17576 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
17577 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
17578
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017579sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017580sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
17581sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
17582sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017583 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
17584 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
17585 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
17586
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017587sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017588sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17589sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17590sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017591 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
17592 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010017593 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
17594 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
17595 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017596
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017597 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017598 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
17599 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020017600 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
17601 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
17602 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017603 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
17604 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
17605
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017606sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17607sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17608sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17609sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17610 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
17611 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
17612 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
17613 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
17614 when a first ACL was verified.
17615
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017616sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017617sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17618sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17619sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017620 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017621 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
17622
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017623sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017624sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
17625sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
17626sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017627 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
17628 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
17629 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
17630
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017631sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017632sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
17633sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
17634sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017635 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
17636 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
17637 See also src_conn_rate.
17638
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017639sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017640sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17641sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17642sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017643 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017644 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020017645
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017646sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17647sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17648sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17649sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17650 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
17651 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
17652
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020017653sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17654sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
17655sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
17656sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
17657 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
17658 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
17659
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017660sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017661sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
17662sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
17663sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020017664 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
17665 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
17666 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017667 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
17668 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
17669 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017670
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017671sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17672sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
17673sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
17674sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
17675 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
17676 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
17677 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
17678 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
17679 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
17680 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
17681
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017682sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017683sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17684sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17685sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017686 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017687 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
17688 See also src_http_err_cnt.
17689
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017690sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017691sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
17692sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
17693sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017694 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
17695 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
17696 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
17697 src_http_err_rate.
17698
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010017699sc_http_fail_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17700sc0_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17701sc1_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17702sc2_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17703 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP response failures from the currently
17704 tracked counters. This includes the both response errors and 5xx status codes
17705 other than 501 and 505. See also src_http_fail_cnt.
17706
17707sc_http_fail_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17708sc0_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
17709sc1_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
17710sc2_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
17711 Returns the average rate of HTTP response failures from the currently tracked
17712 counters, measured in amount of failures over the period configured in the
17713 table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx status codes other than
17714 501 and 505. See also src_http_fail_rate.
17715
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017716sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017717sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17718sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17719sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017720 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017721 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
17722 src_http_req_cnt.
17723
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017724sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017725sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
17726sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
17727sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017728 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
17729 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
17730 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
17731 src_http_req_rate.
17732
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017733sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017734sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17735sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17736sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017737 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010017738 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
17739 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
17740 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
17741 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017742
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017743 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020017744 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
17745 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017746 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
17747
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017748sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17749sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17750sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17751sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17752 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
17753 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
17754 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
17755 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
17756 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
17757
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017758sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017759sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
17760sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
17761sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020017762 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
17763 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
17764 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017765
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017766sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017767sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
17768sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
17769sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020017770 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
17771 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
17772 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017773
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017774sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017775sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17776sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17777sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017778 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017779 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
17780 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
17781 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017782 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017783 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
17784
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017785sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017786sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
17787sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
17788sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017789 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
17790 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
17791 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
17792 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
17793 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017794 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017795
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017796sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017797sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
17798sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
17799sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020017800 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
17801 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
17802 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
17803
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017804sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017805sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
17806sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
17807sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010017808 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
17809 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020017810 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010017811 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
17812 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017813 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
17814 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
17815 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010017816
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017817so_id : integer
17818 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
17819 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
17820 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017821
Jerome Magnineb421b22020-03-27 22:08:40 +010017822so_name : string
17823 Returns a string containing the current listening socket's name, as defined
17824 with name on a "bind" line. It can serve the same purposes as so_id but with
17825 strings instead of integers.
17826
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017827src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017828 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017829 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
17830 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
17831 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017832 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
17833 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
17834 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010017835 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
17836 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
17837 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
17838 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
17839 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
17840 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
17841 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017842
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010017843 Example:
17844 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
17845 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
17846
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017847src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
17848 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
17849 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
17850 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017851 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017852
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017853src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
17854 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
17855 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017856 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017857 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017858
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017859src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17860 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
17861 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
17862 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
17863 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
17864 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
17865 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017866
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017867 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017868 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
17869 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
17870 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
17871 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010017872 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017873 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
17874 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
17875
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017876src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17877 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
17878 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
17879 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
17880 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
17881 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
17882 was verified.
17883
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017884src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017885 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017886 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017887 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017888 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017889
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017890src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017891 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017892 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
17893 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017894 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017895
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017896src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
17897 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
17898 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
17899 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017900 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017901
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017902src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017903 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017904 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017905 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017906 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017907
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017908src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17909 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
17910 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
17911 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
17912 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
17913
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020017914src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
17915 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
17916 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
17917 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
17918 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
17919
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017920src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020017921 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017922 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020017923 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
17924 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017925 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
17926 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
17927 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020017928
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017929src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
17930 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
17931 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
17932 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
17933 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
17934 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
17935 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
17936 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
17937
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017938src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017939 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017940 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017941 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017942 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017943 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017944
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017945src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
17946 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
17947 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
17948 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
17949 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017950 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017951
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010017952src_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17953 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP response failures triggered by the
17954 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Ilya Shipitsin0de36ad2021-02-20 00:23:36 +050017955 the designated stick-table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010017956 status codes other than 501 and 505. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_fail_cnt.
17957 If the address is not found, zero is returned.
17958
17959src_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
17960 Returns the average rate of HTTP response failures triggered by the incoming
17961 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
17962 designated stick-table, measured in amount of failures over the period
17963 configured in the table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx
17964 status codes other than 501 and 505. If the address is not found, zero is
17965 returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_fail_rate.
17966
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017967src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017968 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017969 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
17970 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017971 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017972
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017973src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
17974 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
17975 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
17976 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017977 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017978 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017979
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017980src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17981 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
17982 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
17983 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020017984 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017985 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
17986 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017987
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017988 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017989 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010017990 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017991 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017992
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017993src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17994 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
17995 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
17996 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
17997 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
17998 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
17999 connection when a first ACL was verified.
18000
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020018001src_is_local : boolean
18002 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
18003 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
18004 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
18005 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018006 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020018007 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
18008 once per connection.
18009
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018010src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018011 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
18012 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
18013 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
18014 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
18015 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018016
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018017src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018018 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
18019 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18020 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
18021 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
18022 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020018023
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018024src_port : integer
18025 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
18026 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
18027 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
18028 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010018029
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018030src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018031 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018032 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18033 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
18034 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018035 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018036
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018037src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
18038 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
18039 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18040 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
18041 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018042 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018043
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018044src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18045 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
18046 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
18047 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
18048 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
18049 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
18050 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
18051 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
18052 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020018053
18054 Example :
18055 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
18056 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
18057 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
18058 listen ssh
18059 bind :22
18060 mode tcp
18061 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018062 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018063 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020018064 server local 127.0.0.1:22
18065
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018066srv_id : integer
18067 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
18068 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020018069 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020018070
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080018071srv_name : string
18072 Returns a string containing the server's name when processing the response.
18073 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020018074 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080018075
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200180767.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018077----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020018078
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018079The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
18080closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
18081when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
18082usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018083future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020018084
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001808551d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
18086 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
18087 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
18088 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
18089 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
18090 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
18091
18092 Example :
18093 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
18094 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
18095 # the request.
18096 frontend http-in
18097 bind *:8081
18098 default_backend servers
18099 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
18100 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
18101
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018102ssl_bc : boolean
18103 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
18104 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018105 other a server with the "ssl" option. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
18106 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018107
18108ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
18109 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018110 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
18111 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018112
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018113ssl_bc_alpn : string
18114 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
18115 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020018116 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018117 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
18118 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
18119 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
18120 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
18121 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018122 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn". It can be used in a
18123 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018124
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018125ssl_bc_cipher : string
18126 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018127 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
18128 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018129
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018130ssl_bc_client_random : binary
18131 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
18132 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18133 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018134 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018135
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010018136ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
18137 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18138 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018139 session or a TLS ticket. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
18140 ruleset.
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010018141
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018142ssl_bc_npn : string
18143 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
18144 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020018145 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018146 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
18147 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
18148 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
18149 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018150 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN. It can be used in a tcp-check
18151 or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018152
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018153ssl_bc_protocol : string
18154 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018155 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
18156 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018157
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018158ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018159 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018160 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018161 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64". It
18162 can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018163
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018164ssl_bc_server_random : binary
18165 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
18166 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18167 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018168 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018169
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018170ssl_bc_session_id : binary
18171 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
18172 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018173 if session was reused or not. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
18174 ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018175
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040018176ssl_bc_session_key : binary
18177 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
18178 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
18179 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018180 BoringSSL. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040018181
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018182ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
18183 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018184 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
18185 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018186
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018187ssl_c_ca_err : integer
18188 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18189 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
18190 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
18191 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
18192 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020018193
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018194ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
18195 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18196 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
18197 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
18198 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018199
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010018200ssl_c_chain_der : binary
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018201 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the client when the
18202 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18203 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050018204 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currently
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018205 does not support resumed sessions.
18206
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010018207ssl_c_der : binary
18208 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
18209 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18210 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18211
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018212ssl_c_err : integer
18213 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18214 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
18215 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
18216 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
18217 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018218
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018219ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018220 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18221 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
18222 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18223 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18224 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18225 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18226 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18227 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018228 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18229 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18230 LDAP v3.
18231 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18232 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018233
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018234ssl_c_key_alg : string
18235 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
18236 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18237 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018238
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018239ssl_c_notafter : string
18240 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
18241 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18242 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020018243
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018244ssl_c_notbefore : string
18245 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
18246 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18247 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010018248
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018249ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018250 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18251 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
18252 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18253 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18254 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18255 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18256 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18257 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018258 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18259 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18260 LDAP v3.
18261 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18262 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010018263
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018264ssl_c_serial : binary
18265 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
18266 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18267 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018268
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018269ssl_c_sha1 : binary
18270 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
18271 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
18272 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020018273 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
18274 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
18275
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018276 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020018277 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018278
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018279ssl_c_sig_alg : string
18280 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
18281 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18282 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018283
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018284ssl_c_used : boolean
18285 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
18286 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020018287
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018288ssl_c_verify : integer
18289 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
18290 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
18291 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
18292 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020018293
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018294ssl_c_version : integer
18295 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
18296 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020018297
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010018298ssl_f_der : binary
18299 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
18300 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18301 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18302
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018303ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018304 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18305 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
18306 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18307 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018308 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018309 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18310 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18311 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018312 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18313 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18314 LDAP v3.
18315 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18316 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018317
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018318ssl_f_key_alg : string
18319 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
18320 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
18321 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020018322
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018323ssl_f_notafter : string
18324 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
18325 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18326 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018327
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018328ssl_f_notbefore : string
18329 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
18330 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18331 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018332
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018333ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018334 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18335 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
18336 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18337 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18338 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18339 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18340 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18341 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018342 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18343 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18344 LDAP v3.
18345 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18346 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020018347
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018348ssl_f_serial : binary
18349 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
18350 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18351 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018352
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020018353ssl_f_sha1 : binary
18354 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
18355 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
18356 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
18357
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018358ssl_f_sig_alg : string
18359 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
18360 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18361 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020018362
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018363ssl_f_version : integer
18364 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
18365 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
18366
18367ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018368 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
18369 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
18370 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
18371
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018372 Example :
18373 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
18374 listen http-https
18375 bind :80
18376 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
18377 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
18378
18379ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
18380 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
18381 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
18382
18383ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018384 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018385 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
18386 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
18387 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
18388 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
18389 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
18390 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
18391 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
18392 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
18393
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018394ssl_fc_cipher : string
18395 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
18396 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020018397
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018398ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
18399 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
18400 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010018401 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018402
18403ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
18404 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
18405 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010018406 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018407
18408ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
18409 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
18410 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
18411 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018412 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020018413 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018414
18415ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
18416 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
18417 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010018418 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018419
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018420ssl_fc_client_random : binary
18421 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
18422 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18423 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
18424
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020018425ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret : string
18426 Return the CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18427 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18428 transport layer.
18429 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18430 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18431 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18432 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18433
18434ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret : string
18435 Return the CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18436 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18437 transport layer.
18438 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18439 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18440 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18441 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18442
18443ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0 : string
18444 Return the CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
18445 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18446 transport layer.
18447 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18448 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18449 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18450 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18451
18452ssl_fc_exporter_secret : string
18453 Return the EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18454 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18455 transport layer.
18456 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18457 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18458 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18459 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18460
18461ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret : string
18462 Return the EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18463 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
18464 transport layer.
18465 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18466 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18467 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18468 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18469
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018470ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018471 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
18472 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010018473 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
18474 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
18475 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
18476 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018477
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020018478ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
18479 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
18480 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
18481 wait until the handshake happened.
18482
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018483ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
18484 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020018485 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
18486 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018487 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020018488 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020018489
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020018490ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020018491 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010018492 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
18493 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020018494
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018495ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018496 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018497 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
18498 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
18499 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
18500 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
18501 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
18502 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
18503 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020018504
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018505ssl_fc_protocol : string
18506 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
18507 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020018508
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018509ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040018510 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018511 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
18512 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040018513
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020018514ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret : string
18515 Return the SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18516 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18517 transport layer.
18518 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18519 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18520 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18521 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18522
18523ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0 : string
18524 Return the SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
18525 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
18526 transport layer.
18527 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18528 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18529 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18530 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18531
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018532ssl_fc_server_random : binary
18533 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
18534 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18535 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
18536
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018537ssl_fc_session_id : binary
18538 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
18539 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
18540 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
18541 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020018542
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040018543ssl_fc_session_key : binary
18544 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
18545 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
18546 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
18547 BoringSSL.
18548
18549
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018550ssl_fc_sni : string
18551 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
18552 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
18553 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
18554 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
18555 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
18556
18557 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
18558 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
18559 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018560 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020018561 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018562
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018563 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018564 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
18565 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020018566
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018567ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
18568 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
18569 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020018570
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020018571ssl_s_der : binary
18572 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the server when the
18573 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18574 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18575
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018576ssl_s_chain_der : binary
18577 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the server when the
18578 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18579 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050018580 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currently
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018581 does not support resumed sessions.
18582
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020018583ssl_s_key_alg : string
18584 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
18585 presented by the server when the outgoing connection was made over an
18586 SSL/TLS transport layer.
18587
18588ssl_s_notafter : string
18589 Returns the end date presented by the server as a formatted string
18590 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18591 transport layer.
18592
18593ssl_s_notbefore : string
18594 Returns the start date presented by the server as a formatted string
18595 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18596 transport layer.
18597
18598ssl_s_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
18599 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18600 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
18601 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18602 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18603 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18604 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020018605 For instance, "ssl_s_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18606 "ssl_s_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020018607 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18608 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18609 LDAP v3.
18610 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18611 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
18612
18613ssl_s_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
18614 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18615 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
18616 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18617 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18618 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18619 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020018620 For instance, "ssl_s_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18621 "ssl_s_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020018622 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18623 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18624 LDAP v3.
18625 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18626 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
18627
18628ssl_s_serial : binary
18629 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the server when the
18630 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18631 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18632
18633ssl_s_sha1 : binary
18634 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the server
18635 when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
18636 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
18637
18638ssl_s_sig_alg : string
18639 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
18640 the server when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18641 layer.
18642
18643ssl_s_version : integer
18644 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the server when the
18645 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020018646
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200186477.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018648------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020018649
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018650Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
18651sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
18652only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
18653For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
18654be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
18655can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
18656sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
18657for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
18658content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018659
Christopher Fauleta434a002021-03-25 11:58:51 +010018660Warning : Following sample fetches are ignored if used from HTTP proxies. They
18661 only deal with raw contents found in the buffers. On their side,
18662 HTTTP proxies use structured content. Thus raw representation of
18663 these data are meaningless. A warning is emitted if an ACL relies on
18664 one of the following sample fetches. But it is not possible to detect
18665 all invalid usage (for instance inside a log-format string or a
18666 sample expression). So be careful.
18667
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018668payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018669 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018670 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
18671 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018672
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018673payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
18674 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018675 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018676 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018677
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018678req.len : integer
18679req_len : integer (deprecated)
18680 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
18681 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
18682 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
18683 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
18684 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
18685 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
18686 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
18687 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018688
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018689req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
18690 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020018691 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
18692 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
18693 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
18694 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018695
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018696 ACL alternatives :
18697 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018698
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018699req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
18700 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
18701 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
18702 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
18703 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018704
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018705 ACL alternatives :
18706 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018707
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018708 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018709
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018710req.proto_http : boolean
18711req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
18712 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
18713 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
18714 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
18715 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
18716 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
18717 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
18718 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018719
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018720 Example:
18721 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
18722 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
18723 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018724 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018725
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018726req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
18727rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
18728 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
18729 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
18730 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
18731 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
18732 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
18733 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
18734 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018735
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018736 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
18737 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
18738 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
18739 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
18740 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
18741 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018742
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018743 ACL derivatives :
18744 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018745
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018746 Example :
18747 listen tse-farm
18748 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
18749 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
18750 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
18751 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
18752 # apply RDP cookie persistence
18753 persist rdp-cookie
18754 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
18755 # This is only useful makes sense if
18756 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
18757 stick-table type string size 204800
18758 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
18759 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
18760 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018761
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018762 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
18763 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018764
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018765req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
18766rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
18767 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
18768 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
18769 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
18770 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018771
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018772 ACL derivatives :
18773 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018774
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110018775req.ssl_alpn : string
18776 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
18777 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
18778 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
18779 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
18780 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
18781 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020018782 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110018783
18784 Examples :
18785 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
18786 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
18787 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020018788 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110018789 default_backend bk_default
18790
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020018791req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
18792 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
18793 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020018794 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
18795 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
18796 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
18797 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
18798 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020018799
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018800req.ssl_hello_type : integer
18801req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
18802 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
18803 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
18804 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
18805 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
18806 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
18807 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
18808 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018809
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018810req.ssl_sni : string
18811req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
18812 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
18813 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
18814 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
18815 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
18816 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020018817 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This will only work for actual
18818 implicit TLS based protocols like HTTPS (443), IMAPS (993), SMTPS (465),
18819 however it will not work for explicit TLS based protocols, like SMTP (25/587)
18820 or IMAP (143). SNI normally contains the name of the host the client tries to
18821 connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is useful for allowing or denying access
18822 to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used by the client. This test was designed to
18823 be used with TCP request content inspection. If content switching is needed,
18824 it is recommended to first wait for a complete client hello (type 1), like in
18825 the example below. See also "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018826
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018827 ACL derivatives :
18828 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018829
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018830 Examples :
18831 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
18832 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
18833 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
18834 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
18835 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018836
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053018837req.ssl_st_ext : integer
18838 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
18839 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
18840 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
18841 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
18842 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
18843 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
18844 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
18845 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
18846 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
18847
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018848req.ssl_ver : integer
18849req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
18850 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
18851 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
18852 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
18853 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
18854 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
18855 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
18856 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018857 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018858 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018859
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018860 ACL derivatives :
18861 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018862
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020018863res.len : integer
18864 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
18865 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
18866 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
18867 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
18868 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
18869 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
18870 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018871 content inspection. But it may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020018872
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018873res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
18874 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020018875 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018876 the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020018877 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018878 any location. It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018879
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018880res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
18881 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
18882 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
18883 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018884 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign. It may also be used in tcp-check based
18885 expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018886
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018887 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018888
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020018889res.ssl_hello_type : integer
18890rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
18891 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
18892 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
18893 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
18894 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
18895 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
18896 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
18897 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
18898
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018899wait_end : boolean
18900 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
18901 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018902 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018903 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
18904 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018905 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018906 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
18907 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018908
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018909 Examples :
18910 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
18911 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
18912 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018913
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018914 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
18915 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
18916 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
18917 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
18918 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
18919 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
18920 tcp-request content reject
18921
18922
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200189237.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018924--------------------------------------
18925
18926It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
18927This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
18928data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
18929its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
18930HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
18931content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
18932to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
18933more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
18934response are indexed.
18935
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +010018936Note : Regarding HTTP processing from the tcp-request content rules, everything
18937 will work as expected from an HTTP proxy. However, from a TCP proxy,
18938 without an HTTP upgrade, it will only work for HTTP/1 content. For
18939 HTTP/2 content, only the preface is visible. Thus, it is only possible
18940 to rely to "req.proto_http", "req.ver" and eventually "method" sample
18941 fetches. All other L7 sample fetches will fail. After an HTTP upgrade,
18942 they will work in the same manner than from an HTTP proxy.
18943
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018944base : string
18945 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
18946 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
18947 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
18948 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
18949 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
18950 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
18951 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
18952 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
18953
18954 ACL derivatives :
18955 base : exact string match
18956 base_beg : prefix match
18957 base_dir : subdir match
18958 base_dom : domain match
18959 base_end : suffix match
18960 base_len : length match
18961 base_reg : regex match
18962 base_sub : substring match
18963
18964base32 : integer
18965 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
18966 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
18967 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020018968 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
18969 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
18970 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018971
18972base32+src : binary
18973 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
18974 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
18975 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
18976 per-URL counters.
18977
Yves Lafonb4d37082021-02-11 11:01:28 +010018978baseq : string
18979 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
18980 the request with the query-string, which starts at the first slash. Using this
18981 instead of "base" allows one to properly identify the target resource, for
18982 statistics or caching use cases. See also "path", "pathq" and "base".
18983
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010018984capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
18985 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
18986 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
18987 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
18988
18989capture.req.method : string
18990 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
18991 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
18992 because it's allocated.
18993
18994capture.req.uri : string
18995 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
18996 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
18997 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
18998 allocated.
18999
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020019000capture.req.ver : string
19001 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
19002 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
19003 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
19004
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010019005capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
19006 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
19007 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
19008 The first entry is an index of 0.
19009 See also: "capture response header"
19010
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020019011capture.res.ver : string
19012 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
19013 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
19014 persistent flag.
19015
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019016req.body : binary
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020019017 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It is
19018 recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as much
19019 as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019020
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020019021req.body_param([<name>) : string
19022 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
19023 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
19024 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
19025 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
19026 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
19027 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
19028 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
19029 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
19030 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
19031 given.
19032
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019033req.body_len : integer
19034 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
19035 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020019036 is recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as
19037 much as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019038
19039req.body_size : integer
19040 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020019041 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
19042 available data in case of chunked encoding.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019043
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019044req.cook([<name>]) : string
19045cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19046 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
19047 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
19048 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
19049 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
19050 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
19051 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
19052 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
19053 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
19054
19055 ACL derivatives :
19056 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
19057 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
19058 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
19059 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
19060 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
19061 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
19062 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
19063 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019064
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019065req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19066cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19067 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
19068 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019069
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019070req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
19071cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19072 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
19073 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
19074 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
19075 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020019076
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019077cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19078 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
19079 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
19080 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
19081 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020019082 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019083 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
19084 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
19085 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
19086 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019087
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019088hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
19089 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
19090 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
19091 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
19092 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019093 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019094
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019095req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019096 This returns the full value of the last occurrence of header <name> in an
19097 HTTP request. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas present in the
19098 value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is sometimes useful
19099 with headers such as User-Agent.
19100
19101 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
19102 found.
19103
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019104 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
19105 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
19106 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019107 with -1 being the last one.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019108
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019109req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19110 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
19111 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019112 not specified. Like req.fhdr() it differs from res.hdr_cnt() by not splitting
19113 headers at commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019114
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019115req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019116 This returns the last comma-separated value of the header <name> in an HTTP
19117 request. The fetch considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values.
19118 This is useful if you need to process headers that are defined to be a list
19119 of values, such as Accept, or X-Forwarded-For. If full-line headers are
19120 desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC 7231 to know how
19121 certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
19122 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
19123
19124 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
19125 found.
19126
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019127 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
19128 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
19129 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019130 with -1 being the last one.
19131
19132 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header once converted to IP,
19133 associated with an IP stick-table.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019134
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019135 ACL derivatives :
19136 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
19137 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
19138 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
19139 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
19140 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
19141 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
19142 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
19143 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
19144
19145req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19146hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
19147 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
19148 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019149 <name> is not specified. Like req.hdr() it counts each comma separated
19150 part of the header's value. If counting of full-line headers is desired,
19151 then req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead.
19152
19153 With ACLs, it can be used to detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific
19154 header, as well as to block request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests
19155 which contain more than one of certain headers.
19156
19157 Refer to req.hdr() for more information on header matching.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019158
19159req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
19160hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
19161 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
19162 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
19163 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
Willy Tarreau7b0e00d2021-03-25 14:12:29 +010019164 of every header is checked. The parser strictly adheres to the format
19165 described in RFC7239, with the extension that IPv4 addresses may optionally
19166 be followed by a colon (':') and a valid decimal port number (0 to 65535),
19167 which will be silently dropped. All other forms will not match and will
19168 cause the address to be ignored.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019169
19170 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
19171
19172 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019173
19174req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
19175hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
19176 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
19177 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
19178 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019179
19180 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
19181
19182 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019183
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010019184req.hdrs : string
19185 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
19186 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
19187 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
19188 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
19189
19190req.hdrs_bin : binary
19191 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
19192 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
19193 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
19194 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
19195 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
19196 names and values (length of 0 for both).
19197
19198 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010019199
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010019200 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
19201 str: <int:length><bytes>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010019202
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019203http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
19204 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
19205 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
19206 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
19207 basic auth is supported.
19208
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010019209http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
19210 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
19211 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
19212 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
19213 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019214 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
19215 basic auth is supported.
19216
19217 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010019218 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
19219 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
19220 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
19221 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019222
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019223http_auth_pass : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010019224 Returns the user's password found in the authentication data received from
19225 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
19226 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019227
19228http_auth_type : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010019229 Returns the authentication method found in the authentication data received from
19230 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
19231 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019232
19233http_auth_user : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010019234 Returns the user name found in the authentication data received from the
19235 client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are performed by
19236 this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019237
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019238http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020019239 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
19240 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019241 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
19242 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020019243
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019244method : integer + string
19245 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
19246 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
19247 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
19248 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
19249 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
19250 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
19251 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019252
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019253 ACL derivatives :
19254 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019255
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019256 Example :
19257 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
19258 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
19259 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019260
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019261path : string
19262 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
19263 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
19264 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
19265 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
19266 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019267 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019268 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019269
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019270 ACL derivatives :
19271 path : exact string match
19272 path_beg : prefix match
19273 path_dir : subdir match
19274 path_dom : domain match
19275 path_end : suffix match
19276 path_len : length match
19277 path_reg : regex match
19278 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019279
Christopher Faulete720c322020-09-02 17:25:18 +020019280pathq : string
19281 This extracts the request's URL path with the query-string, which starts at
19282 the first slash. This sample fetch is pretty handy to always retrieve a
19283 relative URI, excluding the scheme and the authority part, if any. Indeed,
19284 while it is the common representation for an HTTP/1.1 request target, in
19285 HTTP/2, an absolute URI is often used. This sample fetch will return the same
19286 result in both cases.
19287
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010019288query : string
19289 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
19290 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
19291 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
19292 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010019293 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010019294 which stops before the question mark.
19295
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010019296req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
19297 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
19298 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
19299 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
19300 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
19301
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019302req.ver : string
19303req_ver : string (deprecated)
19304 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
19305 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
19306 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019307
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019308 ACL derivatives :
19309 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020019310
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019311res.body : binary
19312 This returns the HTTP response's available body as a block of data. Unlike
19313 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019314 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
19315
19316 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019317
19318res.body_len : integer
19319 This returns the length of the HTTP response available body in bytes. Unlike
19320 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019321 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
19322
19323 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019324
19325res.body_size : integer
19326 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP response body in bytes. It
19327 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
19328 available data in case of chunked encoding. Unlike the request side, there is
19329 no directive to wait for the response body. This sample fetch is really
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019330 useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
19331
19332 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019333
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonbf971212020-10-27 11:55:57 +010019334res.cache_hit : boolean
19335 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been built out of an
19336 HTTP cache entry, otherwise returns boolean "false".
19337
19338res.cache_name : string
19339 Returns a string containing the name of the HTTP cache that was used to
19340 build the HTTP response if res.cache_hit is true, otherwise returns an
19341 empty string.
19342
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019343res.comp : boolean
19344 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
19345 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
19346 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019347
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019348res.comp_algo : string
19349 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
19350 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
19351 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019352
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019353res.cook([<name>]) : string
19354scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19355 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
19356 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019357 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
19358
19359 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020019360
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019361 ACL derivatives :
19362 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020019363
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019364res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19365scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19366 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
19367 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019368 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
19369
19370 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019371
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019372res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
19373scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19374 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
19375 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019376 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
19377
19378 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019379
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019380res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019381 This fetch works like the req.fhdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
19382 on the headers within an HTTP response.
19383
19384 Like req.fhdr() the res.fhdr() fetch returns full values. If the header is
19385 defined to be a list you should use res.hdr().
19386
19387 This fetch is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or Expires.
19388
19389 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019390
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019391res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019392 This fetch works like the req.fhdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
19393 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19394
19395 Like req.fhdr_cnt() the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch acts on full values. If the
19396 header is defined to be a list you should use res.hdr_cnt().
19397
19398 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019399
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019400res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
19401shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019402 This fetch works like the req.hdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
19403 on the headers within an HTTP response.
19404
Ilya Shipitsinacf84592021-02-06 22:29:08 +050019405 Like req.hdr() the res.hdr() fetch considers the comma to be a delimiter. If
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019406 this is not desired res.fhdr() should be used.
19407
19408 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019409
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019410 ACL derivatives :
19411 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
19412 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
19413 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
19414 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
19415 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
19416 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
19417 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
19418 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
19419
19420res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19421shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019422 This fetch works like the req.hdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
19423 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19424
19425 Like req.hdr_cnt() the res.hdr_cnt() fetch considers the comma to be a
Ilya Shipitsinacf84592021-02-06 22:29:08 +050019426 delimiter. If this is not desired res.fhdr_cnt() should be used.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019427
19428 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019429
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019430res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
19431shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019432 This fetch works like the req.hdr_ip() fetch with the difference that it
19433 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19434
19435 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
19436
19437 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019438
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010019439res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
19440 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
19441 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
19442 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019443 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
19444
19445 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010019446
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019447res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
19448shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019449 This fetch works like the req.hdr_val() fetch with the difference that it
19450 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19451
19452 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
19453
19454 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019455
19456res.hdrs : string
19457 Returns the current response headers as string including the last empty line
19458 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
19459 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019460 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
19461
19462 It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019463
19464res.hdrs_bin : binary
19465 Returns the current response headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
19466 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. It may be used in
19467 tcp-check based expect rules. Each string is described by a length followed
19468 by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The length is represented
19469 using the variable integer encoding detailed in the SPOE documentation. The
19470 end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header names and values
19471 (length of 0 for both).
19472
19473 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
19474
19475 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
19476 str: <int:length><bytes>
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010019477
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019478res.ver : string
19479resp_ver : string (deprecated)
19480 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019481 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
19482
19483 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020019484
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019485 ACL derivatives :
19486 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010019487
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019488set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19489 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
19490 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020019491 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019492 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010019493
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019494 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
19495 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010019496
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019497status : integer
19498 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
19499 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019500 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
19501
19502 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019503
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020019504unique-id : string
19505 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
19506 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
19507 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
19508 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
19509 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
19510 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
19511
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019512url : string
19513 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
19514 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
19515 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
19516 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
19517 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
19518 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
19519 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019520
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019521 ACL derivatives :
19522 url : exact string match
19523 url_beg : prefix match
19524 url_dir : subdir match
19525 url_dom : domain match
19526 url_end : suffix match
19527 url_len : length match
19528 url_reg : regex match
19529 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019530
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019531url_ip : ip
19532 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
19533 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
19534 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
19535 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
19536 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
19537 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
19538 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019539
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019540url_port : integer
19541 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
19542 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
19543 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
19544 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019545
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020019546urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
19547url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019548 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
19549 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020019550 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
19551 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
19552 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
19553 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019554 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
19555 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020019556 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
19557 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019558
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019559 ACL derivatives :
19560 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
19561 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
19562 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
19563 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
19564 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
19565 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
19566 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
19567 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019568
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019569
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019570 Example :
19571 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
19572 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
19573 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
19574 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019575
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030019576urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019577 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
19578 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
19579 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020019580
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020019581url32 : integer
19582 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
19583 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
19584 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
19585 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
19586 is an unsigned integer.
19587
19588url32+src : binary
19589 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
19590 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
19591 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
19592
Christopher Faulet16032ab2020-04-30 11:30:00 +020019593
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200195947.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019595---------------------------------------
19596
19597This set of sample fetch methods is reserved to developers and must never be
19598used on a production environment, except on developer demand, for debugging
19599purposes. Moreover, no special care will be taken on backwards compatibility.
19600There is no warranty the following sample fetches will never change, be renamed
19601or simply removed. So be really careful if you should use one of them. To avoid
19602any ambiguity, these sample fetches are placed in the dedicated scope "internal",
19603for instance "internal.strm.is_htx".
19604
19605internal.htx.data : integer
19606 Returns the size in bytes used by data in the HTX message associated to a
19607 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19608
19609internal.htx.free : integer
19610 Returns the free space (size - used) in bytes in the HTX message associated
19611 to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19612
19613internal.htx.free_data : integer
19614 Returns the free space for the data in bytes in the HTX message associated to
19615 a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19616
19617internal.htx.has_eom : boolean
Christopher Fauletd1ac2b92020-12-02 19:12:22 +010019618 Returns true if the HTX message associated to a channel contains the
19619 end-of-message flag (EOM). Otherwise, it returns false. The channel is chosen
19620 depending on the sample direction.
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019621
19622internal.htx.nbblks : integer
19623 Returns the number of blocks present in the HTX message associated to a
19624 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19625
19626internal.htx.size : integer
19627 Returns the total size in bytes of the HTX message associated to a
19628 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19629
19630internal.htx.used : integer
19631 Returns the total size used in bytes (data + metadata) in the HTX message
19632 associated to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
19633 direction.
19634
19635internal.htx_blk.size(<idx>) : integer
19636 Returns the size of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
19637 associated to a channel or 0 if it does not exist. The channel is chosen
19638 depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one
19639 of the special value :
19640 * head : The oldest inserted block
19641 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019642 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019643
19644internal.htx_blk.type(<idx>) : string
19645 Returns the type of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
19646 associated to a channel or "HTX_BLK_UNUSED" if it does not exist. The channel
19647 is chosen depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive
19648 integer or one of the special value :
19649 * head : The oldest inserted block
19650 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019651 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019652
19653internal.htx_blk.data(<idx>) : binary
19654 Returns the value of the DATA block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
19655 associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if it is
19656 not a DATA block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19657 <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
19658
19659 * head : The oldest inserted block
19660 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019661 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019662
19663internal.htx_blk.hdrname(<idx>) : string
19664 Returns the header name of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
19665 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
19666 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
19667 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
19668
19669 * head : The oldest inserted block
19670 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019671 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019672
19673internal.htx_blk.hdrval(<idx>) : string
19674 Returns the header value of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
19675 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
19676 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
19677 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
19678
19679 * head : The oldest inserted block
19680 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019681 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019682
19683internal.htx_blk.start_line(<idx>) : string
19684 Returns the value of the REQ_SL or RES_SL block at the position <idx> in the
19685 HTX message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist
19686 or if it is not a SL block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
19687 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
19688
19689 * head : The oldest inserted block
19690 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019691 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019692
19693internal.strm.is_htx : boolean
19694 Returns true if the current stream is an HTX stream. It means the data in the
19695 channels buffers are stored using the internal HTX representation. Otherwise,
19696 it returns false.
19697
19698
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200196997.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019700---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010019701
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019702Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
19703every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020019704order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010019705
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019706ACL name Equivalent to Usage
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020019707---------------+----------------------------------+------------------------------------------------------
19708FALSE always_false never match
19709HTTP req.proto_http match if request protocol is valid HTTP
19710HTTP_1.0 req.ver 1.0 match if HTTP request version is 1.0
19711HTTP_1.1 req.ver 1.1 match if HTTP request version is 1.1
Christopher Faulet8043e832021-03-26 16:00:54 +010019712HTTP_2.0 req.ver 2.0 match if HTTP request version is 2.0
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020019713HTTP_CONTENT req.hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length in the HTTP request
19714HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
19715HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
19716HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
19717LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
19718METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
19719METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
19720METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
19721METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
19722METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
19723METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
19724METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
19725METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
19726RDP_COOKIE req.rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie in the request buffer
19727REQ_CONTENT req.len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
19728TRUE always_true always match
19729WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
19730---------------+----------------------------------+------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010019731
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010019732
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200197338. Logging
19734----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010019735
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019736One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
19737provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
19738very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
19739provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
19740state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010019741to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019742headers.
19743
19744In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
19745about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
19746send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
19747
19748 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
19749 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
19750 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
19751 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
19752 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019753 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060019754 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019755
19756The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
19757allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
19758as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
19759while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
19760real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
19761delay.
19762
19763
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200197648.1. Log levels
19765---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019766
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090019767TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019768source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090019769HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
19770in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
19771track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
19772syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
19773about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019774
19775
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200197768.2. Log formats
19777----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019778
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019779HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090019780and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
19781slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
19782options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019783
19784 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
19785 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
19786 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
19787 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
19788 extents.
19789
19790 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
19791 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
19792 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
19793 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
19794 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
19795
19796 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
19797 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
19798 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
19799 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
19800 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
19801
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020019802 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
19803 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
19804 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
19805 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
19806
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019807 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
19808
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019809Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
19810specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
19811field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
19812servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
19813always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
19814identifier.
19815
19816Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
19817 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
19818 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
19819 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
19820 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
19821
19822
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200198238.2.1. Default log format
19824-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019825
19826This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
19827as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
19828format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
19829
19830 Example :
19831 listen www
19832 mode http
19833 log global
19834 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
19835
19836 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
19837 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
19838 (www/HTTP)
19839
19840 Field Format Extract from the example above
19841 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
19842 2 'Connect from' Connect from
19843 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
19844 4 'to' to
19845 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
19846 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
19847
19848Detailed fields description :
19849 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
19850 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
19851 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
19852 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
19853 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
19854 and processed the connection.
19855 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
19856
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010019857In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
19858"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
19859connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
19860
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019861It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
19862will eventually disappear.
19863
19864
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200198658.2.2. TCP log format
19866---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019867
19868The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
19869is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
19870information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
19871counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
19872emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
19873environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
19874the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
19875sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020019876specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
19877not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
19878fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
19879marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019880
19881 Example :
19882 frontend fnt
19883 mode tcp
19884 option tcplog
19885 log global
19886 default_backend bck
19887
19888 backend bck
19889 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
19890
19891 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
19892 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
19893 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
19894
19895 Field Format Extract from the example above
19896 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
19897 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
19898 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
19899 4 frontend_name fnt
19900 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
19901 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
19902 7 bytes_read* 212
19903 8 termination_state --
19904 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
19905 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
19906
19907Detailed fields description :
19908 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010019909 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
19910 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
19911 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010019912 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019913 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010019914 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019915
19916 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010019917 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
19918 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
19919 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019920
19921 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
19922 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
19923 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019924 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
19925 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
19926 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
19927 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019928
19929 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
19930 and processed the connection.
19931
19932 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
19933 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
19934 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
19935 applications.
19936
19937 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
19938 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
19939 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
19940 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
19941 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
19942
19943 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
19944 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
19945 See "Timers" below for more details.
19946
19947 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
19948 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
19949 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
19950 "Timers" below for more details.
19951
19952 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019953 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019954 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
19955 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
19956 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
19957 details.
19958
19959 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
19960 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
19961 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
19962 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
19963 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
19964
19965 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
19966 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
19967 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
19968 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
19969 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
19970 for more details.
19971
19972 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040019973 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019974 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
19975 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
19976 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019977 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019978
19979 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
19980 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
19981 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
19982 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
19983 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
19984 caused by a denial of service attack.
19985
19986 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
19987 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
19988 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
19989 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
19990 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
19991 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
19992 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
19993 denial of service attack.
19994
19995 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
19996 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
19997 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
19998 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
19999 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
20000 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
20001 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
20002 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
20003 be processed than on other servers.
20004
20005 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
20006 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
20007 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
20008 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
20009 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
20010 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
20011 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
20012 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
20013 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
20014 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
20015 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
20016 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
20017 should not be attributed to the logged server.
20018
20019 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20020 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
20021 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
20022 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
20023 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
20024 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020025 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020026 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
20027
20028 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20029 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
20030 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
20031 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
20032 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
20033 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020034 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020035 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
20036 occurs.
20037
20038
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200200398.2.3. HTTP log format
20040----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020041
20042The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
20043is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
20044the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
20045are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
20046emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
20047generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
20048"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
20049which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020050frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
20051is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020052
20053Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
20054slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
20055with a star ('*') after the field name below.
20056
20057 Example :
20058 frontend http-in
20059 mode http
20060 option httplog
20061 log global
20062 default_backend bck
20063
20064 backend static
20065 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
20066
20067 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
20068 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
20069 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020070 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020071
20072 Field Format Extract from the example above
20073 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
20074 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020075 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020076 4 frontend_name http-in
20077 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020078 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020079 7 status_code 200
20080 8 bytes_read* 2750
20081 9 captured_request_cookie -
20082 10 captured_response_cookie -
20083 11 termination_state ----
20084 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
20085 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
20086 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
20087 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
20088 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020089
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020090Detailed fields description :
20091 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020092 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
20093 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
20094 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020095 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020096 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020097 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020098
20099 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020100 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
20101 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
20102 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020103
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020104 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
20105 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020106
20107 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
20108 and processed the connection.
20109
20110 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
20111 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
20112 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
20113
20114 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
20115 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
20116 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
20117 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
20118 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
20119 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
20120
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020121 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
20122 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
20123 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050020124 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020125 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
20126 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020127 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
20128 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020129
20130 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
20131 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020132 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020133
20134 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
20135 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020136 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
20137 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020138
20139 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
20140 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
20141 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
20142 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
20143 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020144 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
20145 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020146
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020147 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
20148 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
20149 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
20150 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
20151 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
20152 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
20153 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020154 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020155
20156 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
20157 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
20158 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
20159
20160 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
20161 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050020162 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020163 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
20164 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
20165 overflowing.
20166
20167 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
20168 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
20169 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
20170 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
20171 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
20172 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
20173 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
20174 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
20175
20176 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
20177 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
20178 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
20179 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
20180 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
20181 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
20182 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
20183 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
20184
20185 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
20186 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
20187 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
20188 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
20189 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
20190 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
20191 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
20192
20193 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020194 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020195 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
20196 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
20197 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020198 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020199 system.
20200
20201 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
20202 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
20203 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
20204 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
20205 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
20206 caused by a denial of service attack.
20207
20208 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
20209 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
20210 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
20211 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
20212 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
20213 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
20214 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
20215 denial of service attack.
20216
20217 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
20218 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
20219 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
20220 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
20221 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
20222 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
20223 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
20224 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
20225 processed than on other servers.
20226
20227 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
20228 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
20229 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
20230 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
20231 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
20232 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
20233 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
20234 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
20235 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
20236 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
20237 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
20238 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
20239 should not be attributed to the logged server.
20240
20241 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20242 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
20243 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
20244 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
20245 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
20246 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020247 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020248 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
20249
20250 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20251 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
20252 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
20253 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
20254 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
20255 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020256 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020257 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
20258 occurs.
20259
20260 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
20261 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
20262 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
20263 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
20264 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
20265 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
20266 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
20267 cookies" below for more details.
20268
20269 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
20270 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
20271 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
20272 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
20273 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
20274 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
20275 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
20276 and cookies" below for more details.
20277
20278 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
20279 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
20280 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
20281 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
20282 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
20283 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
20284 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
20285 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
20286
20287
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200202888.2.4. Custom log format
20289------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020290
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020291The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020292mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020293
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020294HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020295Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
20296separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
20297prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
20298
20299Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
20300variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020301("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020302
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010020303If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020020304as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010020305less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
20306the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
20307
Dragan Dosen1e3b16f2020-06-23 18:16:44 +020020308Note: spaces must be escaped. In configuration directives "log-format",
20309"log-format-sd" and "unique-id-format", spaces are considered as
20310delimiters and are merged. In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be
20311preceded by another '%' resulting in '%%'.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020312
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020313Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
20314'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
20315https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
20316such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
20317
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020318Flags are :
20319 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020320 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020321 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
20322 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020323
20324 Example:
20325
20326 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
20327 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
20328
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020329 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
20330
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020331At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
20332
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020333 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
20334 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020335
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020336the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020337
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020338 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
20339 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
20340 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020341
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020342and the default TCP format is defined this way :
20343
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020344 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
20345 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020346
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020347Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
20348
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020349 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020350 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020351 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
20352 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
20353 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020354 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
20355 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
20356 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020357 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000020358 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
Maciej Zdeb21acc332020-11-26 10:45:52 +000020359 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string | string |
Maciej Zdebfcdfd852020-11-30 18:27:47 +000020360 | H | %HPO | HTTP path only (without host nor query string)| string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000020361 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000020362 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
20363 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010020364 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020020365 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020366 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020367 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020368 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020020369 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080020370 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020371 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
20372 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
20373 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
20374 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
20375 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020376 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020377 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000020378 | | %Tu | Tu | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020379 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020380 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020381 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
20382 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020383 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
20384 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
20385 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020386 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020387 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
20388 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020389 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020390 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
20391 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
20392 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020020393 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020020394 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020020395 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
20396 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
20397 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
20398 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020020399 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020400 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020401 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020402 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010020403 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020404 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020405 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
20406 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
20407 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020408 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020409 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
20410 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020411 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020412 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
20413 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020020414 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020415 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020416 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020417 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020418
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020419 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020420
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010020421
204228.2.5. Error log format
20423-----------------------
20424
20425When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
20426protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
20427By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
20428"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020429will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010020430logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
20431
20432The format looks like this :
20433
20434 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
20435 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
20436 Connection error during SSL handshake
20437
20438 Field Format Extract from the example above
20439 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
20440 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
20441 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
20442 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
20443 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
20444
20445These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
20446failures.
20447
20448
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200204498.3. Advanced logging options
20450-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020451
20452Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
20453just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
20454options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
20455for more information about their usage.
20456
20457
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200204588.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
20459------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020460
20461It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
20462haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
20463commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
20464monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
20465ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
20466
20467 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
20468 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
20469 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
20470 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
20471
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +020020472 - it is possible to use the "http-request set-log-level silent" action using
20473 a variety of conditions (source networks, paths, user-agents, etc).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020474
20475 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
20476 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
20477 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
20478
20479
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200204808.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
20481----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020482
20483The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
20484what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
20485or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020486"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020487just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
20488log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
20489after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
20490is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
20491with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
20492with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
20493
20494
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200204958.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
20496------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020497
20498Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
20499for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
20500"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
20501retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
20502raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
20503a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
20504file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
20505you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
20506"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
20507
20508
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200205098.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
20510--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020511
20512Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
20513multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
20514them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
20515"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
20516logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
20517error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
20518and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
20519too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
20520useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
20521alternative.
20522
20523
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200205248.4. Timing events
20525------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020526
20527Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
20528reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
20529the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
20530frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020531mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
20532addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
20533
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010020534Timings events in HTTP mode:
20535
20536 first request 2nd request
20537 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
20538 t tr t tr ...
20539 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
20540 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
20541 :<---- Tq ---->: :
20542 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000020543 :<-- -----Tu--------------->:
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010020544 :<--------- Ta --------->:
20545
20546Timings events in TCP mode:
20547
20548 TCP session
20549 |<----------------->|
20550 t t
20551 ---|----|----|----|----|---
20552 | Th Tw Tc Td |
20553 |<------ Tt ------->|
20554
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020555 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020556 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020557 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
20558 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
20559 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020560 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020561 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
20562 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
20563 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
20564 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020565
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020566 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
20567 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
20568 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020569 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
20570 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
20571 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
20572 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
20573 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
20574 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020575
20576 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
20577 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
20578 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
20579 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
20580 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
20581 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
20582 request typed by hand during a test.
20583
20584 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
20585 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020586 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020587 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
20588 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
20589 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
20590 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020591
20592 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
20593 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
20594 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
20595 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
20596 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
20597
20598 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
20599 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
20600 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
20601 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
20602 connection never established.
20603
20604 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
20605 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
20606 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
20607 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
20608 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
20609 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
20610 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
20611 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
20612 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
20613 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
20614 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
20615
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020616 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
20617 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
20618 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
20619 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
20620 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
20621 by subtracting other timers when valid :
20622
20623 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
20624
20625 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
20626 "Ta" can never be negative.
20627
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020628 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
20629 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020630 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
20631 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020632 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020633
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020634 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020635
20636 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020637 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
20638 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020639
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000020640 - Tu: total estimated time as seen from client, between the moment the proxy
20641 accepted it and the moment both ends were closed, without idle time.
20642 This is useful to roughly measure end-to-end time as a user would see it,
20643 without idle time pollution from keep-alive time between requests. This
20644 timer in only an estimation of time seen by user as it assumes network
20645 latency is the same in both directions. The exception is when the "logasap"
20646 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
20647 prefixed with a '+' sign.
20648
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020649These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
20650protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
20651that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020652due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
20653"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
20654that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020655
20656Most common cases :
20657
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020658 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
20659 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
20660 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
20661 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
20662 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
20663 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
20664 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
20665 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
20666 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
20667 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
20668 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020020669 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020670
20671 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
20672 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
20673 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
20674 of ms on remote networks.
20675
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020020676 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
20677 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
20678 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020679
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020680 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
20681 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
20682 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
20683 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
20684 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
20685 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
20686 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
20687 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
20688 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020689
20690Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
20691
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020692 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020693 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020694 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020695
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020696 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020697 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
20698 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
20699
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020700 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020701 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
20702 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
20703 flags.
20704
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020705 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
20706 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020707 Check the session termination flags, then check the
20708 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
20709 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
20710 the client connection was maintained open.
20711
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020712 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020713 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020714 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020715 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
20716
20717
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200207188.5. Session state at disconnection
20719-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020720
20721TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
20722"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
207232-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
20724each of which has a special meaning :
20725
20726 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
20727 session to terminate :
20728
20729 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
20730
20731 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
20732 server explicitly refused it.
20733
20734 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
20735 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
20736 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
20737 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020738 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020020739
20740 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
20741 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020742
20743 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
20744 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
20745 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
20746 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
20747 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
20748
20749 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
20750 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
20751 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
20752 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
20753 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
20754
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090020755 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
20756 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
20757
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070020758 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
20759 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
20760 backup connections when going up.
20761
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020020762 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
20763
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020764 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
20765 send or receive data.
20766
20767 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
20768 send or receive data.
20769
20770 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
20771 with nothing left in the buffers.
20772
20773 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
20774
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010020775 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020776 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
20777
20778 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
20779 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
20780 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
20781 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
20782 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
20783
20784 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
20785 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
20786
20787 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
20788 server (HTTP only).
20789
20790 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
20791
20792 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
20793 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
20794 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
20795
20796 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
20797 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
20798 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
20799
20800 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
20801
20802 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
20803 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
20804
20805 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
20806 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
20807 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
20808
20809 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
20810 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020020811 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
20812 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020813
20814 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
20815 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
20816 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
20817 another server.
20818
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020819 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020820 server.
20821
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020822 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
20823 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
20824 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
20825 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
20826
20827 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
20828 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
20829 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
20830 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
20831
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020020832 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
20833 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
20834 "use-server" rule).
20835
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020836 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
20837
20838 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
20839 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
20840
20841 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
20842
20843 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
20844 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
20845 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
20846
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020847 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
20848 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020849 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020850 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
20851 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
20852
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020853 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
20854
20855 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
20856 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
20857
20858 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
20859
20860 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
20861
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020862The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
20863was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020864helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
20865starvation, attacks, etc...
20866
20867The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
20868alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
20869easier finding and understanding.
20870
20871 Flags Reason
20872
20873 -- Normal termination.
20874
20875 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
20876 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
20877 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
20878 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
20879
20880 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
20881 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
20882 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
20883 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
20884 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
20885 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020886
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020887 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
20888 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020020889 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020890
20891 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
20892 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
20893 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
20894
20895 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
20896 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
20897 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
20898 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
20899 the server takes too long to respond.
20900
20901 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
20902 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
20903 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
20904 long a time to respond.
20905
20906 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
20907 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
20908 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
20909 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020020910 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
20911 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020912
20913 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
20914 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
20915 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
20916 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
20917 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020020918 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020020919 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
20920 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
20921 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
20922 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
20923 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
20924 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
20925 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
20926 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020927 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020020928 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
20929 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
20930 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020931
20932 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
20933 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020020934 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
20935 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
20936 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
20937 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020938
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020020939 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
20940 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
20941
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010020942 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020943 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
20944 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020945 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020946 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
20947 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
20948
20949 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
20950 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
20951 503 or 504 here.
20952
20953 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
20954 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
20955 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
20956 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
20957 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
20958
20959 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
20960 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020961 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020962 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
20963 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
20964
20965 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
20966 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
20967 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
20968 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
20969 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
20970 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
20971 between haproxy and the server.
20972
20973 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
20974 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
20975 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
20976 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
20977 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
20978 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
20979 solution is to fix the application.
20980
20981 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
20982 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
20983 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
20984 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
20985 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
20986 external attacks.
20987
20988 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070020989 process's socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020020990 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020991 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
20992 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
20993
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010020994 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
20995 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
20996 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020997 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020020998 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010020999
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021000 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
21001 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
21002 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
21003 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010021004 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
21005 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
21006 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
21007 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
21008 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021009
21010 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
21011 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
21012 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
21013 returned an HTTP 403 error.
21014
21015 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
21016 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
21017 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
21018 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
21019
21020 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
21021 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
21022 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
21023 only be solved by proper system tuning.
21024
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021025The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
21026persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
21027important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
21028re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
21029
21030 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
21031
21032 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
21033 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
21034 set on a GET request.
21035
21036 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
21037 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040021038 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021039 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
21040
21041 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
21042 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
21043 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
21044
21045 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
21046 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
21047 already got a cookie.
21048
21049 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
21050 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
21051 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
21052 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
21053 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
21054
21055 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
21056 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
21057 new cookie was inserted in the response.
21058
21059 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
21060 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
21061 new cookie was inserted in the response.
21062
21063 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
21064 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
21065
21066 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
21067 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
21068 then advertised in the response.
21069
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021070
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200210718.6. Non-printable characters
21072-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021073
21074In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
21075consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
21076converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
21077prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
21078being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
21079escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
21080is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
21081'}' when logging headers.
21082
21083Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
21084issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
21085containing spaces is "User-Agent".
21086
21087Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
21088the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
21089performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
21090
21091
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200210928.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
21093---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021094
21095Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
21096achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021097section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021098cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
21099the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
21100the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021101locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021102not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
21103user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
21104a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
21105wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
21106
21107 Examples :
21108 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
21109 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
21110
21111 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
21112 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
21113
21114
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200211158.8. Capturing HTTP headers
21116---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021117
21118Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
21119proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
21120the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
21121server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
21122
21123Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
21124response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021125section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021126
21127It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010021128time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
21129appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021130are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
21131and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
21132follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
21133request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
21134in the logs.
21135
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020021136As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
21137frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
21138an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
21139
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021140 Example :
21141 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
21142 listen proxy-out
21143 mode http
21144 option httplog
21145 option logasap
21146 log global
21147 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
21148
21149 # log the name of the virtual server
21150 capture request header Host len 20
21151
21152 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
21153 capture request header Content-Length len 10
21154
21155 # log the beginning of the referrer
21156 capture request header Referer len 20
21157
21158 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
21159 capture response header Server len 20
21160
21161 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
21162 capture response header Content-Length len 10
21163
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021164 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021165 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
21166
21167 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
21168 capture response header Via len 20
21169
21170 # log the URL location during a redirection
21171 capture response header Location len 20
21172
21173 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
21174 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
21175 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
21176 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
21177 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
21178
21179 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
21180 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
21181 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
21182 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021183 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021184
21185 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
21186 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
21187 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
21188 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
21189 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021190 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021191
21192
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200211938.9. Examples of logs
21194---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021195
21196These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
21197them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
21198reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
21199
21200 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
21201 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
21202 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
21203
21204 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
21205 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
21206
21207 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
21208 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
21209 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
21210
21211 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
21212 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
21213
21214 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
21215 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
21216 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
21217
21218 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010021219 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021220 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
21221 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
21222
21223 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
21224 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
21225 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
21226
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020021227 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "http-response
21228 deny" rule, or because the response was improperly formatted and not
21229 HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which risked
21230 being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502 bad
21231 gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided to
21232 return the 502 and not the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021233
21234 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021235 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021236
21237 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
21238 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
21239 Nothing was sent to any server.
21240
21241 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
21242 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
21243
21244 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
21245 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021246 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021247 send a 408 return code to the client.
21248
21249 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
21250 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
21251
21252 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
21253 5 seconds ("c----").
21254
21255 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
21256 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021257 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021258
21259 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021260 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021261 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
21262 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
21263 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
21264 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
21265 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010021266
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020021267
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200212689. Supported filters
21269--------------------
21270
21271Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
21272accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
21273unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
21274
21275See also : "filter"
21276
212779.1. Trace
21278----------
21279
Christopher Fauletc41d8bd2020-11-17 10:43:26 +010021280filter trace [name <name>] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021281
21282 Arguments:
21283 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
21284 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
21285
Christopher Faulet96a577a2020-11-17 10:45:05 +010021286 <quiet> inhibits trace messages.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021287
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021288 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021289 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
21290 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
21291 amount of the parsed data.
21292
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021293 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010021294
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021295This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
21296callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
21297information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
21298filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
21299
21300Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
21301tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
21302a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
21303
21304
213059.2. HTTP compression
21306---------------------
21307
21308filter compression
21309
21310The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
21311keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021312when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache or the
21313fcgi-app enabled, it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always
21314done after the response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to
21315explicitly use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one
21316filter other than the cache or the fcgi-app is used for the same
21317listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
21318order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021319
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021320See also : "compression", section 9.4 about the cache filter and section 9.5
21321 about the fcgi-app filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021322
21323
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200213249.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
21325--------------------------------------------
21326
21327filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
21328
21329 Arguments :
21330
21331 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
21332 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
21333 parsed.
21334
21335 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
21336 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
21337 part must be placed in its own scope.
21338
21339The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
21340external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021341streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020021342exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
21343also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
21344
21345SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
21346the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
21347
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010021348For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020021349"doc/SPOE.txt".
21350
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100213519.4. Cache
21352----------
21353
21354filter cache <name>
21355
21356 Arguments :
21357
21358 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
21359
21360The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
21361"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050021362cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021363other filters than fcgi-app or compression are used, it is enough. In such
21364case, the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it
21365is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
21366filter other than the compression or the fcgi-app is used for the same
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010021367listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
21368order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010021369
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021370See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.5 about the
21371 fcgi-app filter and section 6 about cache.
21372
21373
213749.5. Fcgi-app
21375-------------
21376
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040021377filter fcgi-app <name>
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021378
21379 Arguments :
21380
21381 <name> is name of the fcgi-app section this filter will use.
21382
21383The FastCGI application uses a filter to evaluate all custom parameters on the
21384request path, and to process the headers on the response path. the <name> must
21385reference an existing fcgi-app section. The directive "use-fcgi-app" should be
21386used to define the application to use. By default the corresponding filter is
21387implicitly defined. And when no other filters than cache or compression are
21388used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to a
21389fcgi-app when at least one filter other than the compression or the cache is
21390used for the same backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
21391order.
21392
21393See also: "use-fcgi-app", section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.4
21394 about the cache filter and section 10 about FastCGI application.
21395
21396
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +0100213979.6. OpenTracing
21398----------------
21399
21400The OpenTracing filter adds native support for using distributed tracing in
21401HAProxy. This is enabled by sending an OpenTracing compliant request to one
21402of the supported tracers such as Datadog, Jaeger, Lightstep and Zipkin tracers.
21403Please note: tracers are not listed by any preference, but alphabetically.
21404
21405This feature is only enabled when haproxy was built with USE_OT=1.
21406
21407The OpenTracing filter activation is done explicitly by specifying it in the
21408HAProxy configuration. If this is not done, the OpenTracing filter in no way
21409participates in the work of HAProxy.
21410
21411filter opentracing [id <id>] config <file>
21412
21413 Arguments :
21414
21415 <id> is the OpenTracing filter id that will be used to find the
21416 right scope in the configuration file. If no filter id is
21417 specified, 'ot-filter' is used as default. If scope is not
21418 specified in the configuration file, it applies to all defined
21419 OpenTracing filters.
21420
21421 <file> is the path of the OpenTracing configuration file. The same
21422 file can contain configurations for multiple OpenTracing
21423 filters simultaneously. In that case we do not need to define
21424 scope so the same configuration applies to all filters or each
21425 filter must have its own scope defined.
21426
21427More detailed documentation related to the operation, configuration and use
Willy Tarreaua63d1a02021-04-02 17:16:46 +020021428of the filter can be found in the addons/ot directory.
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +010021429
21430
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02002143110. FastCGI applications
21432-------------------------
21433
21434HAProxy is able to send HTTP requests to Responder FastCGI applications. This
21435feature was added in HAProxy 2.1. To do so, servers must be configured to use
21436the FastCGI protocol (using the keyword "proto fcgi" on the server line) and a
21437FastCGI application must be configured and used by the backend managing these
21438servers (using the keyword "use-fcgi-app" into the proxy section). Several
21439FastCGI applications may be defined, but only one can be used at a time by a
21440backend.
21441
21442HAProxy implements all features of the FastCGI specification for Responder
21443application. Especially it is able to multiplex several requests on a simple
21444connection.
21445
2144610.1. Setup
21447-----------
21448
2144910.1.1. Fcgi-app section
21450--------------------------
21451
21452fcgi-app <name>
21453 Declare a FastCGI application named <name>. To be valid, at least the
21454 document root must be defined.
21455
21456acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
21457 Declare or complete an access list.
21458
21459 See "acl" keyword in section 4.2 and section 7 about ACL usage for
21460 details. ACLs defined for a FastCGI application are private. They cannot be
21461 used by any other application or by any proxy. In the same way, ACLs defined
21462 in any other section are not usable by a FastCGI application. However,
21463 Pre-defined ACLs are available.
21464
21465docroot <path>
21466 Define the document root on the remote host. <path> will be used to build
21467 the default value of FastCGI parameters SCRIPT_FILENAME and
21468 PATH_TRANSLATED. It is a mandatory setting.
21469
21470index <script-name>
21471 Define the script name that will be appended after an URI that ends with a
21472 slash ("/") to set the default value of the FastCGI parameter SCRIPT_NAME. It
21473 is an optional setting.
21474
21475 Example :
21476 index index.php
21477
21478log-stderr global
21479log-stderr <address> [len <length>] [format <format>]
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +010021480 [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021481 Enable logging of STDERR messages reported by the FastCGI application.
21482
21483 See "log" keyword in section 4.2 for details. It is an optional setting. By
21484 default STDERR messages are ignored.
21485
21486pass-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
21487 Specify the name of a request header which will be passed to the FastCGI
21488 application. It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based condition, in
21489 which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
21490
21491 Most request headers are already available to the FastCGI application,
21492 prefixed with "HTTP_". Thus, this directive is only required to pass headers
21493 that are purposefully omitted. Currently, the headers "Authorization",
21494 "Proxy-Authorization" and hop-by-hop headers are omitted.
21495
21496 Note that the headers "Content-type" and "Content-length" are never passed to
21497 the FastCGI application because they are already converted into parameters.
21498
21499path-info <regex>
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010021500 Define a regular expression to extract the script-name and the path-info from
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010021501 the URL-decoded path. Thus, <regex> may have two captures: the first one to
21502 capture the script name and the second one to capture the path-info. The
21503 first one is mandatory, the second one is optional. This way, it is possible
21504 to extract the script-name from the path ignoring the path-info. It is an
21505 optional setting. If it is not defined, no matching is performed on the
21506 path. and the FastCGI parameters PATH_INFO and PATH_TRANSLATED are not
21507 filled.
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010021508
21509 For security reason, when this regular expression is defined, the newline and
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050021510 the null characters are forbidden from the path, once URL-decoded. The reason
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010021511 to such limitation is because otherwise the matching always fails (due to a
21512 limitation one the way regular expression are executed in HAProxy). So if one
21513 of these two characters is found in the URL-decoded path, an error is
21514 returned to the client. The principle of least astonishment is applied here.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021515
21516 Example :
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010021517 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$ # both script-name and path-info may be set
21518 path-info ^(/.+\.php) # the path-info is ignored
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021519
21520option get-values
21521no option get-values
21522 Enable or disable the retrieve of variables about connection management.
21523
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040021524 HAProxy is able to send the record FCGI_GET_VALUES on connection
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021525 establishment to retrieve the value for following variables:
21526
21527 * FCGI_MAX_REQS The maximum number of concurrent requests this
21528 application will accept.
21529
William Lallemand93e548e2019-09-30 13:54:02 +020021530 * FCGI_MPXS_CONNS "0" if this application does not multiplex connections,
21531 "1" otherwise.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021532
21533 Some FastCGI applications does not support this feature. Some others close
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050021534 the connection immediately after sending their response. So, by default, this
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021535 option is disabled.
21536
21537 Note that the maximum number of concurrent requests accepted by a FastCGI
21538 application is a connection variable. It only limits the number of streams
21539 per connection. If the global load must be limited on the application, the
21540 server parameters "maxconn" and "pool-max-conn" must be set. In addition, if
21541 an application does not support connection multiplexing, the maximum number
21542 of concurrent requests is automatically set to 1.
21543
21544option keep-conn
21545no option keep-conn
21546 Instruct the FastCGI application to keep the connection open or not after
21547 sending a response.
21548
21549 If disabled, the FastCGI application closes the connection after responding
21550 to this request. By default, this option is enabled.
21551
21552option max-reqs <reqs>
21553 Define the maximum number of concurrent requests this application will
21554 accept.
21555
21556 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MAX_REQS is retrieved
21557 during connection establishment. Furthermore, if the application does not
21558 support connection multiplexing, this option will be ignored. By default set
21559 to 1.
21560
21561option mpxs-conns
21562no option mpxs-conns
21563 Enable or disable the support of connection multiplexing.
21564
21565 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MPXS_CONNS is retrieved
21566 during connection establishment. It is disabled by default.
21567
21568set-param <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
21569 Set a FastCGI parameter that should be passed to this application. Its
21570 value, defined by <fmt> must follows the log-format rules (see section 8.2.4
21571 "Custom Log format"). It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based
21572 condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
21573
21574 With this directive, it is possible to overwrite the value of default FastCGI
21575 parameters. If the value is evaluated to an empty string, the rule is
21576 ignored. These directives are evaluated in their declaration order.
21577
21578 Example :
21579 # PHP only, required if PHP was built with --enable-force-cgi-redirect
21580 set-param REDIRECT_STATUS 200
21581
21582 set-param PHP_AUTH_DIGEST %[req.hdr(Authorization)]
21583
21584
2158510.1.2. Proxy section
21586---------------------
21587
21588use-fcgi-app <name>
21589 Define the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
21590
21591 Arguments :
21592 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
21593
21594 This keyword is only available for HTTP proxies with the backend capability
21595 and with at least one FastCGI server. However, FastCGI servers can be mixed
21596 with HTTP servers. But except there is a good reason to do so, it is not
21597 recommended (see section 10.3 about the limitations for details). Only one
21598 application may be defined at a time per backend.
21599
21600 Note that, once a FastCGI application is referenced for a backend, depending
21601 on the configuration some processing may be done even if the request is not
21602 sent to a FastCGI server. Rules to set parameters or pass headers to an
21603 application are evaluated.
21604
21605
2160610.1.3. Example
21607---------------
21608
21609 frontend front-http
21610 mode http
21611 bind *:80
21612 bind *:
21613
21614 use_backend back-dynamic if { path_reg ^/.+\.php(/.*)?$ }
21615 default_backend back-static
21616
21617 backend back-static
21618 mode http
21619 server www A.B.C.D:80
21620
21621 backend back-dynamic
21622 mode http
21623 use-fcgi-app php-fpm
21624 server php-fpm A.B.C.D:9000 proto fcgi
21625
21626 fcgi-app php-fpm
21627 log-stderr global
21628 option keep-conn
21629
21630 docroot /var/www/my-app
21631 index index.php
21632 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
21633
21634
2163510.2. Default parameters
21636------------------------
21637
21638A Responder FastCGI application has the same purpose as a CGI/1.1 program. In
21639the CGI/1.1 specification (RFC3875), several variables must be passed to the
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050021640script. So HAProxy set them and some others commonly used by FastCGI
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021641applications. All these variables may be overwritten, with caution though.
21642
21643 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21644 | AUTH_TYPE | Identifies the mechanism, if any, used by HAProxy |
21645 | | to authenticate the user. Concretely, only the |
21646 | | BASIC authentication mechanism is supported. |
21647 | | |
21648 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21649 | CONTENT_LENGTH | Contains the size of the message-body attached to |
21650 | | the request. It means only requests with a known |
21651 | | size are considered as valid and sent to the |
21652 | | application. |
21653 | | |
21654 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21655 | CONTENT_TYPE | Contains the type of the message-body attached to |
21656 | | the request. It may not be set. |
21657 | | |
21658 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21659 | DOCUMENT_ROOT | Contains the document root on the remote host under |
21660 | | which the script should be executed, as defined in |
21661 | | the application's configuration. |
21662 | | |
21663 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21664 | GATEWAY_INTERFACE | Contains the dialect of CGI being used by HAProxy |
21665 | | to communicate with the FastCGI application. |
21666 | | Concretely, it is set to "CGI/1.1". |
21667 | | |
21668 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21669 | PATH_INFO | Contains the portion of the URI path hierarchy |
21670 | | following the part that identifies the script |
21671 | | itself. To be set, the directive "path-info" must |
21672 | | be defined. |
21673 | | |
21674 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21675 | PATH_TRANSLATED | If PATH_INFO is set, it is its translated version. |
21676 | | It is the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and |
21677 | | PATH_INFO. If PATH_INFO is not set, this parameters |
21678 | | is not set too. |
21679 | | |
21680 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21681 | QUERY_STRING | Contains the request's query string. It may not be |
21682 | | set. |
21683 | | |
21684 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21685 | REMOTE_ADDR | Contains the network address of the client sending |
21686 | | the request. |
21687 | | |
21688 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21689 | REMOTE_USER | Contains the user identification string supplied by |
21690 | | client as part of user authentication. |
21691 | | |
21692 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21693 | REQUEST_METHOD | Contains the method which should be used by the |
21694 | | script to process the request. |
21695 | | |
21696 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21697 | REQUEST_URI | Contains the request's URI. |
21698 | | |
21699 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21700 | SCRIPT_FILENAME | Contains the absolute pathname of the script. it is |
21701 | | the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and SCRIPT_NAME. |
21702 | | |
21703 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21704 | SCRIPT_NAME | Contains the name of the script. If the directive |
21705 | | "path-info" is defined, it is the first part of the |
21706 | | URI path hierarchy, ending with the script name. |
21707 | | Otherwise, it is the entire URI path. |
21708 | | |
21709 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21710 | SERVER_NAME | Contains the name of the server host to which the |
21711 | | client request is directed. It is the value of the |
21712 | | header "Host", if defined. Otherwise, the |
21713 | | destination address of the connection on the client |
21714 | | side. |
21715 | | |
21716 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21717 | SERVER_PORT | Contains the destination TCP port of the connection |
21718 | | on the client side, which is the port the client |
21719 | | connected to. |
21720 | | |
21721 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21722 | SERVER_PROTOCOL | Contains the request's protocol. |
21723 | | |
21724 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21725 | HTTPS | Set to a non-empty value ("on") if the script was |
21726 | | queried through the HTTPS protocol. |
21727 | | |
21728 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21729
21730
2173110.3. Limitations
21732------------------
21733
21734The current implementation have some limitations. The first one is about the
21735way some request headers are hidden to the FastCGI applications. This happens
21736during the headers analysis, on the backend side, before the connection
21737establishment. At this stage, HAProxy know the backend is using a FastCGI
21738application but it don't know if the request will be routed to a FastCGI server
21739or not. But to hide request headers, it simply removes them from the HTX
21740message. So, if the request is finally routed to an HTTP server, it never see
21741these headers. For this reason, it is not recommended to mix FastCGI servers
21742and HTTP servers under the same backend.
21743
21744Similarly, the rules "set-param" and "pass-header" are evaluated during the
21745request headers analysis. So the evaluation is always performed, even if the
21746requests is finally forwarded to an HTTP server.
21747
21748About the rules "set-param", when a rule is applied, a pseudo header is added
21749into the HTX message. So, the same way than for HTTP header rewrites, it may
21750fail if the buffer is full. The rules "set-param" will compete with
21751"http-request" ones.
21752
21753Finally, all FastCGI params and HTTP headers are sent into a unique record
21754FCGI_PARAM. Encoding of this record must be done in one pass, otherwise a
21755processing error is returned. It means the record FCGI_PARAM, once encoded,
21756must not exceeds the size of a buffer. However, there is no reserve to respect
21757here.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010021758
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020021759
2176011. Address formats
21761-------------------
21762
21763Several statements as "bind, "server", "nameserver" and "log" requires an
21764address.
21765
21766This address can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6 address, or '*'.
21767The '*' is equal to the special address "0.0.0.0" and can be used, in the case
21768of "bind" or "dgram-bind" to listen on all IPv4 of the system.The IPv6
21769equivalent is '::'.
21770
21771Depending of the statement, a port or port range follows the IP address. This
21772is mandatory on 'bind' statement, optional on 'server'.
21773
21774This address can also begin with a slash '/'. It is considered as the "unix"
21775family, and '/' and following characters must be present the path.
21776
21777Default socket type or transport method "datagram" or "stream" depends on the
21778configuration statement showing the address. Indeed, 'bind' and 'server' will
21779use a "stream" socket type by default whereas 'log', 'nameserver' or
21780'dgram-bind' will use a "datagram".
21781
21782Optionally, a prefix could be used to force the address family and/or the
21783socket type and the transport method.
21784
21785
2178611.1 Address family prefixes
21787----------------------------
21788
21789'abns@<name>' following <name> is an abstract namespace (Linux only).
21790
21791'fd@<n>' following address is a file descriptor <n> inherited from the
21792 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already be
21793 listening.
21794
21795'ip@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4 or
21796 IPv6 address depending on the syntax. Depending
21797 on the statement using this address, a port or
21798 a port range may or must be specified.
21799
21800'ipv4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
21801 an IPv4 address. Depending on the statement
21802 using this address, a port or a port range
21803 may or must be specified.
21804
21805'ipv6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
21806 an IPv6 address. Depending on the statement
21807 using this address, a port or a port range
21808 may or must be specified.
21809
21810'sockpair@<n>' following address is the file descriptor of a connected unix
21811 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the initiator
21812 creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes one of them
21813 over the FD to the other end. The listener waits to receive
21814 the FD from the unix socket and uses it as if it were the FD
21815 of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
21816
21817'unix@<path>' following string is considered as a UNIX socket <path>. this
21818 prefix is useful to declare an UNIX socket path which don't
21819 start by slash '/'.
21820
21821
2182211.2 Socket type prefixes
21823-------------------------
21824
21825Previous "Address family prefixes" can also be prefixed to force the socket
21826type and the transport method. The default depends of the statement using
21827this address but in some cases the user may force it to a different one.
21828This is the case for "log" statement where the default is syslog over UDP
21829but we could force to use syslog over TCP.
21830
21831Those prefixes were designed for internal purpose and users should
21832instead use aliases of the next section "11.5.3 Protocol prefixes".
21833
21834If users need one those prefixes to perform what they expect because
21835they can not configure the same using the protocol prefixes, they should
21836report this to the maintainers.
21837
21838'stream+<family>@<address>' forces socket type and transport method
21839 to "stream"
21840
21841'dgram+<family>@<address>' forces socket type and transport method
21842 to "datagram".
21843
21844
2184511.3 Protocol prefixes
21846----------------------
21847
21848'tcp@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4
21849 or IPv6 address depending of the syntax but
21850 socket type and transport method is forced to
21851 "stream". Depending on the statement using
21852 this address, a port or a port range can or
21853 must be specified. It is considered as an alias
21854 of 'stream+ip@'.
21855
21856'tcp4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
21857 an IPv4 address but socket type and transport
21858 method is forced to "stream". Depending on the
21859 statement using this address, a port or port
21860 range can or must be specified.
21861 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
21862
21863'tcp6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
21864 an IPv6 address but socket type and transport
21865 method is forced to "stream". Depending on the
21866 statement using this address, a port or port
21867 range can or must be specified.
21868 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
21869
21870'udp@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4
21871 or IPv6 address depending of the syntax but
21872 socket type and transport method is forced to
21873 "datagram". Depending on the statement using
21874 this address, a port or a port range can or
21875 must be specified. It is considered as an alias
21876 of 'dgram+ip@'.
21877
21878'udp4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
21879 an IPv4 address but socket type and transport
21880 method is forced to "datagram". Depending on
21881 the statement using this address, a port or
21882 port range can or must be specified.
21883 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
21884
21885'udp6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
21886 an IPv6 address but socket type and transport
21887 method is forced to "datagram". Depending on
21888 the statement using this address, a port or
21889 port range can or must be specified.
21890 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
21891
21892'uxdg@<path>' following string is considered as a unix socket <path> but
21893 transport method is forced to "datagram". It is considered as
21894 an alias of 'dgram+unix@'.
21895
21896'uxst@<path>' following string is considered as a unix socket <path> but
21897 transport method is forced to "stream". It is considered as
21898 an alias of 'stream+unix@'.
21899
21900In future versions, other prefixes could be used to specify protocols like
21901QUIC which proposes stream transport based on socket of type "datagram".
21902
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010021903/*
21904 * Local variables:
21905 * fill-column: 79
21906 * End:
21907 */